Coverage Report

Created: 2026-04-01 06:32

next uncovered line (L), next uncovered region (R), next uncovered branch (B)
/src/libgit2/deps/pcre/pcre_compile.c
Line
Count
Source
1
/*************************************************
2
*      Perl-Compatible Regular Expressions       *
3
*************************************************/
4
5
/* PCRE is a library of functions to support regular expressions whose syntax
6
and semantics are as close as possible to those of the Perl 5 language.
7
8
                       Written by Philip Hazel
9
           Copyright (c) 1997-2021 University of Cambridge
10
11
-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
12
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
13
modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
14
15
    * Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice,
16
      this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
17
18
    * Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
19
      notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
20
      documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
21
22
    * Neither the name of the University of Cambridge nor the names of its
23
      contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived from
24
      this software without specific prior written permission.
25
26
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS "AS IS"
27
AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
28
IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
29
ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT OWNER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE
30
LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
31
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF
32
SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
33
INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN
34
CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
35
ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
36
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
37
-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
38
*/
39
40
41
/* This module contains the external function pcre_compile(), along with
42
supporting internal functions that are not used by other modules. */
43
44
45
#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
46
#include "config.h"
47
#endif
48
49
53.7k
#define NLBLOCK cd             /* Block containing newline information */
50
#define PSSTART start_pattern  /* Field containing pattern start */
51
23.9k
#define PSEND   end_pattern    /* Field containing pattern end */
52
53
#include "pcre_internal.h"
54
55
56
/* When PCRE_DEBUG is defined, we need the pcre(16|32)_printint() function, which
57
is also used by pcretest. PCRE_DEBUG is not defined when building a production
58
library. We do not need to select pcre16_printint.c specially, because the
59
COMPILE_PCREx macro will already be appropriately set. */
60
61
#ifdef PCRE_DEBUG
62
/* pcre_printint.c should not include any headers */
63
#define PCRE_INCLUDED
64
#include "pcre_printint.c"
65
#undef PCRE_INCLUDED
66
#endif
67
68
69
/* Macro for setting individual bits in class bitmaps. */
70
71
1.08M
#define SETBIT(a,b) a[(b)/8] |= (1U << ((b)&7))
72
73
/* Maximum length value to check against when making sure that the integer that
74
holds the compiled pattern length does not overflow. We make it a bit less than
75
INT_MAX to allow for adding in group terminating bytes, so that we don't have
76
to check them every time. */
77
78
3.84M
#define OFLOW_MAX (INT_MAX - 20)
79
80
/* Definitions to allow mutual recursion */
81
82
static int
83
  add_list_to_class(pcre_uint8 *, pcre_uchar **, int, compile_data *,
84
    const pcre_uint32 *, unsigned int);
85
86
static BOOL
87
  compile_regex(int, pcre_uchar **, const pcre_uchar **, int *, BOOL, BOOL, int, int,
88
    pcre_uint32 *, pcre_int32 *, pcre_uint32 *, pcre_int32 *, branch_chain *,
89
    compile_data *, int *);
90
91
92
93
/*************************************************
94
*      Code parameters and static tables         *
95
*************************************************/
96
97
/* This value specifies the size of stack workspace that is used during the
98
first pre-compile phase that determines how much memory is required. The regex
99
is partly compiled into this space, but the compiled parts are discarded as
100
soon as they can be, so that hopefully there will never be an overrun. The code
101
does, however, check for an overrun. The largest amount I've seen used is 218,
102
so this number is very generous.
103
104
The same workspace is used during the second, actual compile phase for
105
remembering forward references to groups so that they can be filled in at the
106
end. Each entry in this list occupies LINK_SIZE bytes, so even when LINK_SIZE
107
is 4 there is plenty of room for most patterns. However, the memory can get
108
filled up by repetitions of forward references, for example patterns like
109
/(?1){0,1999}(b)/, and one user did hit the limit. The code has been changed so
110
that the workspace is expanded using malloc() in this situation. The value
111
below is therefore a minimum, and we put a maximum on it for safety. The
112
minimum is now also defined in terms of LINK_SIZE so that the use of malloc()
113
kicks in at the same number of forward references in all cases. */
114
115
37.4k
#define COMPILE_WORK_SIZE (2048*LINK_SIZE)
116
102
#define COMPILE_WORK_SIZE_MAX (100*COMPILE_WORK_SIZE)
117
118
/* This value determines the size of the initial vector that is used for
119
remembering named groups during the pre-compile. It is allocated on the stack,
120
but if it is too small, it is expanded using malloc(), in a similar way to the
121
workspace. The value is the number of slots in the list. */
122
123
25.5k
#define NAMED_GROUP_LIST_SIZE  20
124
125
/* The overrun tests check for a slightly smaller size so that they detect the
126
overrun before it actually does run off the end of the data block. */
127
128
3.03M
#define WORK_SIZE_SAFETY_MARGIN (100)
129
130
/* Private flags added to firstchar and reqchar. */
131
132
38.7k
#define REQ_CASELESS    (1U << 0)        /* Indicates caselessness */
133
585k
#define REQ_VARY        (1U << 1)        /* Reqchar followed non-literal item */
134
/* Negative values for the firstchar and reqchar flags */
135
2.68M
#define REQ_UNSET       (-2)
136
224k
#define REQ_NONE        (-1)
137
138
/* Repeated character flags. */
139
140
#define UTF_LENGTH     0x10000000l      /* The char contains its length. */
141
142
/* Table for handling escaped characters in the range '0'-'z'. Positive returns
143
are simple data values; negative values are for special things like \d and so
144
on. Zero means further processing is needed (for things like \x), or the escape
145
is invalid. */
146
147
#ifndef EBCDIC
148
149
/* This is the "normal" table for ASCII systems or for EBCDIC systems running
150
in UTF-8 mode. */
151
152
static const short int escapes[] = {
153
     0,                       0,
154
     0,                       0,
155
     0,                       0,
156
     0,                       0,
157
     0,                       0,
158
     CHAR_COLON,              CHAR_SEMICOLON,
159
     CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN,     CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN,
160
     CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN,  CHAR_QUESTION_MARK,
161
     CHAR_COMMERCIAL_AT,      -ESC_A,
162
     -ESC_B,                  -ESC_C,
163
     -ESC_D,                  -ESC_E,
164
     0,                       -ESC_G,
165
     -ESC_H,                  0,
166
     0,                       -ESC_K,
167
     0,                       0,
168
     -ESC_N,                  0,
169
     -ESC_P,                  -ESC_Q,
170
     -ESC_R,                  -ESC_S,
171
     0,                       0,
172
     -ESC_V,                  -ESC_W,
173
     -ESC_X,                  0,
174
     -ESC_Z,                  CHAR_LEFT_SQUARE_BRACKET,
175
     CHAR_BACKSLASH,          CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET,
176
     CHAR_CIRCUMFLEX_ACCENT,  CHAR_UNDERSCORE,
177
     CHAR_GRAVE_ACCENT,       ESC_a,
178
     -ESC_b,                  0,
179
     -ESC_d,                  ESC_e,
180
     ESC_f,                   0,
181
     -ESC_h,                  0,
182
     0,                       -ESC_k,
183
     0,                       0,
184
     ESC_n,                   0,
185
     -ESC_p,                  0,
186
     ESC_r,                   -ESC_s,
187
     ESC_tee,                 0,
188
     -ESC_v,                  -ESC_w,
189
     0,                       0,
190
     -ESC_z
191
};
192
193
#else
194
195
/* This is the "abnormal" table for EBCDIC systems without UTF-8 support. */
196
197
static const short int escapes[] = {
198
/*  48 */     0,     0,      0,     '.',    '<',   '(',    '+',    '|',
199
/*  50 */   '&',     0,      0,       0,      0,     0,      0,      0,
200
/*  58 */     0,     0,    '!',     '$',    '*',   ')',    ';',    '~',
201
/*  60 */   '-',   '/',      0,       0,      0,     0,      0,      0,
202
/*  68 */     0,     0,    '|',     ',',    '%',   '_',    '>',    '?',
203
/*  70 */     0,     0,      0,       0,      0,     0,      0,      0,
204
/*  78 */     0,   '`',    ':',     '#',    '@',  '\'',    '=',    '"',
205
/*  80 */     0, ESC_a, -ESC_b,       0, -ESC_d, ESC_e,  ESC_f,      0,
206
/*  88 */-ESC_h,     0,      0,     '{',      0,     0,      0,      0,
207
/*  90 */     0,     0, -ESC_k,       0,      0, ESC_n,      0, -ESC_p,
208
/*  98 */     0, ESC_r,      0,     '}',      0,     0,      0,      0,
209
/*  A0 */     0,   '~', -ESC_s, ESC_tee,      0,-ESC_v, -ESC_w,      0,
210
/*  A8 */     0,-ESC_z,      0,       0,      0,   '[',      0,      0,
211
/*  B0 */     0,     0,      0,       0,      0,     0,      0,      0,
212
/*  B8 */     0,     0,      0,       0,      0,   ']',    '=',    '-',
213
/*  C0 */   '{',-ESC_A, -ESC_B,  -ESC_C, -ESC_D,-ESC_E,      0, -ESC_G,
214
/*  C8 */-ESC_H,     0,      0,       0,      0,     0,      0,      0,
215
/*  D0 */   '}',     0, -ESC_K,       0,      0,-ESC_N,      0, -ESC_P,
216
/*  D8 */-ESC_Q,-ESC_R,      0,       0,      0,     0,      0,      0,
217
/*  E0 */  '\\',     0, -ESC_S,       0,      0,-ESC_V, -ESC_W, -ESC_X,
218
/*  E8 */     0,-ESC_Z,      0,       0,      0,     0,      0,      0,
219
/*  F0 */     0,     0,      0,       0,      0,     0,      0,      0,
220
/*  F8 */     0,     0,      0,       0,      0,     0,      0,      0
221
};
222
223
/* We also need a table of characters that may follow \c in an EBCDIC
224
environment for characters 0-31. */
225
226
static unsigned char ebcdic_escape_c[] = "@ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ[\\]^_";
227
228
#endif
229
230
231
/* Table of special "verbs" like (*PRUNE). This is a short table, so it is
232
searched linearly. Put all the names into a single string, in order to reduce
233
the number of relocations when a shared library is dynamically linked. The
234
string is built from string macros so that it works in UTF-8 mode on EBCDIC
235
platforms. */
236
237
typedef struct verbitem {
238
  int   len;                 /* Length of verb name */
239
  int   op;                  /* Op when no arg, or -1 if arg mandatory */
240
  int   op_arg;              /* Op when arg present, or -1 if not allowed */
241
} verbitem;
242
243
static const char verbnames[] =
244
  "\0"                       /* Empty name is a shorthand for MARK */
245
  STRING_MARK0
246
  STRING_ACCEPT0
247
  STRING_COMMIT0
248
  STRING_F0
249
  STRING_FAIL0
250
  STRING_PRUNE0
251
  STRING_SKIP0
252
  STRING_THEN;
253
254
static const verbitem verbs[] = {
255
  { 0, -1,        OP_MARK },
256
  { 4, -1,        OP_MARK },
257
  { 6, OP_ACCEPT, -1 },
258
  { 6, OP_COMMIT, -1 },
259
  { 1, OP_FAIL,   -1 },
260
  { 4, OP_FAIL,   -1 },
261
  { 5, OP_PRUNE,  OP_PRUNE_ARG },
262
  { 4, OP_SKIP,   OP_SKIP_ARG  },
263
  { 4, OP_THEN,   OP_THEN_ARG  }
264
};
265
266
static const int verbcount = sizeof(verbs)/sizeof(verbitem);
267
268
269
/* Substitutes for [[:<:]] and [[:>:]], which mean start and end of word in
270
another regex library. */
271
272
static const pcre_uchar sub_start_of_word[] = {
273
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_b, CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS, CHAR_QUESTION_MARK,
274
  CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN, CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_w, CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS, '\0' };
275
276
static const pcre_uchar sub_end_of_word[] = {
277
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_b, CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS, CHAR_QUESTION_MARK,
278
  CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN, CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN, CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_w,
279
  CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS, '\0' };
280
281
282
/* Tables of names of POSIX character classes and their lengths. The names are
283
now all in a single string, to reduce the number of relocations when a shared
284
library is dynamically loaded. The list of lengths is terminated by a zero
285
length entry. The first three must be alpha, lower, upper, as this is assumed
286
for handling case independence. The indices for graph, print, and punct are
287
needed, so identify them. */
288
289
static const char posix_names[] =
290
  STRING_alpha0 STRING_lower0 STRING_upper0 STRING_alnum0
291
  STRING_ascii0 STRING_blank0 STRING_cntrl0 STRING_digit0
292
  STRING_graph0 STRING_print0 STRING_punct0 STRING_space0
293
  STRING_word0  STRING_xdigit;
294
295
static const pcre_uint8 posix_name_lengths[] = {
296
  5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 4, 6, 0 };
297
298
#define PC_GRAPH  8
299
#define PC_PRINT  9
300
#define PC_PUNCT 10
301
302
303
/* Table of class bit maps for each POSIX class. Each class is formed from a
304
base map, with an optional addition or removal of another map. Then, for some
305
classes, there is some additional tweaking: for [:blank:] the vertical space
306
characters are removed, and for [:alpha:] and [:alnum:] the underscore
307
character is removed. The triples in the table consist of the base map offset,
308
second map offset or -1 if no second map, and a non-negative value for map
309
addition or a negative value for map subtraction (if there are two maps). The
310
absolute value of the third field has these meanings: 0 => no tweaking, 1 =>
311
remove vertical space characters, 2 => remove underscore. */
312
313
static const int posix_class_maps[] = {
314
  cbit_word,  cbit_digit, -2,             /* alpha */
315
  cbit_lower, -1,          0,             /* lower */
316
  cbit_upper, -1,          0,             /* upper */
317
  cbit_word,  -1,          2,             /* alnum - word without underscore */
318
  cbit_print, cbit_cntrl,  0,             /* ascii */
319
  cbit_space, -1,          1,             /* blank - a GNU extension */
320
  cbit_cntrl, -1,          0,             /* cntrl */
321
  cbit_digit, -1,          0,             /* digit */
322
  cbit_graph, -1,          0,             /* graph */
323
  cbit_print, -1,          0,             /* print */
324
  cbit_punct, -1,          0,             /* punct */
325
  cbit_space, -1,          0,             /* space */
326
  cbit_word,  -1,          0,             /* word - a Perl extension */
327
  cbit_xdigit,-1,          0              /* xdigit */
328
};
329
330
/* Table of substitutes for \d etc when PCRE_UCP is set. They are replaced by
331
Unicode property escapes. */
332
333
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
334
static const pcre_uchar string_PNd[]  = {
335
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_P, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
336
  CHAR_N, CHAR_d, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
337
static const pcre_uchar string_pNd[]  = {
338
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_p, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
339
  CHAR_N, CHAR_d, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
340
static const pcre_uchar string_PXsp[] = {
341
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_P, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
342
  CHAR_X, CHAR_s, CHAR_p, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
343
static const pcre_uchar string_pXsp[] = {
344
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_p, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
345
  CHAR_X, CHAR_s, CHAR_p, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
346
static const pcre_uchar string_PXwd[] = {
347
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_P, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
348
  CHAR_X, CHAR_w, CHAR_d, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
349
static const pcre_uchar string_pXwd[] = {
350
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_p, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
351
  CHAR_X, CHAR_w, CHAR_d, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
352
353
static const pcre_uchar *substitutes[] = {
354
  string_PNd,           /* \D */
355
  string_pNd,           /* \d */
356
  string_PXsp,          /* \S */   /* Xsp is Perl space, but from 8.34, Perl */
357
  string_pXsp,          /* \s */   /* space and POSIX space are the same. */
358
  string_PXwd,          /* \W */
359
  string_pXwd           /* \w */
360
};
361
362
/* The POSIX class substitutes must be in the order of the POSIX class names,
363
defined above, and there are both positive and negative cases. NULL means no
364
general substitute of a Unicode property escape (\p or \P). However, for some
365
POSIX classes (e.g. graph, print, punct) a special property code is compiled
366
directly. */
367
368
static const pcre_uchar string_pL[] =   {
369
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_p, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
370
  CHAR_L, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
371
static const pcre_uchar string_pLl[] =  {
372
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_p, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
373
  CHAR_L, CHAR_l, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
374
static const pcre_uchar string_pLu[] =  {
375
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_p, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
376
  CHAR_L, CHAR_u, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
377
static const pcre_uchar string_pXan[] = {
378
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_p, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
379
  CHAR_X, CHAR_a, CHAR_n, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
380
static const pcre_uchar string_h[] =    {
381
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_h, '\0' };
382
static const pcre_uchar string_pXps[] = {
383
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_p, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
384
  CHAR_X, CHAR_p, CHAR_s, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
385
static const pcre_uchar string_PL[] =   {
386
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_P, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
387
  CHAR_L, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
388
static const pcre_uchar string_PLl[] =  {
389
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_P, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
390
  CHAR_L, CHAR_l, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
391
static const pcre_uchar string_PLu[] =  {
392
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_P, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
393
  CHAR_L, CHAR_u, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
394
static const pcre_uchar string_PXan[] = {
395
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_P, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
396
  CHAR_X, CHAR_a, CHAR_n, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
397
static const pcre_uchar string_H[] =    {
398
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_H, '\0' };
399
static const pcre_uchar string_PXps[] = {
400
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_P, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
401
  CHAR_X, CHAR_p, CHAR_s, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
402
403
static const pcre_uchar *posix_substitutes[] = {
404
  string_pL,            /* alpha */
405
  string_pLl,           /* lower */
406
  string_pLu,           /* upper */
407
  string_pXan,          /* alnum */
408
  NULL,                 /* ascii */
409
  string_h,             /* blank */
410
  NULL,                 /* cntrl */
411
  string_pNd,           /* digit */
412
  NULL,                 /* graph */
413
  NULL,                 /* print */
414
  NULL,                 /* punct */
415
  string_pXps,          /* space */   /* Xps is POSIX space, but from 8.34 */
416
  string_pXwd,          /* word  */   /* Perl and POSIX space are the same */
417
  NULL,                 /* xdigit */
418
  /* Negated cases */
419
  string_PL,            /* ^alpha */
420
  string_PLl,           /* ^lower */
421
  string_PLu,           /* ^upper */
422
  string_PXan,          /* ^alnum */
423
  NULL,                 /* ^ascii */
424
  string_H,             /* ^blank */
425
  NULL,                 /* ^cntrl */
426
  string_PNd,           /* ^digit */
427
  NULL,                 /* ^graph */
428
  NULL,                 /* ^print */
429
  NULL,                 /* ^punct */
430
  string_PXps,          /* ^space */  /* Xps is POSIX space, but from 8.34 */
431
  string_PXwd,          /* ^word */   /* Perl and POSIX space are the same */
432
  NULL                  /* ^xdigit */
433
};
434
#define POSIX_SUBSIZE (sizeof(posix_substitutes) / sizeof(pcre_uchar *))
435
#endif
436
437
#define STRING(a)  # a
438
#define XSTRING(s) STRING(s)
439
440
/* The texts of compile-time error messages. These are "char *" because they
441
are passed to the outside world. Do not ever re-use any error number, because
442
they are documented. Always add a new error instead. Messages marked DEAD below
443
are no longer used. This used to be a table of strings, but in order to reduce
444
the number of relocations needed when a shared library is loaded dynamically,
445
it is now one long string. We cannot use a table of offsets, because the
446
lengths of inserts such as XSTRING(MAX_NAME_SIZE) are not known. Instead, we
447
simply count through to the one we want - this isn't a performance issue
448
because these strings are used only when there is a compilation error.
449
450
Each substring ends with \0 to insert a null character. This includes the final
451
substring, so that the whole string ends with \0\0, which can be detected when
452
counting through. */
453
454
static const char error_texts[] =
455
  "no error\0"
456
  "\\ at end of pattern\0"
457
  "\\c at end of pattern\0"
458
  "unrecognized character follows \\\0"
459
  "numbers out of order in {} quantifier\0"
460
  /* 5 */
461
  "number too big in {} quantifier\0"
462
  "missing terminating ] for character class\0"
463
  "invalid escape sequence in character class\0"
464
  "range out of order in character class\0"
465
  "nothing to repeat\0"
466
  /* 10 */
467
  "internal error: invalid forward reference offset\0"
468
  "internal error: unexpected repeat\0"
469
  "unrecognized character after (? or (?-\0"
470
  "POSIX named classes are supported only within a class\0"
471
  "missing )\0"
472
  /* 15 */
473
  "reference to non-existent subpattern\0"
474
  "erroffset passed as NULL\0"
475
  "unknown option bit(s) set\0"
476
  "missing ) after comment\0"
477
  "parentheses nested too deeply\0"  /** DEAD **/
478
  /* 20 */
479
  "regular expression is too large\0"
480
  "failed to get memory\0"
481
  "unmatched parentheses\0"
482
  "internal error: code overflow\0"
483
  "unrecognized character after (?<\0"
484
  /* 25 */
485
  "lookbehind assertion is not fixed length\0"
486
  "malformed number or name after (?(\0"
487
  "conditional group contains more than two branches\0"
488
  "assertion expected after (?( or (?(?C)\0"
489
  "(?R or (?[+-]digits must be followed by )\0"
490
  /* 30 */
491
  "unknown POSIX class name\0"
492
  "POSIX collating elements are not supported\0"
493
  "this version of PCRE is compiled without UTF support\0"
494
  "spare error\0"  /** DEAD **/
495
  "character value in \\x{} or \\o{} is too large\0"
496
  /* 35 */
497
  "invalid condition (?(0)\0"
498
  "\\C not allowed in lookbehind assertion\0"
499
  "PCRE does not support \\L, \\l, \\N{name}, \\U, or \\u\0"
500
  "number after (?C is > 255\0"
501
  "closing ) for (?C expected\0"
502
  /* 40 */
503
  "recursive call could loop indefinitely\0"
504
  "unrecognized character after (?P\0"
505
  "syntax error in subpattern name (missing terminator)\0"
506
  "two named subpatterns have the same name\0"
507
  "invalid UTF-8 string\0"
508
  /* 45 */
509
  "support for \\P, \\p, and \\X has not been compiled\0"
510
  "malformed \\P or \\p sequence\0"
511
  "unknown property name after \\P or \\p\0"
512
  "subpattern name is too long (maximum " XSTRING(MAX_NAME_SIZE) " characters)\0"
513
  "too many named subpatterns (maximum " XSTRING(MAX_NAME_COUNT) ")\0"
514
  /* 50 */
515
  "repeated subpattern is too long\0"    /** DEAD **/
516
  "octal value is greater than \\377 in 8-bit non-UTF-8 mode\0"
517
  "internal error: overran compiling workspace\0"
518
  "internal error: previously-checked referenced subpattern not found\0"
519
  "DEFINE group contains more than one branch\0"
520
  /* 55 */
521
  "repeating a DEFINE group is not allowed\0"  /** DEAD **/
522
  "inconsistent NEWLINE options\0"
523
  "\\g is not followed by a braced, angle-bracketed, or quoted name/number or by a plain number\0"
524
  "a numbered reference must not be zero\0"
525
  "an argument is not allowed for (*ACCEPT), (*FAIL), or (*COMMIT)\0"
526
  /* 60 */
527
  "(*VERB) not recognized or malformed\0"
528
  "number is too big\0"
529
  "subpattern name expected\0"
530
  "digit expected after (?+\0"
531
  "] is an invalid data character in JavaScript compatibility mode\0"
532
  /* 65 */
533
  "different names for subpatterns of the same number are not allowed\0"
534
  "(*MARK) must have an argument\0"
535
  "this version of PCRE is not compiled with Unicode property support\0"
536
#ifndef EBCDIC
537
  "\\c must be followed by an ASCII character\0"
538
#else
539
  "\\c must be followed by a letter or one of [\\]^_?\0"
540
#endif
541
  "\\k is not followed by a braced, angle-bracketed, or quoted name\0"
542
  /* 70 */
543
  "internal error: unknown opcode in find_fixedlength()\0"
544
  "\\N is not supported in a class\0"
545
  "too many forward references\0"
546
  "disallowed Unicode code point (>= 0xd800 && <= 0xdfff)\0"
547
  "invalid UTF-16 string\0"
548
  /* 75 */
549
  "name is too long in (*MARK), (*PRUNE), (*SKIP), or (*THEN)\0"
550
  "character value in \\u.... sequence is too large\0"
551
  "invalid UTF-32 string\0"
552
  "setting UTF is disabled by the application\0"
553
  "non-hex character in \\x{} (closing brace missing?)\0"
554
  /* 80 */
555
  "non-octal character in \\o{} (closing brace missing?)\0"
556
  "missing opening brace after \\o\0"
557
  "parentheses are too deeply nested\0"
558
  "invalid range in character class\0"
559
  "group name must start with a non-digit\0"
560
  /* 85 */
561
  "parentheses are too deeply nested (stack check)\0"
562
  "digits missing in \\x{} or \\o{}\0"
563
  "regular expression is too complicated\0"
564
  ;
565
566
/* Table to identify digits and hex digits. This is used when compiling
567
patterns. Note that the tables in chartables are dependent on the locale, and
568
may mark arbitrary characters as digits - but the PCRE compiling code expects
569
to handle only 0-9, a-z, and A-Z as digits when compiling. That is why we have
570
a private table here. It costs 256 bytes, but it is a lot faster than doing
571
character value tests (at least in some simple cases I timed), and in some
572
applications one wants PCRE to compile efficiently as well as match
573
efficiently.
574
575
For convenience, we use the same bit definitions as in chartables:
576
577
  0x04   decimal digit
578
  0x08   hexadecimal digit
579
580
Then we can use ctype_digit and ctype_xdigit in the code. */
581
582
/* Using a simple comparison for decimal numbers rather than a memory read
583
is much faster, and the resulting code is simpler (the compiler turns it
584
into a subtraction and unsigned comparison). */
585
586
321k
#define IS_DIGIT(x) ((x) >= CHAR_0 && (x) <= CHAR_9)
587
588
#ifndef EBCDIC
589
590
/* This is the "normal" case, for ASCII systems, and EBCDIC systems running in
591
UTF-8 mode. */
592
593
static const pcre_uint8 digitab[] =
594
  {
595
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*   0-  7 */
596
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*   8- 15 */
597
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  16- 23 */
598
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  24- 31 */
599
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*    - '  */
600
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  ( - /  */
601
  0x0c,0x0c,0x0c,0x0c,0x0c,0x0c,0x0c,0x0c, /*  0 - 7  */
602
  0x0c,0x0c,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  8 - ?  */
603
  0x00,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x00, /*  @ - G  */
604
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  H - O  */
605
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  P - W  */
606
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  X - _  */
607
  0x00,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x00, /*  ` - g  */
608
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  h - o  */
609
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  p - w  */
610
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  x -127 */
611
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 128-135 */
612
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 136-143 */
613
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 144-151 */
614
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 152-159 */
615
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 160-167 */
616
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 168-175 */
617
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 176-183 */
618
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 184-191 */
619
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 192-199 */
620
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 200-207 */
621
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 208-215 */
622
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 216-223 */
623
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 224-231 */
624
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 232-239 */
625
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 240-247 */
626
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00};/* 248-255 */
627
628
#else
629
630
/* This is the "abnormal" case, for EBCDIC systems not running in UTF-8 mode. */
631
632
static const pcre_uint8 digitab[] =
633
  {
634
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*   0-  7  0 */
635
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*   8- 15    */
636
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  16- 23 10 */
637
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  24- 31    */
638
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  32- 39 20 */
639
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  40- 47    */
640
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  48- 55 30 */
641
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  56- 63    */
642
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*    - 71 40 */
643
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  72- |     */
644
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  & - 87 50 */
645
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  88- 95    */
646
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  - -103 60 */
647
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 104- ?     */
648
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 112-119 70 */
649
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 120- "     */
650
  0x00,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x00, /* 128- g  80 */
651
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  h -143    */
652
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 144- p  90 */
653
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  q -159    */
654
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 160- x  A0 */
655
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  y -175    */
656
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  ^ -183 B0 */
657
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 184-191    */
658
  0x00,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x00, /*  { - G  C0 */
659
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  H -207    */
660
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  } - P  D0 */
661
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  Q -223    */
662
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  \ - X  E0 */
663
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  Y -239    */
664
  0x0c,0x0c,0x0c,0x0c,0x0c,0x0c,0x0c,0x0c, /*  0 - 7  F0 */
665
  0x0c,0x0c,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00};/*  8 -255    */
666
667
static const pcre_uint8 ebcdic_chartab[] = { /* chartable partial dup */
668
  0x80,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x01,0x00,0x00, /*   0-  7 */
669
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x01,0x01,0x00,0x00, /*   8- 15 */
670
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x01,0x00,0x00, /*  16- 23 */
671
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  24- 31 */
672
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x01,0x00,0x00, /*  32- 39 */
673
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  40- 47 */
674
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  48- 55 */
675
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  56- 63 */
676
  0x01,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*    - 71 */
677
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x80,0x00,0x80,0x80,0x80, /*  72- |  */
678
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  & - 87 */
679
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x80,0x80,0x80,0x00,0x00, /*  88- 95 */
680
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  - -103 */
681
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x10,0x00,0x80, /* 104- ?  */
682
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 112-119 */
683
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 120- "  */
684
  0x00,0x1a,0x1a,0x1a,0x1a,0x1a,0x1a,0x12, /* 128- g  */
685
  0x12,0x12,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  h -143 */
686
  0x00,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12, /* 144- p  */
687
  0x12,0x12,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  q -159 */
688
  0x00,0x00,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12, /* 160- x  */
689
  0x12,0x12,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  y -175 */
690
  0x80,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  ^ -183 */
691
  0x00,0x00,0x80,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 184-191 */
692
  0x80,0x1a,0x1a,0x1a,0x1a,0x1a,0x1a,0x12, /*  { - G  */
693
  0x12,0x12,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  H -207 */
694
  0x00,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12, /*  } - P  */
695
  0x12,0x12,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  Q -223 */
696
  0x00,0x00,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12, /*  \ - X  */
697
  0x12,0x12,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  Y -239 */
698
  0x1c,0x1c,0x1c,0x1c,0x1c,0x1c,0x1c,0x1c, /*  0 - 7  */
699
  0x1c,0x1c,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00};/*  8 -255 */
700
#endif
701
702
703
/* This table is used to check whether auto-possessification is possible
704
between adjacent character-type opcodes. The left-hand (repeated) opcode is
705
used to select the row, and the right-hand opcode is use to select the column.
706
A value of 1 means that auto-possessification is OK. For example, the second
707
value in the first row means that \D+\d can be turned into \D++\d.
708
709
The Unicode property types (\P and \p) have to be present to fill out the table
710
because of what their opcode values are, but the table values should always be
711
zero because property types are handled separately in the code. The last four
712
columns apply to items that cannot be repeated, so there is no need to have
713
rows for them. Note that OP_DIGIT etc. are generated only when PCRE_UCP is
714
*not* set. When it is set, \d etc. are converted into OP_(NOT_)PROP codes. */
715
716
#define APTROWS (LAST_AUTOTAB_LEFT_OP - FIRST_AUTOTAB_OP + 1)
717
#define APTCOLS (LAST_AUTOTAB_RIGHT_OP - FIRST_AUTOTAB_OP + 1)
718
719
static const pcre_uint8 autoposstab[APTROWS][APTCOLS] = {
720
/* \D \d \S \s \W \w  . .+ \C \P \p \R \H \h \V \v \X \Z \z  $ $M */
721
  { 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 },  /* \D */
722
  { 1, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 1, 0, 1, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1 },  /* \d */
723
  { 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 1, 0, 1, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1 },  /* \S */
724
  { 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 },  /* \s */
725
  { 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 },  /* \W */
726
  { 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 1, 0, 1, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1 },  /* \w */
727
  { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 },  /* .  */
728
  { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 },  /* .+ */
729
  { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 },  /* \C */
730
  { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0 },  /* \P */
731
  { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0 },  /* \p */
732
  { 0, 1, 0, 1, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 },  /* \R */
733
  { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 },  /* \H */
734
  { 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 },  /* \h */
735
  { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 },  /* \V */
736
  { 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 },  /* \v */
737
  { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 }   /* \X */
738
};
739
740
741
/* This table is used to check whether auto-possessification is possible
742
between adjacent Unicode property opcodes (OP_PROP and OP_NOTPROP). The
743
left-hand (repeated) opcode is used to select the row, and the right-hand
744
opcode is used to select the column. The values are as follows:
745
746
  0   Always return FALSE (never auto-possessify)
747
  1   Character groups are distinct (possessify if both are OP_PROP)
748
  2   Check character categories in the same group (general or particular)
749
  3   TRUE if the two opcodes are not the same (PROP vs NOTPROP)
750
751
  4   Check left general category vs right particular category
752
  5   Check right general category vs left particular category
753
754
  6   Left alphanum vs right general category
755
  7   Left space vs right general category
756
  8   Left word vs right general category
757
758
  9   Right alphanum vs left general category
759
 10   Right space vs left general category
760
 11   Right word vs left general category
761
762
 12   Left alphanum vs right particular category
763
 13   Left space vs right particular category
764
 14   Left word vs right particular category
765
766
 15   Right alphanum vs left particular category
767
 16   Right space vs left particular category
768
 17   Right word vs left particular category
769
*/
770
771
static const pcre_uint8 propposstab[PT_TABSIZE][PT_TABSIZE] = {
772
/* ANY LAMP GC  PC  SC ALNUM SPACE PXSPACE WORD CLIST UCNC */
773
  { 0,  0,  0,  0,  0,    0,    0,      0,   0,    0,   0 },  /* PT_ANY */
774
  { 0,  3,  0,  0,  0,    3,    1,      1,   0,    0,   0 },  /* PT_LAMP */
775
  { 0,  0,  2,  4,  0,    9,   10,     10,  11,    0,   0 },  /* PT_GC */
776
  { 0,  0,  5,  2,  0,   15,   16,     16,  17,    0,   0 },  /* PT_PC */
777
  { 0,  0,  0,  0,  2,    0,    0,      0,   0,    0,   0 },  /* PT_SC */
778
  { 0,  3,  6, 12,  0,    3,    1,      1,   0,    0,   0 },  /* PT_ALNUM */
779
  { 0,  1,  7, 13,  0,    1,    3,      3,   1,    0,   0 },  /* PT_SPACE */
780
  { 0,  1,  7, 13,  0,    1,    3,      3,   1,    0,   0 },  /* PT_PXSPACE */
781
  { 0,  0,  8, 14,  0,    0,    1,      1,   3,    0,   0 },  /* PT_WORD */
782
  { 0,  0,  0,  0,  0,    0,    0,      0,   0,    0,   0 },  /* PT_CLIST */
783
  { 0,  0,  0,  0,  0,    0,    0,      0,   0,    0,   3 }   /* PT_UCNC */
784
};
785
786
/* This table is used to check whether auto-possessification is possible
787
between adjacent Unicode property opcodes (OP_PROP and OP_NOTPROP) when one
788
specifies a general category and the other specifies a particular category. The
789
row is selected by the general category and the column by the particular
790
category. The value is 1 if the particular category is not part of the general
791
category. */
792
793
static const pcre_uint8 catposstab[7][30] = {
794
/* Cc Cf Cn Co Cs Ll Lm Lo Lt Lu Mc Me Mn Nd Nl No Pc Pd Pe Pf Pi Po Ps Sc Sk Sm So Zl Zp Zs */
795
  { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1 },  /* C */
796
  { 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1 },  /* L */
797
  { 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1 },  /* M */
798
  { 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1 },  /* N */
799
  { 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1 },  /* P */
800
  { 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1 },  /* S */
801
  { 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0 }   /* Z */
802
};
803
804
/* This table is used when checking ALNUM, (PX)SPACE, SPACE, and WORD against
805
a general or particular category. The properties in each row are those
806
that apply to the character set in question. Duplication means that a little
807
unnecessary work is done when checking, but this keeps things much simpler
808
because they can all use the same code. For more details see the comment where
809
this table is used.
810
811
Note: SPACE and PXSPACE used to be different because Perl excluded VT from
812
"space", but from Perl 5.18 it's included, so both categories are treated the
813
same here. */
814
815
static const pcre_uint8 posspropstab[3][4] = {
816
  { ucp_L, ucp_N, ucp_N, ucp_Nl },  /* ALNUM, 3rd and 4th values redundant */
817
  { ucp_Z, ucp_Z, ucp_C, ucp_Cc },  /* SPACE and PXSPACE, 2nd value redundant */
818
  { ucp_L, ucp_N, ucp_P, ucp_Po }   /* WORD */
819
};
820
821
/* This table is used when converting repeating opcodes into possessified
822
versions as a result of an explicit possessive quantifier such as ++. A zero
823
value means there is no possessified version - in those cases the item in
824
question must be wrapped in ONCE brackets. The table is truncated at OP_CALLOUT
825
because all relevant opcodes are less than that. */
826
827
static const pcre_uint8 opcode_possessify[] = {
828
  0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0,   /* 0 - 15  */
829
  0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0,   /* 16 - 31 */
830
831
  0,                       /* NOTI */
832
  OP_POSSTAR, 0,           /* STAR, MINSTAR */
833
  OP_POSPLUS, 0,           /* PLUS, MINPLUS */
834
  OP_POSQUERY, 0,          /* QUERY, MINQUERY */
835
  OP_POSUPTO, 0,           /* UPTO, MINUPTO */
836
  0,                       /* EXACT */
837
  0, 0, 0, 0,              /* POS{STAR,PLUS,QUERY,UPTO} */
838
839
  OP_POSSTARI, 0,          /* STARI, MINSTARI */
840
  OP_POSPLUSI, 0,          /* PLUSI, MINPLUSI */
841
  OP_POSQUERYI, 0,         /* QUERYI, MINQUERYI */
842
  OP_POSUPTOI, 0,          /* UPTOI, MINUPTOI */
843
  0,                       /* EXACTI */
844
  0, 0, 0, 0,              /* POS{STARI,PLUSI,QUERYI,UPTOI} */
845
846
  OP_NOTPOSSTAR, 0,        /* NOTSTAR, NOTMINSTAR */
847
  OP_NOTPOSPLUS, 0,        /* NOTPLUS, NOTMINPLUS */
848
  OP_NOTPOSQUERY, 0,       /* NOTQUERY, NOTMINQUERY */
849
  OP_NOTPOSUPTO, 0,        /* NOTUPTO, NOTMINUPTO */
850
  0,                       /* NOTEXACT */
851
  0, 0, 0, 0,              /* NOTPOS{STAR,PLUS,QUERY,UPTO} */
852
853
  OP_NOTPOSSTARI, 0,       /* NOTSTARI, NOTMINSTARI */
854
  OP_NOTPOSPLUSI, 0,       /* NOTPLUSI, NOTMINPLUSI */
855
  OP_NOTPOSQUERYI, 0,      /* NOTQUERYI, NOTMINQUERYI */
856
  OP_NOTPOSUPTOI, 0,       /* NOTUPTOI, NOTMINUPTOI */
857
  0,                       /* NOTEXACTI */
858
  0, 0, 0, 0,              /* NOTPOS{STARI,PLUSI,QUERYI,UPTOI} */
859
860
  OP_TYPEPOSSTAR, 0,       /* TYPESTAR, TYPEMINSTAR */
861
  OP_TYPEPOSPLUS, 0,       /* TYPEPLUS, TYPEMINPLUS */
862
  OP_TYPEPOSQUERY, 0,      /* TYPEQUERY, TYPEMINQUERY */
863
  OP_TYPEPOSUPTO, 0,       /* TYPEUPTO, TYPEMINUPTO */
864
  0,                       /* TYPEEXACT */
865
  0, 0, 0, 0,              /* TYPEPOS{STAR,PLUS,QUERY,UPTO} */
866
867
  OP_CRPOSSTAR, 0,         /* CRSTAR, CRMINSTAR */
868
  OP_CRPOSPLUS, 0,         /* CRPLUS, CRMINPLUS */
869
  OP_CRPOSQUERY, 0,        /* CRQUERY, CRMINQUERY */
870
  OP_CRPOSRANGE, 0,        /* CRRANGE, CRMINRANGE */
871
  0, 0, 0, 0,              /* CRPOS{STAR,PLUS,QUERY,RANGE} */
872
873
  0, 0, 0,                 /* CLASS, NCLASS, XCLASS */
874
  0, 0,                    /* REF, REFI */
875
  0, 0,                    /* DNREF, DNREFI */
876
  0, 0                     /* RECURSE, CALLOUT */
877
};
878
879
880
881
/*************************************************
882
*            Find an error text                  *
883
*************************************************/
884
885
/* The error texts are now all in one long string, to save on relocations. As
886
some of the text is of unknown length, we can't use a table of offsets.
887
Instead, just count through the strings. This is not a performance issue
888
because it happens only when there has been a compilation error.
889
890
Argument:   the error number
891
Returns:    pointer to the error string
892
*/
893
894
static const char *
895
find_error_text(int n)
896
4.46k
{
897
4.46k
const char *s = error_texts;
898
127k
for (; n > 0; n--)
899
123k
  {
900
4.22M
  while (*s++ != CHAR_NULL) {};
901
123k
  if (*s == CHAR_NULL) return "Error text not found (please report)";
902
123k
  }
903
4.46k
return s;
904
4.46k
}
905
906
907
908
/*************************************************
909
*           Expand the workspace                 *
910
*************************************************/
911
912
/* This function is called during the second compiling phase, if the number of
913
forward references fills the existing workspace, which is originally a block on
914
the stack. A larger block is obtained from malloc() unless the ultimate limit
915
has been reached or the increase will be rather small.
916
917
Argument: pointer to the compile data block
918
Returns:  0 if all went well, else an error number
919
*/
920
921
static int
922
expand_workspace(compile_data *cd)
923
34
{
924
34
pcre_uchar *newspace;
925
34
int newsize = cd->workspace_size * 2;
926
927
34
if (newsize > COMPILE_WORK_SIZE_MAX) newsize = COMPILE_WORK_SIZE_MAX;
928
34
if (cd->workspace_size >= COMPILE_WORK_SIZE_MAX ||
929
34
    newsize - cd->workspace_size < WORK_SIZE_SAFETY_MARGIN)
930
0
 return ERR72;
931
932
34
newspace = (PUBL(malloc))(IN_UCHARS(newsize));
933
34
if (newspace == NULL) return ERR21;
934
34
memcpy(newspace, cd->start_workspace, cd->workspace_size * sizeof(pcre_uchar));
935
34
cd->hwm = (pcre_uchar *)newspace + (cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace);
936
34
if (cd->workspace_size > COMPILE_WORK_SIZE)
937
6
  (PUBL(free))((void *)cd->start_workspace);
938
34
cd->start_workspace = newspace;
939
34
cd->workspace_size = newsize;
940
34
return 0;
941
34
}
942
943
944
945
/*************************************************
946
*            Check for counted repeat            *
947
*************************************************/
948
949
/* This function is called when a '{' is encountered in a place where it might
950
start a quantifier. It looks ahead to see if it really is a quantifier or not.
951
It is only a quantifier if it is one of the forms {ddd} {ddd,} or {ddd,ddd}
952
where the ddds are digits.
953
954
Arguments:
955
  p         pointer to the first char after '{'
956
957
Returns:    TRUE or FALSE
958
*/
959
960
static BOOL
961
is_counted_repeat(const pcre_uchar *p)
962
27.2k
{
963
27.2k
if (!IS_DIGIT(*p)) return FALSE;
964
19.3k
p++;
965
29.6k
while (IS_DIGIT(*p)) p++;
966
19.3k
if (*p == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) return TRUE;
967
968
8.02k
if (*p++ != CHAR_COMMA) return FALSE;
969
6.36k
if (*p == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) return TRUE;
970
971
5.22k
if (!IS_DIGIT(*p)) return FALSE;
972
4.15k
p++;
973
6.33k
while (IS_DIGIT(*p)) p++;
974
975
4.15k
return (*p == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET);
976
5.22k
}
977
978
979
980
/*************************************************
981
*            Handle escapes                      *
982
*************************************************/
983
984
/* This function is called when a \ has been encountered. It either returns a
985
positive value for a simple escape such as \n, or 0 for a data character which
986
will be placed in chptr. A backreference to group n is returned as negative n.
987
When UTF-8 is enabled, a positive value greater than 255 may be returned in
988
chptr. On entry, ptr is pointing at the \. On exit, it is on the final
989
character of the escape sequence.
990
991
Arguments:
992
  ptrptr         points to the pattern position pointer
993
  chptr          points to a returned data character
994
  errorcodeptr   points to the errorcode variable
995
  bracount       number of previous extracting brackets
996
  options        the options bits
997
  isclass        TRUE if inside a character class
998
999
Returns:         zero => a data character
1000
                 positive => a special escape sequence
1001
                 negative => a back reference
1002
                 on error, errorcodeptr is set
1003
*/
1004
1005
static int
1006
check_escape(const pcre_uchar **ptrptr, pcre_uint32 *chptr, int *errorcodeptr,
1007
  int bracount, int options, BOOL isclass)
1008
1.01M
{
1009
/* PCRE_UTF16 has the same value as PCRE_UTF8. */
1010
1.01M
BOOL utf = (options & PCRE_UTF8) != 0;
1011
1.01M
const pcre_uchar *ptr = *ptrptr + 1;
1012
1.01M
pcre_uint32 c;
1013
1.01M
int escape = 0;
1014
1.01M
int i;
1015
1016
1.01M
GETCHARINCTEST(c, ptr);           /* Get character value, increment pointer */
1017
1.01M
ptr--;                            /* Set pointer back to the last byte */
1018
1019
/* If backslash is at the end of the pattern, it's an error. */
1020
1021
1.01M
if (c == CHAR_NULL) *errorcodeptr = ERR1;
1022
1023
/* Non-alphanumerics are literals. For digits or letters, do an initial lookup
1024
in a table. A non-zero result is something that can be returned immediately.
1025
Otherwise further processing may be required. */
1026
1027
1.01M
#ifndef EBCDIC  /* ASCII/UTF-8 coding */
1028
/* Not alphanumeric */
1029
1.01M
else if (c < CHAR_0 || c > CHAR_z) {}
1030
932k
else if ((i = escapes[c - CHAR_0]) != 0)
1031
910k
  { if (i > 0) c = (pcre_uint32)i; else escape = -i; }
1032
1033
#else           /* EBCDIC coding */
1034
/* Not alphanumeric */
1035
else if (c < CHAR_a || (!MAX_255(c) || (ebcdic_chartab[c] & 0x0E) == 0)) {}
1036
else if ((i = escapes[c - 0x48]) != 0)  { if (i > 0) c = (pcre_uint32)i; else escape = -i; }
1037
#endif
1038
1039
/* Escapes that need further processing, or are illegal. */
1040
1041
21.8k
else
1042
21.8k
  {
1043
21.8k
  const pcre_uchar *oldptr;
1044
21.8k
  BOOL braced, negated, overflow;
1045
21.8k
  int s;
1046
1047
21.8k
  switch (c)
1048
21.8k
    {
1049
    /* A number of Perl escapes are not handled by PCRE. We give an explicit
1050
    error. */
1051
1052
1
    case CHAR_l:
1053
2
    case CHAR_L:
1054
2
    *errorcodeptr = ERR37;
1055
2
    break;
1056
1057
1
    case CHAR_u:
1058
1
    if ((options & PCRE_JAVASCRIPT_COMPAT) != 0)
1059
0
      {
1060
      /* In JavaScript, \u must be followed by four hexadecimal numbers.
1061
      Otherwise it is a lowercase u letter. */
1062
0
      if (MAX_255(ptr[1]) && (digitab[ptr[1]] & ctype_xdigit) != 0
1063
0
        && MAX_255(ptr[2]) && (digitab[ptr[2]] & ctype_xdigit) != 0
1064
0
        && MAX_255(ptr[3]) && (digitab[ptr[3]] & ctype_xdigit) != 0
1065
0
        && MAX_255(ptr[4]) && (digitab[ptr[4]] & ctype_xdigit) != 0)
1066
0
        {
1067
0
        c = 0;
1068
0
        for (i = 0; i < 4; ++i)
1069
0
          {
1070
0
          register pcre_uint32 cc = *(++ptr);
1071
0
#ifndef EBCDIC  /* ASCII/UTF-8 coding */
1072
0
          if (cc >= CHAR_a) cc -= 32;               /* Convert to upper case */
1073
0
          c = (c << 4) + cc - ((cc < CHAR_A)? CHAR_0 : (CHAR_A - 10));
1074
#else           /* EBCDIC coding */
1075
          if (cc >= CHAR_a && cc <= CHAR_z) cc += 64;  /* Convert to upper case */
1076
          c = (c << 4) + cc - ((cc >= CHAR_0)? CHAR_0 : (CHAR_A - 10));
1077
#endif
1078
0
          }
1079
1080
0
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE8
1081
0
        if (c > (utf ? 0x10ffffU : 0xffU))
1082
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16
1083
        if (c > (utf ? 0x10ffffU : 0xffffU))
1084
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32
1085
        if (utf && c > 0x10ffffU)
1086
#endif
1087
0
          {
1088
0
          *errorcodeptr = ERR76;
1089
0
          }
1090
0
        else if (utf && c >= 0xd800 && c <= 0xdfff) *errorcodeptr = ERR73;
1091
0
        }
1092
0
      }
1093
1
    else
1094
1
      *errorcodeptr = ERR37;
1095
1
    break;
1096
1097
2
    case CHAR_U:
1098
    /* In JavaScript, \U is an uppercase U letter. */
1099
2
    if ((options & PCRE_JAVASCRIPT_COMPAT) == 0) *errorcodeptr = ERR37;
1100
2
    break;
1101
1102
    /* In a character class, \g is just a literal "g". Outside a character
1103
    class, \g must be followed by one of a number of specific things:
1104
1105
    (1) A number, either plain or braced. If positive, it is an absolute
1106
    backreference. If negative, it is a relative backreference. This is a Perl
1107
    5.10 feature.
1108
1109
    (2) Perl 5.10 also supports \g{name} as a reference to a named group. This
1110
    is part of Perl's movement towards a unified syntax for back references. As
1111
    this is synonymous with \k{name}, we fudge it up by pretending it really
1112
    was \k.
1113
1114
    (3) For Oniguruma compatibility we also support \g followed by a name or a
1115
    number either in angle brackets or in single quotes. However, these are
1116
    (possibly recursive) subroutine calls, _not_ backreferences. Just return
1117
    the ESC_g code (cf \k). */
1118
1119
4.45k
    case CHAR_g:
1120
4.45k
    if (isclass) break;
1121
4.19k
    if (ptr[1] == CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN || ptr[1] == CHAR_APOSTROPHE)
1122
1.86k
      {
1123
1.86k
      escape = ESC_g;
1124
1.86k
      break;
1125
1.86k
      }
1126
1127
    /* Handle the Perl-compatible cases */
1128
1129
2.33k
    if (ptr[1] == CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET)
1130
665
      {
1131
665
      const pcre_uchar *p;
1132
1.31k
      for (p = ptr+2; *p != CHAR_NULL && *p != CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET; p++)
1133
1.08k
        if (*p != CHAR_MINUS && !IS_DIGIT(*p)) break;
1134
665
      if (*p != CHAR_NULL && *p != CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET)
1135
430
        {
1136
430
        escape = ESC_k;
1137
430
        break;
1138
430
        }
1139
235
      braced = TRUE;
1140
235
      ptr++;
1141
235
      }
1142
1.66k
    else braced = FALSE;
1143
1144
1.90k
    if (ptr[1] == CHAR_MINUS)
1145
446
      {
1146
446
      negated = TRUE;
1147
446
      ptr++;
1148
446
      }
1149
1.45k
    else negated = FALSE;
1150
1151
    /* The integer range is limited by the machine's int representation. */
1152
1.90k
    s = 0;
1153
1.90k
    overflow = FALSE;
1154
6.34k
    while (IS_DIGIT(ptr[1]))
1155
4.45k
      {
1156
4.45k
      if (s > INT_MAX / 10 - 1) /* Integer overflow */
1157
11
        {
1158
11
        overflow = TRUE;
1159
11
        break;
1160
11
        }
1161
4.44k
      s = s * 10 + (int)(*(++ptr) - CHAR_0);
1162
4.44k
      }
1163
1.90k
    if (overflow) /* Integer overflow */
1164
11
      {
1165
221
      while (IS_DIGIT(ptr[1]))
1166
210
        ptr++;
1167
11
      *errorcodeptr = ERR61;
1168
11
      break;
1169
11
      }
1170
1171
1.88k
    if (braced && *(++ptr) != CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET)
1172
13
      {
1173
13
      *errorcodeptr = ERR57;
1174
13
      break;
1175
13
      }
1176
1177
1.87k
    if (s == 0)
1178
30
      {
1179
30
      *errorcodeptr = ERR58;
1180
30
      break;
1181
30
      }
1182
1183
1.84k
    if (negated)
1184
434
      {
1185
434
      if (s > bracount)
1186
43
        {
1187
43
        *errorcodeptr = ERR15;
1188
43
        break;
1189
43
        }
1190
391
      s = bracount - (s - 1);
1191
391
      }
1192
1193
1.80k
    escape = -s;
1194
1.80k
    break;
1195
1196
    /* The handling of escape sequences consisting of a string of digits
1197
    starting with one that is not zero is not straightforward. Perl has changed
1198
    over the years. Nowadays \g{} for backreferences and \o{} for octal are
1199
    recommended to avoid the ambiguities in the old syntax.
1200
1201
    Outside a character class, the digits are read as a decimal number. If the
1202
    number is less than 8 (used to be 10), or if there are that many previous
1203
    extracting left brackets, then it is a back reference. Otherwise, up to
1204
    three octal digits are read to form an escaped byte. Thus \123 is likely to
1205
    be octal 123 (cf \0123, which is octal 012 followed by the literal 3). If
1206
    the octal value is greater than 377, the least significant 8 bits are
1207
    taken. \8 and \9 are treated as the literal characters 8 and 9.
1208
1209
    Inside a character class, \ followed by a digit is always either a literal
1210
    8 or 9 or an octal number. */
1211
1212
6.98k
    case CHAR_1: case CHAR_2: case CHAR_3: case CHAR_4: case CHAR_5:
1213
9.13k
    case CHAR_6: case CHAR_7: case CHAR_8: case CHAR_9:
1214
1215
9.13k
    if (!isclass)
1216
8.15k
      {
1217
8.15k
      oldptr = ptr;
1218
      /* The integer range is limited by the machine's int representation. */
1219
8.15k
      s = (int)(c -CHAR_0);
1220
8.15k
      overflow = FALSE;
1221
12.3k
      while (IS_DIGIT(ptr[1]))
1222
4.23k
        {
1223
4.23k
        if (s > INT_MAX / 10 - 1) /* Integer overflow */
1224
17
          {
1225
17
          overflow = TRUE;
1226
17
          break;
1227
17
          }
1228
4.21k
        s = s * 10 + (int)(*(++ptr) - CHAR_0);
1229
4.21k
        }
1230
8.15k
      if (overflow) /* Integer overflow */
1231
17
        {
1232
221
        while (IS_DIGIT(ptr[1]))
1233
204
          ptr++;
1234
17
        *errorcodeptr = ERR61;
1235
17
        break;
1236
17
        }
1237
8.14k
      if (s < 8 || s <= bracount)  /* Check for back reference */
1238
6.69k
        {
1239
6.69k
        escape = -s;
1240
6.69k
        break;
1241
6.69k
        }
1242
1.45k
      ptr = oldptr;      /* Put the pointer back and fall through */
1243
1.45k
      }
1244
1245
    /* Handle a digit following \ when the number is not a back reference. If
1246
    the first digit is 8 or 9, Perl used to generate a binary zero byte and
1247
    then treat the digit as a following literal. At least by Perl 5.18 this
1248
    changed so as not to insert the binary zero. */
1249
1250
2.42k
    if ((c = *ptr) >= CHAR_8) break;
1251
1252
    /* Fall through with a digit less than 8 */
1253
1254
    /* \0 always starts an octal number, but we may drop through to here with a
1255
    larger first octal digit. The original code used just to take the least
1256
    significant 8 bits of octal numbers (I think this is what early Perls used
1257
    to do). Nowadays we allow for larger numbers in UTF-8 mode and 16-bit mode,
1258
    but no more than 3 octal digits. */
1259
1260
2.03k
    case CHAR_0:
1261
2.03k
    c -= CHAR_0;
1262
3.79k
    while(i++ < 2 && ptr[1] >= CHAR_0 && ptr[1] <= CHAR_7)
1263
1.75k
        c = c * 8 + *(++ptr) - CHAR_0;
1264
2.03k
#ifdef COMPILE_PCRE8
1265
2.03k
    if (!utf && c > 0xff) *errorcodeptr = ERR51;
1266
2.03k
#endif
1267
2.03k
    break;
1268
1269
    /* \o is a relatively new Perl feature, supporting a more general way of
1270
    specifying character codes in octal. The only supported form is \o{ddd}. */
1271
1272
455
    case CHAR_o:
1273
455
    if (ptr[1] != CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET) *errorcodeptr = ERR81; else
1274
444
    if (ptr[2] == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) *errorcodeptr = ERR86; else
1275
443
      {
1276
443
      ptr += 2;
1277
443
      c = 0;
1278
443
      overflow = FALSE;
1279
1.51k
      while (*ptr >= CHAR_0 && *ptr <= CHAR_7)
1280
1.09k
        {
1281
1.09k
        register pcre_uint32 cc = *ptr++;
1282
1.09k
        if (c == 0 && cc == CHAR_0) continue;     /* Leading zeroes */
1283
#ifdef COMPILE_PCRE32
1284
        if (c >= 0x20000000l) { overflow = TRUE; break; }
1285
#endif
1286
747
        c = (c << 3) + cc - CHAR_0 ;
1287
747
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE8
1288
747
        if (c > (utf ? 0x10ffffU : 0xffU)) { overflow = TRUE; break; }
1289
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16
1290
        if (c > (utf ? 0x10ffffU : 0xffffU)) { overflow = TRUE; break; }
1291
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32
1292
        if (utf && c > 0x10ffffU) { overflow = TRUE; break; }
1293
#endif
1294
747
        }
1295
443
      if (overflow)
1296
24
        {
1297
226
        while (*ptr >= CHAR_0 && *ptr <= CHAR_7) ptr++;
1298
24
        *errorcodeptr = ERR34;
1299
24
        }
1300
419
      else if (*ptr == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET)
1301
400
        {
1302
400
        if (utf && c >= 0xd800 && c <= 0xdfff) *errorcodeptr = ERR73;
1303
400
        }
1304
19
      else *errorcodeptr = ERR80;
1305
443
      }
1306
455
    break;
1307
1308
    /* \x is complicated. In JavaScript, \x must be followed by two hexadecimal
1309
    numbers. Otherwise it is a lowercase x letter. */
1310
1311
6.30k
    case CHAR_x:
1312
6.30k
    if ((options & PCRE_JAVASCRIPT_COMPAT) != 0)
1313
0
      {
1314
0
      if (MAX_255(ptr[1]) && (digitab[ptr[1]] & ctype_xdigit) != 0
1315
0
        && MAX_255(ptr[2]) && (digitab[ptr[2]] & ctype_xdigit) != 0)
1316
0
        {
1317
0
        c = 0;
1318
0
        for (i = 0; i < 2; ++i)
1319
0
          {
1320
0
          register pcre_uint32 cc = *(++ptr);
1321
0
#ifndef EBCDIC  /* ASCII/UTF-8 coding */
1322
0
          if (cc >= CHAR_a) cc -= 32;               /* Convert to upper case */
1323
0
          c = (c << 4) + cc - ((cc < CHAR_A)? CHAR_0 : (CHAR_A - 10));
1324
#else           /* EBCDIC coding */
1325
          if (cc >= CHAR_a && cc <= CHAR_z) cc += 64;  /* Convert to upper case */
1326
          c = (c << 4) + cc - ((cc >= CHAR_0)? CHAR_0 : (CHAR_A - 10));
1327
#endif
1328
0
          }
1329
0
        }
1330
0
      }    /* End JavaScript handling */
1331
1332
    /* Handle \x in Perl's style. \x{ddd} is a character number which can be
1333
    greater than 0xff in utf or non-8bit mode, but only if the ddd are hex
1334
    digits. If not, { used to be treated as a data character. However, Perl
1335
    seems to read hex digits up to the first non-such, and ignore the rest, so
1336
    that, for example \x{zz} matches a binary zero. This seems crazy, so PCRE
1337
    now gives an error. */
1338
1339
6.30k
    else
1340
6.30k
      {
1341
6.30k
      if (ptr[1] == CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET)
1342
432
        {
1343
432
        ptr += 2;
1344
432
        if (*ptr == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET)
1345
1
          {
1346
1
          *errorcodeptr = ERR86;
1347
1
          break;
1348
1
          }
1349
431
        c = 0;
1350
431
        overflow = FALSE;
1351
1.41k
        while (MAX_255(*ptr) && (digitab[*ptr] & ctype_xdigit) != 0)
1352
1.00k
          {
1353
1.00k
          register pcre_uint32 cc = *ptr++;
1354
1.00k
          if (c == 0 && cc == CHAR_0) continue;     /* Leading zeroes */
1355
1356
#ifdef COMPILE_PCRE32
1357
          if (c >= 0x10000000l) { overflow = TRUE; break; }
1358
#endif
1359
1360
808
#ifndef EBCDIC  /* ASCII/UTF-8 coding */
1361
808
          if (cc >= CHAR_a) cc -= 32;               /* Convert to upper case */
1362
808
          c = (c << 4) + cc - ((cc < CHAR_A)? CHAR_0 : (CHAR_A - 10));
1363
#else           /* EBCDIC coding */
1364
          if (cc >= CHAR_a && cc <= CHAR_z) cc += 64;  /* Convert to upper case */
1365
          c = (c << 4) + cc - ((cc >= CHAR_0)? CHAR_0 : (CHAR_A - 10));
1366
#endif
1367
1368
808
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE8
1369
808
          if (c > (utf ? 0x10ffffU : 0xffU)) { overflow = TRUE; break; }
1370
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16
1371
          if (c > (utf ? 0x10ffffU : 0xffffU)) { overflow = TRUE; break; }
1372
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32
1373
          if (utf && c > 0x10ffffU) { overflow = TRUE; break; }
1374
#endif
1375
808
          }
1376
1377
431
        if (overflow)
1378
16
          {
1379
170
          while (MAX_255(*ptr) && (digitab[*ptr] & ctype_xdigit) != 0) ptr++;
1380
16
          *errorcodeptr = ERR34;
1381
16
          }
1382
1383
415
        else if (*ptr == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET)
1384
392
          {
1385
392
          if (utf && c >= 0xd800 && c <= 0xdfff) *errorcodeptr = ERR73;
1386
392
          }
1387
1388
        /* If the sequence of hex digits does not end with '}', give an error.
1389
        We used just to recognize this construct and fall through to the normal
1390
        \x handling, but nowadays Perl gives an error, which seems much more
1391
        sensible, so we do too. */
1392
1393
23
        else *errorcodeptr = ERR79;
1394
431
        }   /* End of \x{} processing */
1395
1396
      /* Read a single-byte hex-defined char (up to two hex digits after \x) */
1397
1398
5.87k
      else
1399
5.87k
        {
1400
5.87k
        c = 0;
1401
11.7k
        while (i++ < 2 && MAX_255(ptr[1]) && (digitab[ptr[1]] & ctype_xdigit) != 0)
1402
5.89k
          {
1403
5.89k
          pcre_uint32 cc;                          /* Some compilers don't like */
1404
5.89k
          cc = *(++ptr);                           /* ++ in initializers */
1405
5.89k
#ifndef EBCDIC  /* ASCII/UTF-8 coding */
1406
5.89k
          if (cc >= CHAR_a) cc -= 32;              /* Convert to upper case */
1407
5.89k
          c = c * 16 + cc - ((cc < CHAR_A)? CHAR_0 : (CHAR_A - 10));
1408
#else           /* EBCDIC coding */
1409
          if (cc <= CHAR_z) cc += 64;              /* Convert to upper case */
1410
          c = c * 16 + cc - ((cc >= CHAR_0)? CHAR_0 : (CHAR_A - 10));
1411
#endif
1412
5.89k
          }
1413
5.87k
        }     /* End of \xdd handling */
1414
6.30k
      }       /* End of Perl-style \x handling */
1415
6.30k
    break;
1416
1417
    /* For \c, a following letter is upper-cased; then the 0x40 bit is flipped.
1418
    An error is given if the byte following \c is not an ASCII character. This
1419
    coding is ASCII-specific, but then the whole concept of \cx is
1420
    ASCII-specific. (However, an EBCDIC equivalent has now been added.) */
1421
1422
6.30k
    case CHAR_c:
1423
633
    c = *(++ptr);
1424
633
    if (c == CHAR_NULL)
1425
1
      {
1426
1
      *errorcodeptr = ERR2;
1427
1
      break;
1428
1
      }
1429
632
#ifndef EBCDIC    /* ASCII/UTF-8 coding */
1430
632
    if (c > 127)  /* Excludes all non-ASCII in either mode */
1431
8
      {
1432
8
      *errorcodeptr = ERR68;
1433
8
      break;
1434
8
      }
1435
624
    if (c >= CHAR_a && c <= CHAR_z) c -= 32;
1436
624
    c ^= 0x40;
1437
#else             /* EBCDIC coding */
1438
    if (c >= CHAR_a && c <= CHAR_z) c += 64;
1439
    if (c == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK)
1440
      c = ('\\' == 188 && '`' == 74)? 0x5f : 0xff;
1441
    else
1442
      {
1443
      for (i = 0; i < 32; i++)
1444
        {
1445
        if (c == ebcdic_escape_c[i]) break;
1446
        }
1447
      if (i < 32) c = i; else *errorcodeptr = ERR68;
1448
      }
1449
#endif
1450
624
    break;
1451
1452
    /* PCRE_EXTRA enables extensions to Perl in the matter of escapes. Any
1453
    other alphanumeric following \ is an error if PCRE_EXTRA was set;
1454
    otherwise, for Perl compatibility, it is a literal. This code looks a bit
1455
    odd, but there used to be some cases other than the default, and there may
1456
    be again in future, so I haven't "optimized" it. */
1457
1458
493
    default:
1459
493
    if ((options & PCRE_EXTRA) != 0) switch(c)
1460
1
      {
1461
1
      default:
1462
1
      *errorcodeptr = ERR3;
1463
1
      break;
1464
1
      }
1465
493
    break;
1466
21.8k
    }
1467
21.8k
  }
1468
1469
/* Perl supports \N{name} for character names, as well as plain \N for "not
1470
newline". PCRE does not support \N{name}. However, it does support
1471
quantification such as \N{2,3}. */
1472
1473
1.01M
if (escape == ESC_N && ptr[1] == CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET &&
1474
365
     !is_counted_repeat(ptr+2))
1475
1
  *errorcodeptr = ERR37;
1476
1477
/* If PCRE_UCP is set, we change the values for \d etc. */
1478
1479
1.01M
if ((options & PCRE_UCP) != 0 && escape >= ESC_D && escape <= ESC_w)
1480
0
  escape += (ESC_DU - ESC_D);
1481
1482
/* Set the pointer to the final character before returning. */
1483
1484
1.01M
*ptrptr = ptr;
1485
1.01M
*chptr = c;
1486
1.01M
return escape;
1487
1.01M
}
1488
1489
1490
1491
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
1492
/*************************************************
1493
*               Handle \P and \p                 *
1494
*************************************************/
1495
1496
/* This function is called after \P or \p has been encountered, provided that
1497
PCRE is compiled with support for Unicode properties. On entry, ptrptr is
1498
pointing at the P or p. On exit, it is pointing at the final character of the
1499
escape sequence.
1500
1501
Argument:
1502
  ptrptr         points to the pattern position pointer
1503
  negptr         points to a boolean that is set TRUE for negation else FALSE
1504
  ptypeptr       points to an unsigned int that is set to the type value
1505
  pdataptr       points to an unsigned int that is set to the detailed property value
1506
  errorcodeptr   points to the error code variable
1507
1508
Returns:         TRUE if the type value was found, or FALSE for an invalid type
1509
*/
1510
1511
static BOOL
1512
get_ucp(const pcre_uchar **ptrptr, BOOL *negptr, unsigned int *ptypeptr,
1513
  unsigned int *pdataptr, int *errorcodeptr)
1514
{
1515
pcre_uchar c;
1516
int i, bot, top;
1517
const pcre_uchar *ptr = *ptrptr;
1518
pcre_uchar name[32];
1519
1520
c = *(++ptr);
1521
if (c == CHAR_NULL) goto ERROR_RETURN;
1522
1523
*negptr = FALSE;
1524
1525
/* \P or \p can be followed by a name in {}, optionally preceded by ^ for
1526
negation. */
1527
1528
if (c == CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET)
1529
  {
1530
  if (ptr[1] == CHAR_CIRCUMFLEX_ACCENT)
1531
    {
1532
    *negptr = TRUE;
1533
    ptr++;
1534
    }
1535
  for (i = 0; i < (int)(sizeof(name) / sizeof(pcre_uchar)) - 1; i++)
1536
    {
1537
    c = *(++ptr);
1538
    if (c == CHAR_NULL) goto ERROR_RETURN;
1539
    if (c == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) break;
1540
    name[i] = c;
1541
    }
1542
  if (c != CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) goto ERROR_RETURN;
1543
  name[i] = 0;
1544
  }
1545
1546
/* Otherwise there is just one following character */
1547
1548
else
1549
  {
1550
  name[0] = c;
1551
  name[1] = 0;
1552
  }
1553
1554
*ptrptr = ptr;
1555
1556
/* Search for a recognized property name using binary chop */
1557
1558
bot = 0;
1559
top = PRIV(utt_size);
1560
1561
while (bot < top)
1562
  {
1563
  int r;
1564
  i = (bot + top) >> 1;
1565
  r = STRCMP_UC_C8(name, PRIV(utt_names) + PRIV(utt)[i].name_offset);
1566
  if (r == 0)
1567
    {
1568
    *ptypeptr = PRIV(utt)[i].type;
1569
    *pdataptr = PRIV(utt)[i].value;
1570
    return TRUE;
1571
    }
1572
  if (r > 0) bot = i + 1; else top = i;
1573
  }
1574
1575
*errorcodeptr = ERR47;
1576
*ptrptr = ptr;
1577
return FALSE;
1578
1579
ERROR_RETURN:
1580
*errorcodeptr = ERR46;
1581
*ptrptr = ptr;
1582
return FALSE;
1583
}
1584
#endif
1585
1586
1587
1588
/*************************************************
1589
*         Read repeat counts                     *
1590
*************************************************/
1591
1592
/* Read an item of the form {n,m} and return the values. This is called only
1593
after is_counted_repeat() has confirmed that a repeat-count quantifier exists,
1594
so the syntax is guaranteed to be correct, but we need to check the values.
1595
1596
Arguments:
1597
  p              pointer to first char after '{'
1598
  minp           pointer to int for min
1599
  maxp           pointer to int for max
1600
                 returned as -1 if no max
1601
  errorcodeptr   points to error code variable
1602
1603
Returns:         pointer to '}' on success;
1604
                 current ptr on error, with errorcodeptr set non-zero
1605
*/
1606
1607
static const pcre_uchar *
1608
read_repeat_counts(const pcre_uchar *p, int *minp, int *maxp, int *errorcodeptr)
1609
15.6k
{
1610
15.6k
int min = 0;
1611
15.6k
int max = -1;
1612
1613
39.0k
while (IS_DIGIT(*p))
1614
23.4k
  {
1615
23.4k
  min = min * 10 + (int)(*p++ - CHAR_0);
1616
23.4k
  if (min > 65535)
1617
1
    {
1618
1
    *errorcodeptr = ERR5;
1619
1
    return p;
1620
1
    }
1621
23.4k
  }
1622
1623
15.6k
if (*p == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) max = min; else
1624
4.60k
  {
1625
4.60k
  if (*(++p) != CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET)
1626
3.49k
    {
1627
3.49k
    max = 0;
1628
8.76k
    while(IS_DIGIT(*p))
1629
5.27k
      {
1630
5.27k
      max = max * 10 + (int)(*p++ - CHAR_0);
1631
5.27k
      if (max > 65535)
1632
1
        {
1633
1
        *errorcodeptr = ERR5;
1634
1
        return p;
1635
1
        }
1636
5.27k
      }
1637
3.49k
    if (max < min)
1638
2
      {
1639
2
      *errorcodeptr = ERR4;
1640
2
      return p;
1641
2
      }
1642
3.49k
    }
1643
4.60k
  }
1644
1645
15.6k
*minp = min;
1646
15.6k
*maxp = max;
1647
15.6k
return p;
1648
15.6k
}
1649
1650
1651
1652
/*************************************************
1653
*      Find first significant op code            *
1654
*************************************************/
1655
1656
/* This is called by several functions that scan a compiled expression looking
1657
for a fixed first character, or an anchoring op code etc. It skips over things
1658
that do not influence this. For some calls, it makes sense to skip negative
1659
forward and all backward assertions, and also the \b assertion; for others it
1660
does not.
1661
1662
Arguments:
1663
  code         pointer to the start of the group
1664
  skipassert   TRUE if certain assertions are to be skipped
1665
1666
Returns:       pointer to the first significant opcode
1667
*/
1668
1669
static const pcre_uchar*
1670
first_significant_code(const pcre_uchar *code, BOOL skipassert)
1671
11.1M
{
1672
11.1M
for (;;)
1673
11.1M
  {
1674
11.1M
  switch ((int)*code)
1675
11.1M
    {
1676
1.07k
    case OP_ASSERT_NOT:
1677
2.38k
    case OP_ASSERTBACK:
1678
4.61k
    case OP_ASSERTBACK_NOT:
1679
4.61k
    if (!skipassert) return code;
1680
4.36k
    do code += GET(code, 1); while (*code == OP_ALT);
1681
3.37k
    code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[*code];
1682
3.37k
    break;
1683
1684
583
    case OP_WORD_BOUNDARY:
1685
1.14k
    case OP_NOT_WORD_BOUNDARY:
1686
1.14k
    if (!skipassert) return code;
1687
    /* Fall through */
1688
1689
2.45k
    case OP_CALLOUT:
1690
2.69k
    case OP_CREF:
1691
3.44k
    case OP_DNCREF:
1692
4.71k
    case OP_RREF:
1693
4.95k
    case OP_DNRREF:
1694
5.16k
    case OP_DEF:
1695
5.16k
    code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[*code];
1696
5.16k
    break;
1697
1698
11.1M
    default:
1699
11.1M
    return code;
1700
11.1M
    }
1701
11.1M
  }
1702
/* Control never reaches here */
1703
11.1M
}
1704
1705
1706
1707
/*************************************************
1708
*        Find the fixed length of a branch       *
1709
*************************************************/
1710
1711
/* Scan a branch and compute the fixed length of subject that will match it,
1712
if the length is fixed. This is needed for dealing with backward assertions.
1713
In UTF8 mode, the result is in characters rather than bytes. The branch is
1714
temporarily terminated with OP_END when this function is called.
1715
1716
This function is called when a backward assertion is encountered, so that if it
1717
fails, the error message can point to the correct place in the pattern.
1718
However, we cannot do this when the assertion contains subroutine calls,
1719
because they can be forward references. We solve this by remembering this case
1720
and doing the check at the end; a flag specifies which mode we are running in.
1721
1722
Arguments:
1723
  code     points to the start of the pattern (the bracket)
1724
  utf      TRUE in UTF-8 / UTF-16 / UTF-32 mode
1725
  atend    TRUE if called when the pattern is complete
1726
  cd       the "compile data" structure
1727
  recurses    chain of recurse_check to catch mutual recursion
1728
1729
Returns:   the fixed length,
1730
             or -1 if there is no fixed length,
1731
             or -2 if \C was encountered (in UTF-8 mode only)
1732
             or -3 if an OP_RECURSE item was encountered and atend is FALSE
1733
             or -4 if an unknown opcode was encountered (internal error)
1734
*/
1735
1736
static int
1737
find_fixedlength(pcre_uchar *code, BOOL utf, BOOL atend, compile_data *cd,
1738
  recurse_check *recurses)
1739
132M
{
1740
132M
int length = -1;
1741
132M
recurse_check this_recurse;
1742
132M
register int branchlength = 0;
1743
132M
register pcre_uchar *cc = code + 1 + LINK_SIZE;
1744
1745
/* Scan along the opcodes for this branch. If we get to the end of the
1746
branch, check the length against that of the other branches. */
1747
1748
132M
for (;;)
1749
670M
  {
1750
670M
  int d;
1751
670M
  pcre_uchar *ce, *cs;
1752
670M
  register pcre_uchar op = *cc;
1753
1754
670M
  switch (op)
1755
670M
    {
1756
    /* We only need to continue for OP_CBRA (normal capturing bracket) and
1757
    OP_BRA (normal non-capturing bracket) because the other variants of these
1758
    opcodes are all concerned with unlimited repeated groups, which of course
1759
    are not of fixed length. */
1760
1761
131M
    case OP_CBRA:
1762
131M
    case OP_BRA:
1763
131M
    case OP_ONCE:
1764
131M
    case OP_ONCE_NC:
1765
131M
    case OP_COND:
1766
131M
    d = find_fixedlength(cc + ((op == OP_CBRA)? IMM2_SIZE : 0), utf, atend, cd,
1767
131M
      recurses);
1768
131M
    if (d < 0) return d;
1769
131M
    branchlength += d;
1770
131M
    do cc += GET(cc, 1); while (*cc == OP_ALT);
1771
131M
    cc += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
1772
131M
    break;
1773
1774
    /* Reached end of a branch; if it's a ket it is the end of a nested call.
1775
    If it's ALT it is an alternation in a nested call. An ACCEPT is effectively
1776
    an ALT. If it is END it's the end of the outer call. All can be handled by
1777
    the same code. Note that we must not include the OP_KETRxxx opcodes here,
1778
    because they all imply an unlimited repeat. */
1779
1780
3.29k
    case OP_ALT:
1781
132M
    case OP_KET:
1782
132M
    case OP_END:
1783
132M
    case OP_ACCEPT:
1784
132M
    case OP_ASSERT_ACCEPT:
1785
132M
    if (length < 0) length = branchlength;
1786
3.25k
      else if (length != branchlength) return -1;
1787
132M
    if (*cc != OP_ALT) return length;
1788
3.29k
    cc += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
1789
3.29k
    branchlength = 0;
1790
3.29k
    break;
1791
1792
    /* A true recursion implies not fixed length, but a subroutine call may
1793
    be OK. If the subroutine is a forward reference, we can't deal with
1794
    it until the end of the pattern, so return -3. */
1795
1796
340k
    case OP_RECURSE:
1797
340k
    if (!atend) return -3;
1798
340k
    cs = ce = (pcre_uchar *)cd->start_code + GET(cc, 1);  /* Start subpattern */
1799
343k
    do ce += GET(ce, 1); while (*ce == OP_ALT);           /* End subpattern */
1800
340k
    if (cc > cs && cc < ce) return -1;                    /* Recursion */
1801
340k
    else   /* Check for mutual recursion */
1802
340k
      {
1803
340k
      recurse_check *r = recurses;
1804
365k
      for (r = recurses; r != NULL; r = r->prev) if (r->group == cs) break;
1805
340k
      if (r != NULL) return -1;   /* Mutual recursion */
1806
340k
      }
1807
340k
    this_recurse.prev = recurses;
1808
340k
    this_recurse.group = cs;
1809
340k
    d = find_fixedlength(cs + IMM2_SIZE, utf, atend, cd, &this_recurse);
1810
340k
    if (d < 0) return d;
1811
339k
    branchlength += d;
1812
339k
    cc += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
1813
339k
    break;
1814
1815
    /* Skip over assertive subpatterns */
1816
1817
316
    case OP_ASSERT:
1818
2.12k
    case OP_ASSERT_NOT:
1819
3.19k
    case OP_ASSERTBACK:
1820
3.78k
    case OP_ASSERTBACK_NOT:
1821
5.59k
    do cc += GET(cc, 1); while (*cc == OP_ALT);
1822
3.78k
    cc += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
1823
3.78k
    break;
1824
1825
    /* Skip over things that don't match chars */
1826
1827
1.01k
    case OP_MARK:
1828
1.39k
    case OP_PRUNE_ARG:
1829
1.91k
    case OP_SKIP_ARG:
1830
3.51k
    case OP_THEN_ARG:
1831
3.51k
    cc += cc[1] + PRIV(OP_lengths)[*cc];
1832
3.51k
    break;
1833
1834
572
    case OP_CALLOUT:
1835
2.89k
    case OP_CIRC:
1836
3.31k
    case OP_CIRCM:
1837
5.05k
    case OP_CLOSE:
1838
5.25k
    case OP_COMMIT:
1839
5.62k
    case OP_CREF:
1840
5.83k
    case OP_DEF:
1841
5.93k
    case OP_DNCREF:
1842
7.02k
    case OP_DNRREF:
1843
5.24M
    case OP_DOLL:
1844
5.24M
    case OP_DOLLM:
1845
5.24M
    case OP_EOD:
1846
5.24M
    case OP_EODN:
1847
5.24M
    case OP_FAIL:
1848
5.24M
    case OP_NOT_WORD_BOUNDARY:
1849
5.24M
    case OP_PRUNE:
1850
5.24M
    case OP_REVERSE:
1851
5.24M
    case OP_RREF:
1852
5.24M
    case OP_SET_SOM:
1853
5.24M
    case OP_SKIP:
1854
5.25M
    case OP_SOD:
1855
5.25M
    case OP_SOM:
1856
5.25M
    case OP_THEN:
1857
5.25M
    case OP_WORD_BOUNDARY:
1858
5.25M
    cc += PRIV(OP_lengths)[*cc];
1859
5.25M
    break;
1860
1861
    /* Handle literal characters */
1862
1863
326M
    case OP_CHAR:
1864
326M
    case OP_CHARI:
1865
326M
    case OP_NOT:
1866
326M
    case OP_NOTI:
1867
326M
    branchlength++;
1868
326M
    cc += 2;
1869
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
1870
    if (utf && HAS_EXTRALEN(cc[-1])) cc += GET_EXTRALEN(cc[-1]);
1871
#endif
1872
326M
    break;
1873
1874
    /* Handle exact repetitions. The count is already in characters, but we
1875
    need to skip over a multibyte character in UTF8 mode.  */
1876
1877
67.5M
    case OP_EXACT:
1878
67.5M
    case OP_EXACTI:
1879
67.5M
    case OP_NOTEXACT:
1880
67.5M
    case OP_NOTEXACTI:
1881
67.5M
    branchlength += (int)GET2(cc,1);
1882
67.5M
    cc += 2 + IMM2_SIZE;
1883
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
1884
    if (utf && HAS_EXTRALEN(cc[-1])) cc += GET_EXTRALEN(cc[-1]);
1885
#endif
1886
67.5M
    break;
1887
1888
23.9k
    case OP_TYPEEXACT:
1889
23.9k
    branchlength += GET2(cc,1);
1890
23.9k
    if (cc[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_PROP || cc[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_NOTPROP)
1891
403
      cc += 2;
1892
23.9k
    cc += 1 + IMM2_SIZE + 1;
1893
23.9k
    break;
1894
1895
    /* Handle single-char matchers */
1896
1897
566
    case OP_PROP:
1898
625
    case OP_NOTPROP:
1899
625
    cc += 2;
1900
    /* Fall through */
1901
1902
708
    case OP_HSPACE:
1903
1.22k
    case OP_VSPACE:
1904
1.47k
    case OP_NOT_HSPACE:
1905
1.79k
    case OP_NOT_VSPACE:
1906
2.11k
    case OP_NOT_DIGIT:
1907
2.36k
    case OP_DIGIT:
1908
2.89k
    case OP_NOT_WHITESPACE:
1909
3.75k
    case OP_WHITESPACE:
1910
4.07k
    case OP_NOT_WORDCHAR:
1911
4.96k
    case OP_WORDCHAR:
1912
6.64M
    case OP_ANY:
1913
6.65M
    case OP_ALLANY:
1914
6.65M
    branchlength++;
1915
6.65M
    cc++;
1916
6.65M
    break;
1917
1918
    /* The single-byte matcher isn't allowed. This only happens in UTF-8 mode;
1919
    otherwise \C is coded as OP_ALLANY. */
1920
1921
1
    case OP_ANYBYTE:
1922
1
    return -2;
1923
1924
    /* Check a class for variable quantification */
1925
1926
21.2k
    case OP_CLASS:
1927
21.4k
    case OP_NCLASS:
1928
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || defined COMPILE_PCRE16 || defined COMPILE_PCRE32
1929
    case OP_XCLASS:
1930
    /* The original code caused an unsigned overflow in 64 bit systems,
1931
    so now we use a conditional statement. */
1932
    if (op == OP_XCLASS)
1933
      cc += GET(cc, 1);
1934
    else
1935
      cc += PRIV(OP_lengths)[OP_CLASS];
1936
#else
1937
21.4k
    cc += PRIV(OP_lengths)[OP_CLASS];
1938
21.4k
#endif
1939
1940
21.4k
    switch (*cc)
1941
21.4k
      {
1942
1
      case OP_CRSTAR:
1943
2
      case OP_CRMINSTAR:
1944
3
      case OP_CRPLUS:
1945
4
      case OP_CRMINPLUS:
1946
5
      case OP_CRQUERY:
1947
6
      case OP_CRMINQUERY:
1948
7
      case OP_CRPOSSTAR:
1949
8
      case OP_CRPOSPLUS:
1950
12
      case OP_CRPOSQUERY:
1951
12
      return -1;
1952
1953
815
      case OP_CRRANGE:
1954
1.03k
      case OP_CRMINRANGE:
1955
1.33k
      case OP_CRPOSRANGE:
1956
1.33k
      if (GET2(cc,1) != GET2(cc,1+IMM2_SIZE)) return -1;
1957
1.31k
      branchlength += (int)GET2(cc,1);
1958
1.31k
      cc += 1 + 2 * IMM2_SIZE;
1959
1.31k
      break;
1960
1961
20.1k
      default:
1962
20.1k
      branchlength++;
1963
21.4k
      }
1964
21.4k
    break;
1965
1966
    /* Anything else is variable length */
1967
1968
21.4k
    case OP_ANYNL:
1969
2
    case OP_BRAMINZERO:
1970
3
    case OP_BRAPOS:
1971
4
    case OP_BRAPOSZERO:
1972
7
    case OP_BRAZERO:
1973
8
    case OP_CBRAPOS:
1974
9
    case OP_EXTUNI:
1975
29
    case OP_KETRMAX:
1976
30
    case OP_KETRMIN:
1977
31
    case OP_KETRPOS:
1978
32
    case OP_MINPLUS:
1979
33
    case OP_MINPLUSI:
1980
34
    case OP_MINQUERY:
1981
35
    case OP_MINQUERYI:
1982
36
    case OP_MINSTAR:
1983
37
    case OP_MINSTARI:
1984
38
    case OP_MINUPTO:
1985
39
    case OP_MINUPTOI:
1986
40
    case OP_NOTMINPLUS:
1987
41
    case OP_NOTMINPLUSI:
1988
42
    case OP_NOTMINQUERY:
1989
43
    case OP_NOTMINQUERYI:
1990
44
    case OP_NOTMINSTAR:
1991
45
    case OP_NOTMINSTARI:
1992
46
    case OP_NOTMINUPTO:
1993
47
    case OP_NOTMINUPTOI:
1994
48
    case OP_NOTPLUS:
1995
49
    case OP_NOTPLUSI:
1996
50
    case OP_NOTPOSPLUS:
1997
51
    case OP_NOTPOSPLUSI:
1998
52
    case OP_NOTPOSQUERY:
1999
53
    case OP_NOTPOSQUERYI:
2000
54
    case OP_NOTPOSSTAR:
2001
55
    case OP_NOTPOSSTARI:
2002
57
    case OP_NOTPOSUPTO:
2003
58
    case OP_NOTPOSUPTOI:
2004
59
    case OP_NOTQUERY:
2005
61
    case OP_NOTQUERYI:
2006
62
    case OP_NOTSTAR:
2007
63
    case OP_NOTSTARI:
2008
64
    case OP_NOTUPTO:
2009
65
    case OP_NOTUPTOI:
2010
68
    case OP_PLUS:
2011
69
    case OP_PLUSI:
2012
71
    case OP_POSPLUS:
2013
72
    case OP_POSPLUSI:
2014
73
    case OP_POSQUERY:
2015
74
    case OP_POSQUERYI:
2016
77
    case OP_POSSTAR:
2017
78
    case OP_POSSTARI:
2018
79
    case OP_POSUPTO:
2019
80
    case OP_POSUPTOI:
2020
85
    case OP_QUERY:
2021
86
    case OP_QUERYI:
2022
91
    case OP_REF:
2023
92
    case OP_REFI:
2024
93
    case OP_DNREF:
2025
93
    case OP_DNREFI:
2026
94
    case OP_SBRA:
2027
95
    case OP_SBRAPOS:
2028
96
    case OP_SCBRA:
2029
97
    case OP_SCBRAPOS:
2030
98
    case OP_SCOND:
2031
100
    case OP_SKIPZERO:
2032
103
    case OP_STAR:
2033
104
    case OP_STARI:
2034
105
    case OP_TYPEMINPLUS:
2035
106
    case OP_TYPEMINQUERY:
2036
106
    case OP_TYPEMINSTAR:
2037
107
    case OP_TYPEMINUPTO:
2038
109
    case OP_TYPEPLUS:
2039
110
    case OP_TYPEPOSPLUS:
2040
110
    case OP_TYPEPOSQUERY:
2041
111
    case OP_TYPEPOSSTAR:
2042
112
    case OP_TYPEPOSUPTO:
2043
112
    case OP_TYPEQUERY:
2044
113
    case OP_TYPESTAR:
2045
114
    case OP_TYPEUPTO:
2046
115
    case OP_UPTO:
2047
116
    case OP_UPTOI:
2048
116
    return -1;
2049
2050
    /* Catch unrecognized opcodes so that when new ones are added they
2051
    are not forgotten, as has happened in the past. */
2052
2053
1
    default:
2054
1
    return -4;
2055
670M
    }
2056
670M
  }
2057
/* Control never gets here */
2058
132M
}
2059
2060
2061
2062
/*************************************************
2063
*    Scan compiled regex for specific bracket    *
2064
*************************************************/
2065
2066
/* This little function scans through a compiled pattern until it finds a
2067
capturing bracket with the given number, or, if the number is negative, an
2068
instance of OP_REVERSE for a lookbehind. The function is global in the C sense
2069
so that it can be called from pcre_study() when finding the minimum matching
2070
length.
2071
2072
Arguments:
2073
  code        points to start of expression
2074
  utf         TRUE in UTF-8 / UTF-16 / UTF-32 mode
2075
  number      the required bracket number or negative to find a lookbehind
2076
2077
Returns:      pointer to the opcode for the bracket, or NULL if not found
2078
*/
2079
2080
const pcre_uchar *
2081
PRIV(find_bracket)(const pcre_uchar *code, BOOL utf, int number)
2082
8.74k
{
2083
8.74k
for (;;)
2084
4.17M
  {
2085
4.17M
  register pcre_uchar c = *code;
2086
2087
4.17M
  if (c == OP_END) return NULL;
2088
2089
  /* XCLASS is used for classes that cannot be represented just by a bit
2090
  map. This includes negated single high-valued characters. The length in
2091
  the table is zero; the actual length is stored in the compiled code. */
2092
2093
4.17M
  if (c == OP_XCLASS) code += GET(code, 1);
2094
2095
  /* Handle recursion */
2096
2097
4.17M
  else if (c == OP_REVERSE)
2098
5.93k
    {
2099
5.93k
    if (number < 0) return (pcre_uchar *)code;
2100
3.22k
    code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c];
2101
3.22k
    }
2102
2103
  /* Handle capturing bracket */
2104
2105
4.16M
  else if (c == OP_CBRA || c == OP_SCBRA ||
2106
3.80M
           c == OP_CBRAPOS || c == OP_SCBRAPOS)
2107
359k
    {
2108
359k
    int n = (int)GET2(code, 1+LINK_SIZE);
2109
359k
    if (n == number) return (pcre_uchar *)code;
2110
355k
    code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c];
2111
355k
    }
2112
2113
  /* Otherwise, we can get the item's length from the table, except that for
2114
  repeated character types, we have to test for \p and \P, which have an extra
2115
  two bytes of parameters, and for MARK/PRUNE/SKIP/THEN with an argument, we
2116
  must add in its length. */
2117
2118
3.80M
  else
2119
3.80M
    {
2120
3.80M
    switch(c)
2121
3.80M
      {
2122
2.84k
      case OP_TYPESTAR:
2123
6.85k
      case OP_TYPEMINSTAR:
2124
8.73k
      case OP_TYPEPLUS:
2125
9.20k
      case OP_TYPEMINPLUS:
2126
73.7k
      case OP_TYPEQUERY:
2127
75.9k
      case OP_TYPEMINQUERY:
2128
76.2k
      case OP_TYPEPOSSTAR:
2129
78.7k
      case OP_TYPEPOSPLUS:
2130
79.0k
      case OP_TYPEPOSQUERY:
2131
79.0k
      if (code[1] == OP_PROP || code[1] == OP_NOTPROP) code += 2;
2132
79.0k
      break;
2133
2134
134
      case OP_TYPEUPTO:
2135
1.50k
      case OP_TYPEMINUPTO:
2136
5.07k
      case OP_TYPEEXACT:
2137
6.34k
      case OP_TYPEPOSUPTO:
2138
6.34k
      if (code[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_PROP || code[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_NOTPROP)
2139
0
        code += 2;
2140
6.34k
      break;
2141
2142
120
      case OP_MARK:
2143
336
      case OP_PRUNE_ARG:
2144
657
      case OP_SKIP_ARG:
2145
868
      case OP_THEN_ARG:
2146
868
      code += code[1];
2147
868
      break;
2148
3.80M
      }
2149
2150
    /* Add in the fixed length from the table */
2151
2152
3.80M
    code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c];
2153
2154
  /* In UTF-8 mode, opcodes that are followed by a character may be followed by
2155
  a multi-byte character. The length in the table is a minimum, so we have to
2156
  arrange to skip the extra bytes. */
2157
2158
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32
2159
    if (utf) switch(c)
2160
      {
2161
      case OP_CHAR:
2162
      case OP_CHARI:
2163
      case OP_NOT:
2164
      case OP_NOTI:
2165
      case OP_EXACT:
2166
      case OP_EXACTI:
2167
      case OP_NOTEXACT:
2168
      case OP_NOTEXACTI:
2169
      case OP_UPTO:
2170
      case OP_UPTOI:
2171
      case OP_NOTUPTO:
2172
      case OP_NOTUPTOI:
2173
      case OP_MINUPTO:
2174
      case OP_MINUPTOI:
2175
      case OP_NOTMINUPTO:
2176
      case OP_NOTMINUPTOI:
2177
      case OP_POSUPTO:
2178
      case OP_POSUPTOI:
2179
      case OP_NOTPOSUPTO:
2180
      case OP_NOTPOSUPTOI:
2181
      case OP_STAR:
2182
      case OP_STARI:
2183
      case OP_NOTSTAR:
2184
      case OP_NOTSTARI:
2185
      case OP_MINSTAR:
2186
      case OP_MINSTARI:
2187
      case OP_NOTMINSTAR:
2188
      case OP_NOTMINSTARI:
2189
      case OP_POSSTAR:
2190
      case OP_POSSTARI:
2191
      case OP_NOTPOSSTAR:
2192
      case OP_NOTPOSSTARI:
2193
      case OP_PLUS:
2194
      case OP_PLUSI:
2195
      case OP_NOTPLUS:
2196
      case OP_NOTPLUSI:
2197
      case OP_MINPLUS:
2198
      case OP_MINPLUSI:
2199
      case OP_NOTMINPLUS:
2200
      case OP_NOTMINPLUSI:
2201
      case OP_POSPLUS:
2202
      case OP_POSPLUSI:
2203
      case OP_NOTPOSPLUS:
2204
      case OP_NOTPOSPLUSI:
2205
      case OP_QUERY:
2206
      case OP_QUERYI:
2207
      case OP_NOTQUERY:
2208
      case OP_NOTQUERYI:
2209
      case OP_MINQUERY:
2210
      case OP_MINQUERYI:
2211
      case OP_NOTMINQUERY:
2212
      case OP_NOTMINQUERYI:
2213
      case OP_POSQUERY:
2214
      case OP_POSQUERYI:
2215
      case OP_NOTPOSQUERY:
2216
      case OP_NOTPOSQUERYI:
2217
      if (HAS_EXTRALEN(code[-1])) code += GET_EXTRALEN(code[-1]);
2218
      break;
2219
      }
2220
#else
2221
3.80M
    (void)(utf);  /* Keep compiler happy by referencing function argument */
2222
3.80M
#endif
2223
3.80M
    }
2224
4.17M
  }
2225
8.74k
}
2226
2227
2228
2229
/*************************************************
2230
*   Scan compiled regex for recursion reference  *
2231
*************************************************/
2232
2233
/* This little function scans through a compiled pattern until it finds an
2234
instance of OP_RECURSE.
2235
2236
Arguments:
2237
  code        points to start of expression
2238
  utf         TRUE in UTF-8 / UTF-16 / UTF-32 mode
2239
2240
Returns:      pointer to the opcode for OP_RECURSE, or NULL if not found
2241
*/
2242
2243
static const pcre_uchar *
2244
find_recurse(const pcre_uchar *code, BOOL utf)
2245
180k
{
2246
180k
for (;;)
2247
1.17M
  {
2248
1.17M
  register pcre_uchar c = *code;
2249
1.17M
  if (c == OP_END) return NULL;
2250
1.02M
  if (c == OP_RECURSE) return code;
2251
2252
  /* XCLASS is used for classes that cannot be represented just by a bit
2253
  map. This includes negated single high-valued characters. The length in
2254
  the table is zero; the actual length is stored in the compiled code. */
2255
2256
990k
  if (c == OP_XCLASS) code += GET(code, 1);
2257
2258
  /* Otherwise, we can get the item's length from the table, except that for
2259
  repeated character types, we have to test for \p and \P, which have an extra
2260
  two bytes of parameters, and for MARK/PRUNE/SKIP/THEN with an argument, we
2261
  must add in its length. */
2262
2263
990k
  else
2264
990k
    {
2265
990k
    switch(c)
2266
990k
      {
2267
1.11k
      case OP_TYPESTAR:
2268
2.25k
      case OP_TYPEMINSTAR:
2269
2.82k
      case OP_TYPEPLUS:
2270
3.11k
      case OP_TYPEMINPLUS:
2271
3.96k
      case OP_TYPEQUERY:
2272
4.76k
      case OP_TYPEMINQUERY:
2273
5.04k
      case OP_TYPEPOSSTAR:
2274
5.65k
      case OP_TYPEPOSPLUS:
2275
6.15k
      case OP_TYPEPOSQUERY:
2276
6.15k
      if (code[1] == OP_PROP || code[1] == OP_NOTPROP) code += 2;
2277
6.15k
      break;
2278
2279
657
      case OP_TYPEPOSUPTO:
2280
1.22k
      case OP_TYPEUPTO:
2281
1.98k
      case OP_TYPEMINUPTO:
2282
3.58k
      case OP_TYPEEXACT:
2283
3.58k
      if (code[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_PROP || code[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_NOTPROP)
2284
0
        code += 2;
2285
3.58k
      break;
2286
2287
882
      case OP_MARK:
2288
1.01k
      case OP_PRUNE_ARG:
2289
1.26k
      case OP_SKIP_ARG:
2290
1.81k
      case OP_THEN_ARG:
2291
1.81k
      code += code[1];
2292
1.81k
      break;
2293
990k
      }
2294
2295
    /* Add in the fixed length from the table */
2296
2297
990k
    code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c];
2298
2299
    /* In UTF-8 mode, opcodes that are followed by a character may be followed
2300
    by a multi-byte character. The length in the table is a minimum, so we have
2301
    to arrange to skip the extra bytes. */
2302
2303
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32
2304
    if (utf) switch(c)
2305
      {
2306
      case OP_CHAR:
2307
      case OP_CHARI:
2308
      case OP_NOT:
2309
      case OP_NOTI:
2310
      case OP_EXACT:
2311
      case OP_EXACTI:
2312
      case OP_NOTEXACT:
2313
      case OP_NOTEXACTI:
2314
      case OP_UPTO:
2315
      case OP_UPTOI:
2316
      case OP_NOTUPTO:
2317
      case OP_NOTUPTOI:
2318
      case OP_MINUPTO:
2319
      case OP_MINUPTOI:
2320
      case OP_NOTMINUPTO:
2321
      case OP_NOTMINUPTOI:
2322
      case OP_POSUPTO:
2323
      case OP_POSUPTOI:
2324
      case OP_NOTPOSUPTO:
2325
      case OP_NOTPOSUPTOI:
2326
      case OP_STAR:
2327
      case OP_STARI:
2328
      case OP_NOTSTAR:
2329
      case OP_NOTSTARI:
2330
      case OP_MINSTAR:
2331
      case OP_MINSTARI:
2332
      case OP_NOTMINSTAR:
2333
      case OP_NOTMINSTARI:
2334
      case OP_POSSTAR:
2335
      case OP_POSSTARI:
2336
      case OP_NOTPOSSTAR:
2337
      case OP_NOTPOSSTARI:
2338
      case OP_PLUS:
2339
      case OP_PLUSI:
2340
      case OP_NOTPLUS:
2341
      case OP_NOTPLUSI:
2342
      case OP_MINPLUS:
2343
      case OP_MINPLUSI:
2344
      case OP_NOTMINPLUS:
2345
      case OP_NOTMINPLUSI:
2346
      case OP_POSPLUS:
2347
      case OP_POSPLUSI:
2348
      case OP_NOTPOSPLUS:
2349
      case OP_NOTPOSPLUSI:
2350
      case OP_QUERY:
2351
      case OP_QUERYI:
2352
      case OP_NOTQUERY:
2353
      case OP_NOTQUERYI:
2354
      case OP_MINQUERY:
2355
      case OP_MINQUERYI:
2356
      case OP_NOTMINQUERY:
2357
      case OP_NOTMINQUERYI:
2358
      case OP_POSQUERY:
2359
      case OP_POSQUERYI:
2360
      case OP_NOTPOSQUERY:
2361
      case OP_NOTPOSQUERYI:
2362
      if (HAS_EXTRALEN(code[-1])) code += GET_EXTRALEN(code[-1]);
2363
      break;
2364
      }
2365
#else
2366
990k
    (void)(utf);  /* Keep compiler happy by referencing function argument */
2367
990k
#endif
2368
990k
    }
2369
990k
  }
2370
180k
}
2371
2372
2373
2374
/*************************************************
2375
*    Scan compiled branch for non-emptiness      *
2376
*************************************************/
2377
2378
/* This function scans through a branch of a compiled pattern to see whether it
2379
can match the empty string or not. It is called from could_be_empty()
2380
below and from compile_branch() when checking for an unlimited repeat of a
2381
group that can match nothing. Note that first_significant_code() skips over
2382
backward and negative forward assertions when its final argument is TRUE. If we
2383
hit an unclosed bracket, we return "empty" - this means we've struck an inner
2384
bracket whose current branch will already have been scanned.
2385
2386
Arguments:
2387
  code        points to start of search
2388
  endcode     points to where to stop
2389
  utf         TRUE if in UTF-8 / UTF-16 / UTF-32 mode
2390
  cd          contains pointers to tables etc.
2391
  recurses    chain of recurse_check to catch mutual recursion
2392
2393
Returns:      TRUE if what is matched could be empty
2394
*/
2395
2396
static BOOL
2397
could_be_empty_branch(const pcre_uchar *code, const pcre_uchar *endcode,
2398
  BOOL utf, compile_data *cd, recurse_check *recurses)
2399
5.56M
{
2400
5.56M
register pcre_uchar c;
2401
5.56M
recurse_check this_recurse;
2402
2403
5.56M
for (code = first_significant_code(code + PRIV(OP_lengths)[*code], TRUE);
2404
11.1M
     code < endcode;
2405
5.56M
     code = first_significant_code(code + PRIV(OP_lengths)[c], TRUE))
2406
11.1M
  {
2407
11.1M
  const pcre_uchar *ccode;
2408
2409
11.1M
  c = *code;
2410
2411
  /* Skip over forward assertions; the other assertions are skipped by
2412
  first_significant_code() with a TRUE final argument. */
2413
2414
11.1M
  if (c == OP_ASSERT)
2415
4.07k
    {
2416
10.0k
    do code += GET(code, 1); while (*code == OP_ALT);
2417
4.07k
    c = *code;
2418
4.07k
    continue;
2419
4.07k
    }
2420
2421
  /* For a recursion/subroutine call, if its end has been reached, which
2422
  implies a backward reference subroutine call, we can scan it. If it's a
2423
  forward reference subroutine call, we can't. To detect forward reference
2424
  we have to scan up the list that is kept in the workspace. This function is
2425
  called only when doing the real compile, not during the pre-compile that
2426
  measures the size of the compiled pattern. */
2427
2428
11.1M
  if (c == OP_RECURSE)
2429
5.19M
    {
2430
5.19M
    const pcre_uchar *scode = cd->start_code + GET(code, 1);
2431
5.19M
    const pcre_uchar *endgroup = scode;
2432
5.19M
    BOOL empty_branch;
2433
2434
    /* Test for forward reference or uncompleted reference. This is disabled
2435
    when called to scan a completed pattern by setting cd->start_workspace to
2436
    NULL. */
2437
2438
5.19M
    if (cd->start_workspace != NULL)
2439
5.16M
      {
2440
5.16M
      const pcre_uchar *tcode;
2441
5.87G
      for (tcode = cd->start_workspace; tcode < cd->hwm; tcode += LINK_SIZE)
2442
5.87G
        if ((int)GET(tcode, 0) == (int)(code + 1 - cd->start_code)) return TRUE;
2443
9.14k
      if (GET(scode, 1) == 0) return TRUE;    /* Unclosed */
2444
9.14k
      }
2445
2446
    /* If the reference is to a completed group, we need to detect whether this
2447
    is a recursive call, as otherwise there will be an infinite loop. If it is
2448
    a recursion, just skip over it. Simple recursions are easily detected. For
2449
    mutual recursions we keep a chain on the stack. */
2450
2451
41.6k
    do endgroup += GET(endgroup, 1); while (*endgroup == OP_ALT);
2452
40.5k
    if (code >= scode && code <= endgroup) continue;  /* Simple recursion */
2453
40.0k
    else
2454
40.0k
      {
2455
40.0k
      recurse_check *r = recurses;
2456
59.6k
      for (r = recurses; r != NULL; r = r->prev)
2457
36.1k
        if (r->group == scode) break;
2458
40.0k
      if (r != NULL) continue;   /* Mutual recursion */
2459
40.0k
      }
2460
2461
    /* Completed reference; scan the referenced group, remembering it on the
2462
    stack chain to detect mutual recursions. */
2463
2464
23.4k
    empty_branch = FALSE;
2465
23.4k
    this_recurse.prev = recurses;
2466
23.4k
    this_recurse.group = scode;
2467
2468
23.4k
    do
2469
23.9k
      {
2470
23.9k
      if (could_be_empty_branch(scode, endcode, utf, cd, &this_recurse))
2471
19.7k
        {
2472
19.7k
        empty_branch = TRUE;
2473
19.7k
        break;
2474
19.7k
        }
2475
4.11k
      scode += GET(scode, 1);
2476
4.11k
      }
2477
23.4k
    while (*scode == OP_ALT);
2478
2479
23.4k
    if (!empty_branch) return FALSE;  /* All branches are non-empty */
2480
19.7k
    continue;
2481
23.4k
    }
2482
2483
  /* Groups with zero repeats can of course be empty; skip them. */
2484
2485
5.90M
  if (c == OP_BRAZERO || c == OP_BRAMINZERO || c == OP_SKIPZERO ||
2486
5.90M
      c == OP_BRAPOSZERO)
2487
4.93k
    {
2488
4.93k
    code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c];
2489
5.35k
    do code += GET(code, 1); while (*code == OP_ALT);
2490
4.93k
    c = *code;
2491
4.93k
    continue;
2492
4.93k
    }
2493
2494
  /* A nested group that is already marked as "could be empty" can just be
2495
  skipped. */
2496
2497
5.90M
  if (c == OP_SBRA  || c == OP_SBRAPOS ||
2498
5.89M
      c == OP_SCBRA || c == OP_SCBRAPOS)
2499
3.87k
    {
2500
4.42k
    do code += GET(code, 1); while (*code == OP_ALT);
2501
3.87k
    c = *code;
2502
3.87k
    continue;
2503
3.87k
    }
2504
2505
  /* For other groups, scan the branches. */
2506
2507
5.89M
  if (c == OP_BRA  || c == OP_BRAPOS ||
2508
5.87M
      c == OP_CBRA || c == OP_CBRAPOS ||
2509
5.60M
      c == OP_ONCE || c == OP_ONCE_NC ||
2510
411k
      c == OP_COND || c == OP_SCOND)
2511
5.48M
    {
2512
5.48M
    BOOL empty_branch;
2513
5.48M
    if (GET(code, 1) == 0) return TRUE;    /* Hit unclosed bracket */
2514
2515
    /* If a conditional group has only one branch, there is a second, implied,
2516
    empty branch, so just skip over the conditional, because it could be empty.
2517
    Otherwise, scan the individual branches of the group. */
2518
2519
5.48M
    if (c == OP_COND && code[GET(code, 1)] != OP_ALT)
2520
565
      code += GET(code, 1);
2521
5.48M
    else
2522
5.48M
      {
2523
5.48M
      empty_branch = FALSE;
2524
5.48M
      do
2525
5.52M
        {
2526
5.52M
        if (!empty_branch && could_be_empty_branch(code, endcode, utf, cd,
2527
5.51M
          recurses)) empty_branch = TRUE;
2528
5.52M
        code += GET(code, 1);
2529
5.52M
        }
2530
5.52M
      while (*code == OP_ALT);
2531
5.48M
      if (!empty_branch) return FALSE;   /* All branches are non-empty */
2532
5.48M
      }
2533
2534
5.46M
    c = *code;
2535
5.46M
    continue;
2536
5.48M
    }
2537
2538
  /* Handle the other opcodes */
2539
2540
409k
  switch (c)
2541
409k
    {
2542
    /* Check for quantifiers after a class. XCLASS is used for classes that
2543
    cannot be represented just by a bit map. This includes negated single
2544
    high-valued characters. The length in PRIV(OP_lengths)[] is zero; the
2545
    actual length is stored in the compiled code, so we must update "code"
2546
    here. */
2547
2548
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
2549
    case OP_XCLASS:
2550
    ccode = code += GET(code, 1);
2551
    goto CHECK_CLASS_REPEAT;
2552
#endif
2553
2554
6.83k
    case OP_CLASS:
2555
8.49k
    case OP_NCLASS:
2556
8.49k
    ccode = code + PRIV(OP_lengths)[OP_CLASS];
2557
2558
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
2559
    CHECK_CLASS_REPEAT:
2560
#endif
2561
2562
8.49k
    switch (*ccode)
2563
8.49k
      {
2564
1.03k
      case OP_CRSTAR:            /* These could be empty; continue */
2565
1.34k
      case OP_CRMINSTAR:
2566
2.25k
      case OP_CRQUERY:
2567
2.47k
      case OP_CRMINQUERY:
2568
2.77k
      case OP_CRPOSSTAR:
2569
3.32k
      case OP_CRPOSQUERY:
2570
3.32k
      break;
2571
2572
1.27k
      default:                   /* Non-repeat => class must match */
2573
2.28k
      case OP_CRPLUS:            /* These repeats aren't empty */
2574
2.60k
      case OP_CRMINPLUS:
2575
2.96k
      case OP_CRPOSPLUS:
2576
2.96k
      return FALSE;
2577
2578
811
      case OP_CRRANGE:
2579
1.62k
      case OP_CRMINRANGE:
2580
2.20k
      case OP_CRPOSRANGE:
2581
2.20k
      if (GET2(ccode, 1) > 0) return FALSE;  /* Minimum > 0 */
2582
238
      break;
2583
8.49k
      }
2584
3.56k
    break;
2585
2586
    /* Opcodes that must match a character */
2587
2588
3.56k
    case OP_ANY:
2589
1.93k
    case OP_ALLANY:
2590
2.04k
    case OP_ANYBYTE:
2591
2592
2.11k
    case OP_PROP:
2593
2.19k
    case OP_NOTPROP:
2594
2.54k
    case OP_ANYNL:
2595
2596
2.74k
    case OP_NOT_HSPACE:
2597
3.05k
    case OP_HSPACE:
2598
3.36k
    case OP_NOT_VSPACE:
2599
3.68k
    case OP_VSPACE:
2600
3.72k
    case OP_EXTUNI:
2601
2602
4.16k
    case OP_NOT_DIGIT:
2603
4.57k
    case OP_DIGIT:
2604
4.86k
    case OP_NOT_WHITESPACE:
2605
5.41k
    case OP_WHITESPACE:
2606
5.96k
    case OP_NOT_WORDCHAR:
2607
6.16k
    case OP_WORDCHAR:
2608
2609
28.0k
    case OP_CHAR:
2610
28.9k
    case OP_CHARI:
2611
29.3k
    case OP_NOT:
2612
30.1k
    case OP_NOTI:
2613
2614
30.9k
    case OP_PLUS:
2615
31.2k
    case OP_PLUSI:
2616
32.0k
    case OP_MINPLUS:
2617
32.4k
    case OP_MINPLUSI:
2618
2619
32.9k
    case OP_NOTPLUS:
2620
33.2k
    case OP_NOTPLUSI:
2621
33.7k
    case OP_NOTMINPLUS:
2622
33.9k
    case OP_NOTMINPLUSI:
2623
2624
34.3k
    case OP_POSPLUS:
2625
34.6k
    case OP_POSPLUSI:
2626
35.3k
    case OP_NOTPOSPLUS:
2627
36.3k
    case OP_NOTPOSPLUSI:
2628
2629
36.9k
    case OP_EXACT:
2630
37.0k
    case OP_EXACTI:
2631
37.1k
    case OP_NOTEXACT:
2632
37.4k
    case OP_NOTEXACTI:
2633
2634
37.9k
    case OP_TYPEPLUS:
2635
38.2k
    case OP_TYPEMINPLUS:
2636
39.3k
    case OP_TYPEPOSPLUS:
2637
40.1k
    case OP_TYPEEXACT:
2638
2639
40.1k
    return FALSE;
2640
2641
    /* These are going to continue, as they may be empty, but we have to
2642
    fudge the length for the \p and \P cases. */
2643
2644
1.04k
    case OP_TYPESTAR:
2645
1.48k
    case OP_TYPEMINSTAR:
2646
2.37k
    case OP_TYPEPOSSTAR:
2647
5.12k
    case OP_TYPEQUERY:
2648
5.89k
    case OP_TYPEMINQUERY:
2649
6.84k
    case OP_TYPEPOSQUERY:
2650
6.84k
    if (code[1] == OP_PROP || code[1] == OP_NOTPROP) code += 2;
2651
6.84k
    break;
2652
2653
    /* Same for these */
2654
2655
575
    case OP_TYPEUPTO:
2656
1.22k
    case OP_TYPEMINUPTO:
2657
2.48k
    case OP_TYPEPOSUPTO:
2658
2.48k
    if (code[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_PROP || code[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_NOTPROP)
2659
10
      code += 2;
2660
2.48k
    break;
2661
2662
    /* End of branch */
2663
2664
311k
    case OP_KET:
2665
312k
    case OP_KETRMAX:
2666
313k
    case OP_KETRMIN:
2667
313k
    case OP_KETRPOS:
2668
325k
    case OP_ALT:
2669
325k
    return TRUE;
2670
2671
    /* In UTF-8 mode, STAR, MINSTAR, POSSTAR, QUERY, MINQUERY, POSQUERY, UPTO,
2672
    MINUPTO, and POSUPTO and their caseless and negative versions may be
2673
    followed by a multibyte character. */
2674
2675
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32
2676
    case OP_STAR:
2677
    case OP_STARI:
2678
    case OP_NOTSTAR:
2679
    case OP_NOTSTARI:
2680
2681
    case OP_MINSTAR:
2682
    case OP_MINSTARI:
2683
    case OP_NOTMINSTAR:
2684
    case OP_NOTMINSTARI:
2685
2686
    case OP_POSSTAR:
2687
    case OP_POSSTARI:
2688
    case OP_NOTPOSSTAR:
2689
    case OP_NOTPOSSTARI:
2690
2691
    case OP_QUERY:
2692
    case OP_QUERYI:
2693
    case OP_NOTQUERY:
2694
    case OP_NOTQUERYI:
2695
2696
    case OP_MINQUERY:
2697
    case OP_MINQUERYI:
2698
    case OP_NOTMINQUERY:
2699
    case OP_NOTMINQUERYI:
2700
2701
    case OP_POSQUERY:
2702
    case OP_POSQUERYI:
2703
    case OP_NOTPOSQUERY:
2704
    case OP_NOTPOSQUERYI:
2705
2706
    if (utf && HAS_EXTRALEN(code[1])) code += GET_EXTRALEN(code[1]);
2707
    break;
2708
2709
    case OP_UPTO:
2710
    case OP_UPTOI:
2711
    case OP_NOTUPTO:
2712
    case OP_NOTUPTOI:
2713
2714
    case OP_MINUPTO:
2715
    case OP_MINUPTOI:
2716
    case OP_NOTMINUPTO:
2717
    case OP_NOTMINUPTOI:
2718
2719
    case OP_POSUPTO:
2720
    case OP_POSUPTOI:
2721
    case OP_NOTPOSUPTO:
2722
    case OP_NOTPOSUPTOI:
2723
2724
    if (utf && HAS_EXTRALEN(code[1 + IMM2_SIZE])) code += GET_EXTRALEN(code[1 + IMM2_SIZE]);
2725
    break;
2726
#endif
2727
2728
    /* MARK, and PRUNE/SKIP/THEN with an argument must skip over the argument
2729
    string. */
2730
2731
1.46k
    case OP_MARK:
2732
2.45k
    case OP_PRUNE_ARG:
2733
3.25k
    case OP_SKIP_ARG:
2734
4.08k
    case OP_THEN_ARG:
2735
4.08k
    code += code[1];
2736
4.08k
    break;
2737
2738
    /* None of the remaining opcodes are required to match a character. */
2739
2740
21.8k
    default:
2741
21.8k
    break;
2742
409k
    }
2743
409k
  }
2744
2745
2.25k
return TRUE;
2746
5.56M
}
2747
2748
2749
2750
/*************************************************
2751
*    Scan compiled regex for non-emptiness       *
2752
*************************************************/
2753
2754
/* This function is called to check for left recursive calls. We want to check
2755
the current branch of the current pattern to see if it could match the empty
2756
string. If it could, we must look outwards for branches at other levels,
2757
stopping when we pass beyond the bracket which is the subject of the recursion.
2758
This function is called only during the real compile, not during the
2759
pre-compile.
2760
2761
Arguments:
2762
  code        points to start of the recursion
2763
  endcode     points to where to stop (current RECURSE item)
2764
  bcptr       points to the chain of current (unclosed) branch starts
2765
  utf         TRUE if in UTF-8 / UTF-16 / UTF-32 mode
2766
  cd          pointers to tables etc
2767
2768
Returns:      TRUE if what is matched could be empty
2769
*/
2770
2771
static BOOL
2772
could_be_empty(const pcre_uchar *code, const pcre_uchar *endcode,
2773
  branch_chain *bcptr, BOOL utf, compile_data *cd)
2774
1.51k
{
2775
2.63k
while (bcptr != NULL && bcptr->current_branch >= code)
2776
2.60k
  {
2777
2.60k
  if (!could_be_empty_branch(bcptr->current_branch, endcode, utf, cd, NULL))
2778
1.48k
    return FALSE;
2779
1.12k
  bcptr = bcptr->outer;
2780
1.12k
  }
2781
29
return TRUE;
2782
1.51k
}
2783
2784
2785
2786
/*************************************************
2787
*        Base opcode of repeated opcodes         *
2788
*************************************************/
2789
2790
/* Returns the base opcode for repeated single character type opcodes. If the
2791
opcode is not a repeated character type, it returns with the original value.
2792
2793
Arguments:  c opcode
2794
Returns:    base opcode for the type
2795
*/
2796
2797
static pcre_uchar
2798
get_repeat_base(pcre_uchar c)
2799
363k
{
2800
363k
return (c > OP_TYPEPOSUPTO)? c :
2801
363k
       (c >= OP_TYPESTAR)?   OP_TYPESTAR :
2802
363k
       (c >= OP_NOTSTARI)?   OP_NOTSTARI :
2803
277k
       (c >= OP_NOTSTAR)?    OP_NOTSTAR :
2804
272k
       (c >= OP_STARI)?      OP_STARI :
2805
264k
                             OP_STAR;
2806
363k
}
2807
2808
2809
2810
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
2811
/*************************************************
2812
*        Check a character and a property        *
2813
*************************************************/
2814
2815
/* This function is called by check_auto_possessive() when a property item
2816
is adjacent to a fixed character.
2817
2818
Arguments:
2819
  c            the character
2820
  ptype        the property type
2821
  pdata        the data for the type
2822
  negated      TRUE if it's a negated property (\P or \p{^)
2823
2824
Returns:       TRUE if auto-possessifying is OK
2825
*/
2826
2827
static BOOL
2828
check_char_prop(pcre_uint32 c, unsigned int ptype, unsigned int pdata,
2829
  BOOL negated)
2830
{
2831
const pcre_uint32 *p;
2832
const ucd_record *prop = GET_UCD(c);
2833
2834
switch(ptype)
2835
  {
2836
  case PT_LAMP:
2837
  return (prop->chartype == ucp_Lu ||
2838
          prop->chartype == ucp_Ll ||
2839
          prop->chartype == ucp_Lt) == negated;
2840
2841
  case PT_GC:
2842
  return (pdata == PRIV(ucp_gentype)[prop->chartype]) == negated;
2843
2844
  case PT_PC:
2845
  return (pdata == prop->chartype) == negated;
2846
2847
  case PT_SC:
2848
  return (pdata == prop->script) == negated;
2849
2850
  /* These are specials */
2851
2852
  case PT_ALNUM:
2853
  return (PRIV(ucp_gentype)[prop->chartype] == ucp_L ||
2854
          PRIV(ucp_gentype)[prop->chartype] == ucp_N) == negated;
2855
2856
  /* Perl space used to exclude VT, but from Perl 5.18 it is included, which
2857
  means that Perl space and POSIX space are now identical. PCRE was changed
2858
  at release 8.34. */
2859
2860
  case PT_SPACE:    /* Perl space */
2861
  case PT_PXSPACE:  /* POSIX space */
2862
  switch(c)
2863
    {
2864
    HSPACE_CASES:
2865
    VSPACE_CASES:
2866
    return negated;
2867
2868
    default:
2869
    return (PRIV(ucp_gentype)[prop->chartype] == ucp_Z) == negated;
2870
    }
2871
  break;  /* Control never reaches here */
2872
2873
  case PT_WORD:
2874
  return (PRIV(ucp_gentype)[prop->chartype] == ucp_L ||
2875
          PRIV(ucp_gentype)[prop->chartype] == ucp_N ||
2876
          c == CHAR_UNDERSCORE) == negated;
2877
2878
  case PT_CLIST:
2879
  p = PRIV(ucd_caseless_sets) + prop->caseset;
2880
  for (;;)
2881
    {
2882
    if (c < *p) return !negated;
2883
    if (c == *p++) return negated;
2884
    }
2885
  break;  /* Control never reaches here */
2886
  }
2887
2888
return FALSE;
2889
}
2890
#endif  /* SUPPORT_UCP */
2891
2892
2893
2894
/*************************************************
2895
*        Fill the character property list        *
2896
*************************************************/
2897
2898
/* Checks whether the code points to an opcode that can take part in auto-
2899
possessification, and if so, fills a list with its properties.
2900
2901
Arguments:
2902
  code        points to start of expression
2903
  utf         TRUE if in UTF-8 / UTF-16 / UTF-32 mode
2904
  fcc         points to case-flipping table
2905
  list        points to output list
2906
              list[0] will be filled with the opcode
2907
              list[1] will be non-zero if this opcode
2908
                can match an empty character string
2909
              list[2..7] depends on the opcode
2910
2911
Returns:      points to the start of the next opcode if *code is accepted
2912
              NULL if *code is not accepted
2913
*/
2914
2915
static const pcre_uchar *
2916
get_chr_property_list(const pcre_uchar *code, BOOL utf,
2917
  const pcre_uint8 *fcc, pcre_uint32 *list)
2918
714k
{
2919
714k
pcre_uchar c = *code;
2920
714k
pcre_uchar base;
2921
714k
const pcre_uchar *end;
2922
714k
pcre_uint32 chr;
2923
2924
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
2925
pcre_uint32 *clist_dest;
2926
const pcre_uint32 *clist_src;
2927
#else
2928
714k
((void)utf); /* Suppress "unused parameter" compiler warning */
2929
714k
#endif
2930
2931
714k
list[0] = c;
2932
714k
list[1] = FALSE;
2933
714k
code++;
2934
2935
714k
if (c >= OP_STAR && c <= OP_TYPEPOSUPTO)
2936
116k
  {
2937
116k
  base = get_repeat_base(c);
2938
116k
  c -= (base - OP_STAR);
2939
2940
116k
  if (c == OP_UPTO || c == OP_MINUPTO || c == OP_EXACT || c == OP_POSUPTO)
2941
4.16k
    code += IMM2_SIZE;
2942
2943
116k
  list[1] = (c != OP_PLUS && c != OP_MINPLUS && c != OP_EXACT && c != OP_POSPLUS);
2944
2945
116k
  switch(base)
2946
116k
    {
2947
64.9k
    case OP_STAR:
2948
64.9k
    list[0] = OP_CHAR;
2949
64.9k
    break;
2950
2951
2.99k
    case OP_STARI:
2952
2.99k
    list[0] = OP_CHARI;
2953
2.99k
    break;
2954
2955
4.01k
    case OP_NOTSTAR:
2956
4.01k
    list[0] = OP_NOT;
2957
4.01k
    break;
2958
2959
2.32k
    case OP_NOTSTARI:
2960
2.32k
    list[0] = OP_NOTI;
2961
2.32k
    break;
2962
2963
42.5k
    case OP_TYPESTAR:
2964
42.5k
    list[0] = *code;
2965
42.5k
    code++;
2966
42.5k
    break;
2967
116k
    }
2968
116k
  c = list[0];
2969
116k
  }
2970
2971
714k
switch(c)
2972
714k
  {
2973
1.57k
  case OP_NOT_DIGIT:
2974
4.34k
  case OP_DIGIT:
2975
5.82k
  case OP_NOT_WHITESPACE:
2976
6.92k
  case OP_WHITESPACE:
2977
9.09k
  case OP_NOT_WORDCHAR:
2978
10.4k
  case OP_WORDCHAR:
2979
39.9k
  case OP_ANY:
2980
40.8k
  case OP_ALLANY:
2981
42.4k
  case OP_ANYNL:
2982
45.6k
  case OP_NOT_HSPACE:
2983
47.0k
  case OP_HSPACE:
2984
50.4k
  case OP_NOT_VSPACE:
2985
52.3k
  case OP_VSPACE:
2986
52.3k
  case OP_EXTUNI:
2987
52.6k
  case OP_EODN:
2988
53.0k
  case OP_EOD:
2989
452k
  case OP_DOLL:
2990
452k
  case OP_DOLLM:
2991
452k
  return code;
2992
2993
225k
  case OP_CHAR:
2994
229k
  case OP_NOT:
2995
229k
  GETCHARINCTEST(chr, code);
2996
229k
  list[2] = chr;
2997
229k
  list[3] = NOTACHAR;
2998
229k
  return code;
2999
3000
5.26k
  case OP_CHARI:
3001
7.62k
  case OP_NOTI:
3002
7.62k
  list[0] = (c == OP_CHARI) ? OP_CHAR : OP_NOT;
3003
7.62k
  GETCHARINCTEST(chr, code);
3004
7.62k
  list[2] = chr;
3005
3006
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
3007
  if (chr < 128 || (chr < 256 && !utf))
3008
    list[3] = fcc[chr];
3009
  else
3010
    list[3] = UCD_OTHERCASE(chr);
3011
#elif defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
3012
  list[3] = (chr < 256) ? fcc[chr] : chr;
3013
#else
3014
7.62k
  list[3] = fcc[chr];
3015
7.62k
#endif
3016
3017
  /* The othercase might be the same value. */
3018
3019
7.62k
  if (chr == list[3])
3020
6.18k
    list[3] = NOTACHAR;
3021
1.44k
  else
3022
1.44k
    list[4] = NOTACHAR;
3023
7.62k
  return code;
3024
3025
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
3026
  case OP_PROP:
3027
  case OP_NOTPROP:
3028
  if (code[0] != PT_CLIST)
3029
    {
3030
    list[2] = code[0];
3031
    list[3] = code[1];
3032
    return code + 2;
3033
    }
3034
3035
  /* Convert only if we have enough space. */
3036
3037
  clist_src = PRIV(ucd_caseless_sets) + code[1];
3038
  clist_dest = list + 2;
3039
  code += 2;
3040
3041
  do {
3042
     if (clist_dest >= list + 8)
3043
       {
3044
       /* Early return if there is not enough space. This should never
3045
       happen, since all clists are shorter than 5 character now. */
3046
       list[2] = code[0];
3047
       list[3] = code[1];
3048
       return code;
3049
       }
3050
     *clist_dest++ = *clist_src;
3051
     }
3052
  while(*clist_src++ != NOTACHAR);
3053
3054
  /* All characters are stored. The terminating NOTACHAR
3055
  is copied form the clist itself. */
3056
3057
  list[0] = (c == OP_PROP) ? OP_CHAR : OP_NOT;
3058
  return code;
3059
#endif
3060
3061
2.56k
  case OP_NCLASS:
3062
24.3k
  case OP_CLASS:
3063
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
3064
  case OP_XCLASS:
3065
  if (c == OP_XCLASS)
3066
    end = code + GET(code, 0) - 1;
3067
  else
3068
#endif
3069
24.3k
    end = code + 32 / sizeof(pcre_uchar);
3070
3071
24.3k
  switch(*end)
3072
24.3k
    {
3073
2.88k
    case OP_CRSTAR:
3074
4.69k
    case OP_CRMINSTAR:
3075
8.11k
    case OP_CRQUERY:
3076
9.07k
    case OP_CRMINQUERY:
3077
9.65k
    case OP_CRPOSSTAR:
3078
9.91k
    case OP_CRPOSQUERY:
3079
9.91k
    list[1] = TRUE;
3080
9.91k
    end++;
3081
9.91k
    break;
3082
3083
3.61k
    case OP_CRPLUS:
3084
4.45k
    case OP_CRMINPLUS:
3085
4.68k
    case OP_CRPOSPLUS:
3086
4.68k
    end++;
3087
4.68k
    break;
3088
3089
3.85k
    case OP_CRRANGE:
3090
5.79k
    case OP_CRMINRANGE:
3091
6.05k
    case OP_CRPOSRANGE:
3092
6.05k
    list[1] = (GET2(end, 1) == 0);
3093
6.05k
    end += 1 + 2 * IMM2_SIZE;
3094
6.05k
    break;
3095
24.3k
    }
3096
24.3k
  list[2] = (pcre_uint32)(end - code);
3097
24.3k
  return end;
3098
714k
  }
3099
659
return NULL;    /* Opcode not accepted */
3100
714k
}
3101
3102
3103
3104
/*************************************************
3105
*    Scan further character sets for match       *
3106
*************************************************/
3107
3108
/* Checks whether the base and the current opcode have a common character, in
3109
which case the base cannot be possessified.
3110
3111
Arguments:
3112
  code        points to the byte code
3113
  utf         TRUE in UTF-8 / UTF-16 / UTF-32 mode
3114
  cd          static compile data
3115
  base_list   the data list of the base opcode
3116
3117
Returns:      TRUE if the auto-possessification is possible
3118
*/
3119
3120
static BOOL
3121
compare_opcodes(const pcre_uchar *code, BOOL utf, const compile_data *cd,
3122
  const pcre_uint32 *base_list, const pcre_uchar *base_end, int *rec_limit)
3123
3.76M
{
3124
3.76M
pcre_uchar c;
3125
3.76M
pcre_uint32 list[8];
3126
3.76M
const pcre_uint32 *chr_ptr;
3127
3.76M
const pcre_uint32 *ochr_ptr;
3128
3.76M
const pcre_uint32 *list_ptr;
3129
3.76M
const pcre_uchar *next_code;
3130
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
3131
const pcre_uchar *xclass_flags;
3132
#endif
3133
3.76M
const pcre_uint8 *class_bitset;
3134
3.76M
const pcre_uint8 *set1, *set2, *set_end;
3135
3.76M
pcre_uint32 chr;
3136
3.76M
BOOL accepted, invert_bits;
3137
3.76M
BOOL entered_a_group = FALSE;
3138
3139
3.76M
if (*rec_limit == 0) return FALSE;
3140
3.76M
--(*rec_limit);
3141
3142
/* Note: the base_list[1] contains whether the current opcode has greedy
3143
(represented by a non-zero value) quantifier. This is a different from
3144
other character type lists, which stores here that the character iterator
3145
matches to an empty string (also represented by a non-zero value). */
3146
3147
3.76M
for(;;)
3148
9.53M
  {
3149
  /* All operations move the code pointer forward.
3150
  Therefore infinite recursions are not possible. */
3151
3152
9.53M
  c = *code;
3153
3154
  /* Skip over callouts */
3155
3156
9.53M
  if (c == OP_CALLOUT)
3157
581
    {
3158
581
    code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c];
3159
581
    continue;
3160
581
    }
3161
3162
9.53M
  if (c == OP_ALT)
3163
3.55M
    {
3164
4.00M
    do code += GET(code, 1); while (*code == OP_ALT);
3165
3.55M
    c = *code;
3166
3.55M
    }
3167
3168
9.53M
  switch(c)
3169
9.53M
    {
3170
214k
    case OP_END:
3171
215k
    case OP_KETRPOS:
3172
    /* TRUE only in greedy case. The non-greedy case could be replaced by
3173
    an OP_EXACT, but it is probably not worth it. (And note that OP_EXACT
3174
    uses more memory, which we cannot get at this stage.) */
3175
3176
215k
    return base_list[1] != 0;
3177
3178
5.19M
    case OP_KET:
3179
    /* If the bracket is capturing, and referenced by an OP_RECURSE, or
3180
    it is an atomic sub-pattern (assert, once, etc.) the non-greedy case
3181
    cannot be converted to a possessive form. */
3182
3183
5.19M
    if (base_list[1] == 0) return FALSE;
3184
3185
5.18M
    switch(*(code - GET(code, 1)))
3186
5.18M
      {
3187
722
      case OP_ASSERT:
3188
1.07k
      case OP_ASSERT_NOT:
3189
1.67k
      case OP_ASSERTBACK:
3190
2.00k
      case OP_ASSERTBACK_NOT:
3191
7.19k
      case OP_ONCE:
3192
8.17k
      case OP_ONCE_NC:
3193
      /* Atomic sub-patterns and assertions can always auto-possessify their
3194
      last iterator. However, if the group was entered as a result of checking
3195
      a previous iterator, this is not possible. */
3196
3197
8.17k
      return !entered_a_group;
3198
5.18M
      }
3199
3200
5.17M
    code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c];
3201
5.17M
    continue;
3202
3203
1.91k
    case OP_ONCE:
3204
2.60k
    case OP_ONCE_NC:
3205
8.66k
    case OP_BRA:
3206
3.49M
    case OP_CBRA:
3207
3.49M
    next_code = code + GET(code, 1);
3208
3.49M
    code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c];
3209
3210
4.23M
    while (*next_code == OP_ALT)
3211
3.65M
      {
3212
3.65M
      if (!compare_opcodes(code, utf, cd, base_list, base_end, rec_limit))
3213
2.92M
        return FALSE;
3214
737k
      code = next_code + 1 + LINK_SIZE;
3215
737k
      next_code += GET(next_code, 1);
3216
737k
      }
3217
3218
576k
    entered_a_group = TRUE;
3219
576k
    continue;
3220
3221
12.3k
    case OP_BRAZERO:
3222
12.6k
    case OP_BRAMINZERO:
3223
3224
12.6k
    next_code = code + 1;
3225
12.6k
    if (*next_code != OP_BRA && *next_code != OP_CBRA
3226
1.40k
        && *next_code != OP_ONCE && *next_code != OP_ONCE_NC) return FALSE;
3227
3228
12.2k
    do next_code += GET(next_code, 1); while (*next_code == OP_ALT);
3229
3230
    /* The bracket content will be checked by the
3231
    OP_BRA/OP_CBRA case above. */
3232
11.9k
    next_code += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
3233
11.9k
    if (!compare_opcodes(next_code, utf, cd, base_list, base_end, rec_limit))
3234
4.19k
      return FALSE;
3235
3236
7.76k
    code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c];
3237
7.76k
    continue;
3238
3239
615k
    default:
3240
615k
    break;
3241
9.53M
    }
3242
3243
  /* Check for a supported opcode, and load its properties. */
3244
3245
615k
  code = get_chr_property_list(code, utf, cd->fcc, list);
3246
615k
  if (code == NULL) return FALSE;    /* Unsupported */
3247
3248
  /* If either opcode is a small character list, set pointers for comparing
3249
  characters from that list with another list, or with a property. */
3250
3251
614k
  if (base_list[0] == OP_CHAR)
3252
567k
    {
3253
567k
    chr_ptr = base_list + 2;
3254
567k
    list_ptr = list;
3255
567k
    }
3256
46.7k
  else if (list[0] == OP_CHAR)
3257
27.7k
    {
3258
27.7k
    chr_ptr = list + 2;
3259
27.7k
    list_ptr = base_list;
3260
27.7k
    }
3261
3262
  /* Character bitsets can also be compared to certain opcodes. */
3263
3264
18.9k
  else if (base_list[0] == OP_CLASS || list[0] == OP_CLASS
3265
12.1k
#ifdef COMPILE_PCRE8
3266
      /* In 8 bit, non-UTF mode, OP_CLASS and OP_NCLASS are the same. */
3267
12.1k
      || (!utf && (base_list[0] == OP_NCLASS || list[0] == OP_NCLASS))
3268
18.9k
#endif
3269
18.9k
      )
3270
8.11k
    {
3271
8.11k
#ifdef COMPILE_PCRE8
3272
8.11k
    if (base_list[0] == OP_CLASS || (!utf && base_list[0] == OP_NCLASS))
3273
#else
3274
    if (base_list[0] == OP_CLASS)
3275
#endif
3276
5.44k
      {
3277
5.44k
      set1 = (pcre_uint8 *)(base_end - base_list[2]);
3278
5.44k
      list_ptr = list;
3279
5.44k
      }
3280
2.67k
    else
3281
2.67k
      {
3282
2.67k
      set1 = (pcre_uint8 *)(code - list[2]);
3283
2.67k
      list_ptr = base_list;
3284
2.67k
      }
3285
3286
8.11k
    invert_bits = FALSE;
3287
8.11k
    switch(list_ptr[0])
3288
8.11k
      {
3289
3.34k
      case OP_CLASS:
3290
4.11k
      case OP_NCLASS:
3291
4.11k
      set2 = (pcre_uint8 *)
3292
4.11k
        ((list_ptr == list ? code : base_end) - list_ptr[2]);
3293
4.11k
      break;
3294
3295
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
3296
      case OP_XCLASS:
3297
      xclass_flags = (list_ptr == list ? code : base_end) - list_ptr[2] + LINK_SIZE;
3298
      if ((*xclass_flags & XCL_HASPROP) != 0) return FALSE;
3299
      if ((*xclass_flags & XCL_MAP) == 0)
3300
        {
3301
        /* No bits are set for characters < 256. */
3302
        if (list[1] == 0) return (*xclass_flags & XCL_NOT) == 0;
3303
        /* Might be an empty repeat. */
3304
        continue;
3305
        }
3306
      set2 = (pcre_uint8 *)(xclass_flags + 1);
3307
      break;
3308
#endif
3309
3310
530
      case OP_NOT_DIGIT:
3311
530
      invert_bits = TRUE;
3312
      /* Fall through */
3313
2.20k
      case OP_DIGIT:
3314
2.20k
      set2 = (pcre_uint8 *)(cd->cbits + cbit_digit);
3315
2.20k
      break;
3316
3317
279
      case OP_NOT_WHITESPACE:
3318
279
      invert_bits = TRUE;
3319
      /* Fall through */
3320
459
      case OP_WHITESPACE:
3321
459
      set2 = (pcre_uint8 *)(cd->cbits + cbit_space);
3322
459
      break;
3323
3324
499
      case OP_NOT_WORDCHAR:
3325
499
      invert_bits = TRUE;
3326
      /* Fall through */
3327
748
      case OP_WORDCHAR:
3328
748
      set2 = (pcre_uint8 *)(cd->cbits + cbit_word);
3329
748
      break;
3330
3331
596
      default:
3332
596
      return FALSE;
3333
8.11k
      }
3334
3335
    /* Because the sets are unaligned, we need
3336
    to perform byte comparison here. */
3337
7.52k
    set_end = set1 + 32;
3338
7.52k
    if (invert_bits)
3339
1.30k
      {
3340
1.30k
      do
3341
20.3k
        {
3342
20.3k
        if ((*set1++ & ~(*set2++)) != 0) return FALSE;
3343
20.3k
        }
3344
19.4k
      while (set1 < set_end);
3345
1.30k
      }
3346
6.21k
    else
3347
6.21k
      {
3348
6.21k
      do
3349
94.4k
        {
3350
94.4k
        if ((*set1++ & *set2++) != 0) return FALSE;
3351
94.4k
        }
3352
90.0k
      while (set1 < set_end);
3353
6.21k
      }
3354
3355
2.28k
    if (list[1] == 0) return TRUE;
3356
    /* Might be an empty repeat. */
3357
381
    continue;
3358
2.28k
    }
3359
3360
  /* Some property combinations also acceptable. Unicode property opcodes are
3361
  processed specially; the rest can be handled with a lookup table. */
3362
3363
10.8k
  else
3364
10.8k
    {
3365
10.8k
    pcre_uint32 leftop, rightop;
3366
3367
10.8k
    leftop = base_list[0];
3368
10.8k
    rightop = list[0];
3369
3370
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
3371
    accepted = FALSE; /* Always set in non-unicode case. */
3372
    if (leftop == OP_PROP || leftop == OP_NOTPROP)
3373
      {
3374
      if (rightop == OP_EOD)
3375
        accepted = TRUE;
3376
      else if (rightop == OP_PROP || rightop == OP_NOTPROP)
3377
        {
3378
        int n;
3379
        const pcre_uint8 *p;
3380
        BOOL same = leftop == rightop;
3381
        BOOL lisprop = leftop == OP_PROP;
3382
        BOOL risprop = rightop == OP_PROP;
3383
        BOOL bothprop = lisprop && risprop;
3384
3385
        /* There's a table that specifies how each combination is to be
3386
        processed:
3387
          0   Always return FALSE (never auto-possessify)
3388
          1   Character groups are distinct (possessify if both are OP_PROP)
3389
          2   Check character categories in the same group (general or particular)
3390
          3   Return TRUE if the two opcodes are not the same
3391
          ... see comments below
3392
        */
3393
3394
        n = propposstab[base_list[2]][list[2]];
3395
        switch(n)
3396
          {
3397
          case 0: break;
3398
          case 1: accepted = bothprop; break;
3399
          case 2: accepted = (base_list[3] == list[3]) != same; break;
3400
          case 3: accepted = !same; break;
3401
3402
          case 4:  /* Left general category, right particular category */
3403
          accepted = risprop && catposstab[base_list[3]][list[3]] == same;
3404
          break;
3405
3406
          case 5:  /* Right general category, left particular category */
3407
          accepted = lisprop && catposstab[list[3]][base_list[3]] == same;
3408
          break;
3409
3410
          /* This code is logically tricky. Think hard before fiddling with it.
3411
          The posspropstab table has four entries per row. Each row relates to
3412
          one of PCRE's special properties such as ALNUM or SPACE or WORD.
3413
          Only WORD actually needs all four entries, but using repeats for the
3414
          others means they can all use the same code below.
3415
3416
          The first two entries in each row are Unicode general categories, and
3417
          apply always, because all the characters they include are part of the
3418
          PCRE character set. The third and fourth entries are a general and a
3419
          particular category, respectively, that include one or more relevant
3420
          characters. One or the other is used, depending on whether the check
3421
          is for a general or a particular category. However, in both cases the
3422
          category contains more characters than the specials that are defined
3423
          for the property being tested against. Therefore, it cannot be used
3424
          in a NOTPROP case.
3425
3426
          Example: the row for WORD contains ucp_L, ucp_N, ucp_P, ucp_Po.
3427
          Underscore is covered by ucp_P or ucp_Po. */
3428
3429
          case 6:  /* Left alphanum vs right general category */
3430
          case 7:  /* Left space vs right general category */
3431
          case 8:  /* Left word vs right general category */
3432
          p = posspropstab[n-6];
3433
          accepted = risprop && lisprop ==
3434
            (list[3] != p[0] &&
3435
             list[3] != p[1] &&
3436
            (list[3] != p[2] || !lisprop));
3437
          break;
3438
3439
          case 9:   /* Right alphanum vs left general category */
3440
          case 10:  /* Right space vs left general category */
3441
          case 11:  /* Right word vs left general category */
3442
          p = posspropstab[n-9];
3443
          accepted = lisprop && risprop ==
3444
            (base_list[3] != p[0] &&
3445
             base_list[3] != p[1] &&
3446
            (base_list[3] != p[2] || !risprop));
3447
          break;
3448
3449
          case 12:  /* Left alphanum vs right particular category */
3450
          case 13:  /* Left space vs right particular category */
3451
          case 14:  /* Left word vs right particular category */
3452
          p = posspropstab[n-12];
3453
          accepted = risprop && lisprop ==
3454
            (catposstab[p[0]][list[3]] &&
3455
             catposstab[p[1]][list[3]] &&
3456
            (list[3] != p[3] || !lisprop));
3457
          break;
3458
3459
          case 15:  /* Right alphanum vs left particular category */
3460
          case 16:  /* Right space vs left particular category */
3461
          case 17:  /* Right word vs left particular category */
3462
          p = posspropstab[n-15];
3463
          accepted = lisprop && risprop ==
3464
            (catposstab[p[0]][base_list[3]] &&
3465
             catposstab[p[1]][base_list[3]] &&
3466
            (base_list[3] != p[3] || !risprop));
3467
          break;
3468
          }
3469
        }
3470
      }
3471
3472
    else
3473
#endif  /* SUPPORT_UCP */
3474
3475
10.8k
    accepted = leftop >= FIRST_AUTOTAB_OP && leftop <= LAST_AUTOTAB_LEFT_OP &&
3476
9.57k
           rightop >= FIRST_AUTOTAB_OP && rightop <= LAST_AUTOTAB_RIGHT_OP &&
3477
9.18k
           autoposstab[leftop - FIRST_AUTOTAB_OP][rightop - FIRST_AUTOTAB_OP];
3478
3479
10.8k
    if (!accepted) return FALSE;
3480
3481
463
    if (list[1] == 0) return TRUE;
3482
    /* Might be an empty repeat. */
3483
239
    continue;
3484
463
    }
3485
3486
  /* Control reaches here only if one of the items is a small character list.
3487
  All characters are checked against the other side. */
3488
3489
595k
  do
3490
596k
    {
3491
596k
    chr = *chr_ptr;
3492
3493
596k
    switch(list_ptr[0])
3494
596k
      {
3495
157k
      case OP_CHAR:
3496
157k
      ochr_ptr = list_ptr + 2;
3497
157k
      do
3498
157k
        {
3499
157k
        if (chr == *ochr_ptr) return FALSE;
3500
137k
        ochr_ptr++;
3501
137k
        }
3502
157k
      while(*ochr_ptr != NOTACHAR);
3503
136k
      break;
3504
3505
136k
      case OP_NOT:
3506
3.27k
      ochr_ptr = list_ptr + 2;
3507
3.27k
      do
3508
3.63k
        {
3509
3.63k
        if (chr == *ochr_ptr)
3510
2.05k
          break;
3511
1.57k
        ochr_ptr++;
3512
1.57k
        }
3513
3.27k
      while(*ochr_ptr != NOTACHAR);
3514
3.27k
      if (*ochr_ptr == NOTACHAR) return FALSE;   /* Not found */
3515
2.05k
      break;
3516
3517
      /* Note that OP_DIGIT etc. are generated only when PCRE_UCP is *not*
3518
      set. When it is set, \d etc. are converted into OP_(NOT_)PROP codes. */
3519
3520
2.05k
      case OP_DIGIT:
3521
859
      if (chr < 256 && (cd->ctypes[chr] & ctype_digit) != 0) return FALSE;
3522
298
      break;
3523
3524
803
      case OP_NOT_DIGIT:
3525
803
      if (chr > 255 || (cd->ctypes[chr] & ctype_digit) == 0) return FALSE;
3526
530
      break;
3527
3528
732
      case OP_WHITESPACE:
3529
732
      if (chr < 256 && (cd->ctypes[chr] & ctype_space) != 0) return FALSE;
3530
533
      break;
3531
3532
914
      case OP_NOT_WHITESPACE:
3533
914
      if (chr > 255 || (cd->ctypes[chr] & ctype_space) == 0) return FALSE;
3534
567
      break;
3535
3536
805
      case OP_WORDCHAR:
3537
805
      if (chr < 255 && (cd->ctypes[chr] & ctype_word) != 0) return FALSE;
3538
556
      break;
3539
3540
1.31k
      case OP_NOT_WORDCHAR:
3541
1.31k
      if (chr > 255 || (cd->ctypes[chr] & ctype_word) == 0) return FALSE;
3542
294
      break;
3543
3544
1.13k
      case OP_HSPACE:
3545
1.13k
      switch(chr)
3546
1.13k
        {
3547
883
        HSPACE_CASES: return FALSE;
3548
254
        default: break;
3549
1.13k
        }
3550
254
      break;
3551
3552
2.88k
      case OP_NOT_HSPACE:
3553
2.88k
      switch(chr)
3554
2.88k
        {
3555
2.65k
        HSPACE_CASES: break;
3556
233
        default: return FALSE;
3557
2.88k
        }
3558
2.65k
      break;
3559
3560
2.65k
      case OP_ANYNL:
3561
2.39k
      case OP_VSPACE:
3562
2.39k
      switch(chr)
3563
2.39k
        {
3564
1.90k
        VSPACE_CASES: return FALSE;
3565
487
        default: break;
3566
2.39k
        }
3567
487
      break;
3568
3569
3.10k
      case OP_NOT_VSPACE:
3570
3.10k
      switch(chr)
3571
3.10k
        {
3572
3.02k
        VSPACE_CASES: break;
3573
83
        default: return FALSE;
3574
3.10k
        }
3575
3.02k
      break;
3576
3577
397k
      case OP_DOLL:
3578
398k
      case OP_EODN:
3579
398k
      switch (chr)
3580
398k
        {
3581
232
        case CHAR_CR:
3582
496
        case CHAR_LF:
3583
1.24k
        case CHAR_VT:
3584
1.63k
        case CHAR_FF:
3585
1.93k
        case CHAR_NEL:
3586
1.93k
#ifndef EBCDIC
3587
1.93k
        case 0x2028:
3588
1.93k
        case 0x2029:
3589
1.93k
#endif  /* Not EBCDIC */
3590
1.93k
        return FALSE;
3591
398k
        }
3592
396k
      break;
3593
3594
396k
      case OP_EOD:    /* Can always possessify before \z */
3595
257
      break;
3596
3597
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
3598
      case OP_PROP:
3599
      case OP_NOTPROP:
3600
      if (!check_char_prop(chr, list_ptr[2], list_ptr[3],
3601
            list_ptr[0] == OP_NOTPROP))
3602
        return FALSE;
3603
      break;
3604
#endif
3605
3606
371
      case OP_NCLASS:
3607
371
      if (chr > 255) return FALSE;
3608
      /* Fall through */
3609
3610
9.74k
      case OP_CLASS:
3611
9.74k
      if (chr > 255) break;
3612
9.74k
      class_bitset = (pcre_uint8 *)
3613
9.74k
        ((list_ptr == list ? code : base_end) - list_ptr[2]);
3614
9.74k
      if ((class_bitset[chr >> 3] & (1U << (chr & 7))) != 0) return FALSE;
3615
9.31k
      break;
3616
3617
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
3618
      case OP_XCLASS:
3619
      if (PRIV(xclass)(chr, (list_ptr == list ? code : base_end) -
3620
          list_ptr[2] + LINK_SIZE, utf)) return FALSE;
3621
      break;
3622
#endif
3623
3624
12.3k
      default:
3625
12.3k
      return FALSE;
3626
596k
      }
3627
3628
553k
    chr_ptr++;
3629
553k
    }
3630
595k
  while(*chr_ptr != NOTACHAR);
3631
3632
  /* At least one character must be matched from this opcode. */
3633
3634
553k
  if (list[1] == 0) return TRUE;
3635
553k
  }
3636
3637
/* Control never reaches here. There used to be a fail-save return FALSE; here,
3638
but some compilers complain about an unreachable statement. */
3639
3640
3.76M
}
3641
3642
3643
3644
/*************************************************
3645
*    Scan compiled regex for auto-possession     *
3646
*************************************************/
3647
3648
/* Replaces single character iterations with their possessive alternatives
3649
if appropriate. This function modifies the compiled opcode!
3650
3651
Arguments:
3652
  code        points to start of the byte code
3653
  utf         TRUE in UTF-8 / UTF-16 / UTF-32 mode
3654
  cd          static compile data
3655
3656
Returns:      nothing
3657
*/
3658
3659
static void
3660
auto_possessify(pcre_uchar *code, BOOL utf, const compile_data *cd)
3661
15.7k
{
3662
15.7k
register pcre_uchar c;
3663
15.7k
const pcre_uchar *end;
3664
15.7k
pcre_uchar *repeat_opcode;
3665
15.7k
pcre_uint32 list[8];
3666
15.7k
int rec_limit;
3667
3668
15.7k
for (;;)
3669
4.00M
  {
3670
4.00M
  c = *code;
3671
3672
  /* When a pattern with bad UTF-8 encoding is compiled with NO_UTF_CHECK,
3673
  it may compile without complaining, but may get into a loop here if the code
3674
  pointer points to a bad value. This is, of course a documentated possibility,
3675
  when NO_UTF_CHECK is set, so it isn't a bug, but we can detect this case and
3676
  just give up on this optimization. */
3677
3678
4.00M
  if (c >= OP_TABLE_LENGTH) return;
3679
3680
4.00M
  if (c >= OP_STAR && c <= OP_TYPEPOSUPTO)
3681
247k
    {
3682
247k
    c -= get_repeat_base(c) - OP_STAR;
3683
247k
    end = (c <= OP_MINUPTO) ?
3684
247k
      get_chr_property_list(code, utf, cd->fcc, list) : NULL;
3685
247k
    list[1] = c == OP_STAR || c == OP_PLUS || c == OP_QUERY || c == OP_UPTO;
3686
3687
247k
    rec_limit = 1000;
3688
247k
    if (end != NULL && compare_opcodes(end, utf, cd, list, end, &rec_limit))
3689
21.1k
      {
3690
21.1k
      switch(c)
3691
21.1k
        {
3692
4.31k
        case OP_STAR:
3693
4.31k
        *code += OP_POSSTAR - OP_STAR;
3694
4.31k
        break;
3695
3696
299
        case OP_MINSTAR:
3697
299
        *code += OP_POSSTAR - OP_MINSTAR;
3698
299
        break;
3699
3700
6.57k
        case OP_PLUS:
3701
6.57k
        *code += OP_POSPLUS - OP_PLUS;
3702
6.57k
        break;
3703
3704
399
        case OP_MINPLUS:
3705
399
        *code += OP_POSPLUS - OP_MINPLUS;
3706
399
        break;
3707
3708
8.18k
        case OP_QUERY:
3709
8.18k
        *code += OP_POSQUERY - OP_QUERY;
3710
8.18k
        break;
3711
3712
591
        case OP_MINQUERY:
3713
591
        *code += OP_POSQUERY - OP_MINQUERY;
3714
591
        break;
3715
3716
486
        case OP_UPTO:
3717
486
        *code += OP_POSUPTO - OP_UPTO;
3718
486
        break;
3719
3720
316
        case OP_MINUPTO:
3721
316
        *code += OP_POSUPTO - OP_MINUPTO;
3722
316
        break;
3723
21.1k
        }
3724
21.1k
      }
3725
247k
    c = *code;
3726
247k
    }
3727
3.75M
  else if (c == OP_CLASS || c == OP_NCLASS || c == OP_XCLASS)
3728
24.2k
    {
3729
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
3730
    if (c == OP_XCLASS)
3731
      repeat_opcode = code + GET(code, 1);
3732
    else
3733
#endif
3734
24.2k
      repeat_opcode = code + 1 + (32 / sizeof(pcre_uchar));
3735
3736
24.2k
    c = *repeat_opcode;
3737
24.2k
    if (c >= OP_CRSTAR && c <= OP_CRMINRANGE)
3738
14.9k
      {
3739
      /* end must not be NULL. */
3740
14.9k
      end = get_chr_property_list(code, utf, cd->fcc, list);
3741
3742
14.9k
      list[1] = (c & 1) == 0;
3743
3744
14.9k
      rec_limit = 1000;
3745
14.9k
      if (compare_opcodes(end, utf, cd, list, end, &rec_limit))
3746
7.74k
        {
3747
7.74k
        switch (c)
3748
7.74k
          {
3749
614
          case OP_CRSTAR:
3750
2.10k
          case OP_CRMINSTAR:
3751
2.10k
          *repeat_opcode = OP_CRPOSSTAR;
3752
2.10k
          break;
3753
3754
970
          case OP_CRPLUS:
3755
1.23k
          case OP_CRMINPLUS:
3756
1.23k
          *repeat_opcode = OP_CRPOSPLUS;
3757
1.23k
          break;
3758
3759
829
          case OP_CRQUERY:
3760
1.57k
          case OP_CRMINQUERY:
3761
1.57k
          *repeat_opcode = OP_CRPOSQUERY;
3762
1.57k
          break;
3763
3764
1.81k
          case OP_CRRANGE:
3765
2.84k
          case OP_CRMINRANGE:
3766
2.84k
          *repeat_opcode = OP_CRPOSRANGE;
3767
2.84k
          break;
3768
7.74k
          }
3769
7.74k
        }
3770
14.9k
      }
3771
24.2k
    c = *code;
3772
24.2k
    }
3773
3774
4.00M
  switch(c)
3775
4.00M
    {
3776
15.7k
    case OP_END:
3777
15.7k
    return;
3778
3779
15.6k
    case OP_TYPESTAR:
3780
16.6k
    case OP_TYPEMINSTAR:
3781
20.1k
    case OP_TYPEPLUS:
3782
20.9k
    case OP_TYPEMINPLUS:
3783
26.0k
    case OP_TYPEQUERY:
3784
26.8k
    case OP_TYPEMINQUERY:
3785
29.1k
    case OP_TYPEPOSSTAR:
3786
31.2k
    case OP_TYPEPOSPLUS:
3787
35.1k
    case OP_TYPEPOSQUERY:
3788
35.1k
    if (code[1] == OP_PROP || code[1] == OP_NOTPROP) code += 2;
3789
35.1k
    break;
3790
3791
707
    case OP_TYPEUPTO:
3792
1.50k
    case OP_TYPEMINUPTO:
3793
6.44k
    case OP_TYPEEXACT:
3794
8.63k
    case OP_TYPEPOSUPTO:
3795
8.63k
    if (code[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_PROP || code[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_NOTPROP)
3796
0
      code += 2;
3797
8.63k
    break;
3798
3799
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
3800
    case OP_XCLASS:
3801
    code += GET(code, 1);
3802
    break;
3803
#endif
3804
3805
2.69k
    case OP_MARK:
3806
4.13k
    case OP_PRUNE_ARG:
3807
5.53k
    case OP_SKIP_ARG:
3808
8.04k
    case OP_THEN_ARG:
3809
8.04k
    code += code[1];
3810
8.04k
    break;
3811
4.00M
    }
3812
3813
  /* Add in the fixed length from the table */
3814
3815
3.99M
  code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c];
3816
3817
  /* In UTF-8 mode, opcodes that are followed by a character may be followed by
3818
  a multi-byte character. The length in the table is a minimum, so we have to
3819
  arrange to skip the extra bytes. */
3820
3821
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32
3822
  if (utf) switch(c)
3823
    {
3824
    case OP_CHAR:
3825
    case OP_CHARI:
3826
    case OP_NOT:
3827
    case OP_NOTI:
3828
    case OP_STAR:
3829
    case OP_MINSTAR:
3830
    case OP_PLUS:
3831
    case OP_MINPLUS:
3832
    case OP_QUERY:
3833
    case OP_MINQUERY:
3834
    case OP_UPTO:
3835
    case OP_MINUPTO:
3836
    case OP_EXACT:
3837
    case OP_POSSTAR:
3838
    case OP_POSPLUS:
3839
    case OP_POSQUERY:
3840
    case OP_POSUPTO:
3841
    case OP_STARI:
3842
    case OP_MINSTARI:
3843
    case OP_PLUSI:
3844
    case OP_MINPLUSI:
3845
    case OP_QUERYI:
3846
    case OP_MINQUERYI:
3847
    case OP_UPTOI:
3848
    case OP_MINUPTOI:
3849
    case OP_EXACTI:
3850
    case OP_POSSTARI:
3851
    case OP_POSPLUSI:
3852
    case OP_POSQUERYI:
3853
    case OP_POSUPTOI:
3854
    case OP_NOTSTAR:
3855
    case OP_NOTMINSTAR:
3856
    case OP_NOTPLUS:
3857
    case OP_NOTMINPLUS:
3858
    case OP_NOTQUERY:
3859
    case OP_NOTMINQUERY:
3860
    case OP_NOTUPTO:
3861
    case OP_NOTMINUPTO:
3862
    case OP_NOTEXACT:
3863
    case OP_NOTPOSSTAR:
3864
    case OP_NOTPOSPLUS:
3865
    case OP_NOTPOSQUERY:
3866
    case OP_NOTPOSUPTO:
3867
    case OP_NOTSTARI:
3868
    case OP_NOTMINSTARI:
3869
    case OP_NOTPLUSI:
3870
    case OP_NOTMINPLUSI:
3871
    case OP_NOTQUERYI:
3872
    case OP_NOTMINQUERYI:
3873
    case OP_NOTUPTOI:
3874
    case OP_NOTMINUPTOI:
3875
    case OP_NOTEXACTI:
3876
    case OP_NOTPOSSTARI:
3877
    case OP_NOTPOSPLUSI:
3878
    case OP_NOTPOSQUERYI:
3879
    case OP_NOTPOSUPTOI:
3880
    if (HAS_EXTRALEN(code[-1])) code += GET_EXTRALEN(code[-1]);
3881
    break;
3882
    }
3883
#else
3884
3.99M
  (void)(utf);  /* Keep compiler happy by referencing function argument */
3885
3.99M
#endif
3886
3.99M
  }
3887
15.7k
}
3888
3889
3890
3891
/*************************************************
3892
*           Check for POSIX class syntax         *
3893
*************************************************/
3894
3895
/* This function is called when the sequence "[:" or "[." or "[=" is
3896
encountered in a character class. It checks whether this is followed by a
3897
sequence of characters terminated by a matching ":]" or ".]" or "=]". If we
3898
reach an unescaped ']' without the special preceding character, return FALSE.
3899
3900
Originally, this function only recognized a sequence of letters between the
3901
terminators, but it seems that Perl recognizes any sequence of characters,
3902
though of course unknown POSIX names are subsequently rejected. Perl gives an
3903
"Unknown POSIX class" error for [:f\oo:] for example, where previously PCRE
3904
didn't consider this to be a POSIX class. Likewise for [:1234:].
3905
3906
The problem in trying to be exactly like Perl is in the handling of escapes. We
3907
have to be sure that [abc[:x\]pqr] is *not* treated as containing a POSIX
3908
class, but [abc[:x\]pqr:]] is (so that an error can be generated). The code
3909
below handles the special cases \\ and \], but does not try to do any other
3910
escape processing. This makes it different from Perl for cases such as
3911
[:l\ower:] where Perl recognizes it as the POSIX class "lower" but PCRE does
3912
not recognize "l\ower". This is a lesser evil than not diagnosing bad classes
3913
when Perl does, I think.
3914
3915
A user pointed out that PCRE was rejecting [:a[:digit:]] whereas Perl was not.
3916
It seems that the appearance of a nested POSIX class supersedes an apparent
3917
external class. For example, [:a[:digit:]b:] matches "a", "b", ":", or
3918
a digit.
3919
3920
In Perl, unescaped square brackets may also appear as part of class names. For
3921
example, [:a[:abc]b:] gives unknown POSIX class "[:abc]b:]". However, for
3922
[:a[:abc]b][b:] it gives unknown POSIX class "[:abc]b][b:]", which does not
3923
seem right at all. PCRE does not allow closing square brackets in POSIX class
3924
names.
3925
3926
Arguments:
3927
  ptr      pointer to the initial [
3928
  endptr   where to return the end pointer
3929
3930
Returns:   TRUE or FALSE
3931
*/
3932
3933
static BOOL
3934
check_posix_syntax(const pcre_uchar *ptr, const pcre_uchar **endptr)
3935
3.96k
{
3936
3.96k
pcre_uchar terminator;          /* Don't combine these lines; the Solaris cc */
3937
3.96k
terminator = *(++ptr);   /* compiler warns about "non-constant" initializer. */
3938
1.55M
for (++ptr; *ptr != CHAR_NULL; ptr++)
3939
1.55M
  {
3940
1.55M
  if (*ptr == CHAR_BACKSLASH &&
3941
91.0k
      (ptr[1] == CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET ||
3942
90.8k
       ptr[1] == CHAR_BACKSLASH))
3943
974
    ptr++;
3944
1.55M
  else if ((*ptr == CHAR_LEFT_SQUARE_BRACKET && ptr[1] == terminator) ||
3945
1.55M
            *ptr == CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET) return FALSE;
3946
1.55M
  else if (*ptr == terminator && ptr[1] == CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET)
3947
1.07k
    {
3948
1.07k
    *endptr = ptr;
3949
1.07k
    return TRUE;
3950
1.07k
    }
3951
1.55M
  }
3952
123
return FALSE;
3953
3.96k
}
3954
3955
3956
3957
3958
/*************************************************
3959
*          Check POSIX class name                *
3960
*************************************************/
3961
3962
/* This function is called to check the name given in a POSIX-style class entry
3963
such as [:alnum:].
3964
3965
Arguments:
3966
  ptr        points to the first letter
3967
  len        the length of the name
3968
3969
Returns:     a value representing the name, or -1 if unknown
3970
*/
3971
3972
static int
3973
check_posix_name(const pcre_uchar *ptr, int len)
3974
1.06k
{
3975
1.06k
const char *pn = posix_names;
3976
1.06k
register int yield = 0;
3977
7.16k
while (posix_name_lengths[yield] != 0)
3978
7.06k
  {
3979
7.06k
  if (len == posix_name_lengths[yield] &&
3980
3.54k
    STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr, pn, (unsigned int)len) == 0) return yield;
3981
6.09k
  pn += posix_name_lengths[yield] + 1;
3982
6.09k
  yield++;
3983
6.09k
  }
3984
93
return -1;
3985
1.06k
}
3986
3987
3988
/*************************************************
3989
*    Adjust OP_RECURSE items in repeated group   *
3990
*************************************************/
3991
3992
/* OP_RECURSE items contain an offset from the start of the regex to the group
3993
that is referenced. This means that groups can be replicated for fixed
3994
repetition simply by copying (because the recursion is allowed to refer to
3995
earlier groups that are outside the current group). However, when a group is
3996
optional (i.e. the minimum quantifier is zero), OP_BRAZERO or OP_SKIPZERO is
3997
inserted before it, after it has been compiled. This means that any OP_RECURSE
3998
items within it that refer to the group itself or any contained groups have to
3999
have their offsets adjusted. That one of the jobs of this function. Before it
4000
is called, the partially compiled regex must be temporarily terminated with
4001
OP_END.
4002
4003
This function has been extended to cope with forward references for recursions
4004
and subroutine calls. It must check the list of such references for the
4005
group we are dealing with. If it finds that one of the recursions in the
4006
current group is on this list, it does not adjust the value in the reference
4007
(which is a group number). After the group has been scanned, all the offsets in
4008
the forward reference list for the group are adjusted.
4009
4010
Arguments:
4011
  group      points to the start of the group
4012
  adjust     the amount by which the group is to be moved
4013
  utf        TRUE in UTF-8 / UTF-16 / UTF-32 mode
4014
  cd         contains pointers to tables etc.
4015
  save_hwm_offset   the hwm forward reference offset at the start of the group
4016
4017
Returns:     nothing
4018
*/
4019
4020
static void
4021
adjust_recurse(pcre_uchar *group, int adjust, BOOL utf, compile_data *cd,
4022
  size_t save_hwm_offset)
4023
143k
{
4024
143k
int offset;
4025
143k
pcre_uchar *hc;
4026
143k
pcre_uchar *ptr = group;
4027
4028
180k
while ((ptr = (pcre_uchar *)find_recurse(ptr, utf)) != NULL)
4029
37.3k
  {
4030
39.2M
  for (hc = (pcre_uchar *)cd->start_workspace + save_hwm_offset; hc < cd->hwm;
4031
39.2M
       hc += LINK_SIZE)
4032
39.2M
    {
4033
39.2M
    offset = (int)GET(hc, 0);
4034
39.2M
    if (cd->start_code + offset == ptr + 1) break;
4035
39.2M
    }
4036
4037
  /* If we have not found this recursion on the forward reference list, adjust
4038
  the recursion's offset if it's after the start of this group. */
4039
4040
37.3k
  if (hc >= cd->hwm)
4041
18.2k
    {
4042
18.2k
    offset = (int)GET(ptr, 1);
4043
18.2k
    if (cd->start_code + offset >= group) PUT(ptr, 1, offset + adjust);
4044
18.2k
    }
4045
4046
37.3k
  ptr += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
4047
37.3k
  }
4048
4049
/* Now adjust all forward reference offsets for the group. */
4050
4051
165k
for (hc = (pcre_uchar *)cd->start_workspace + save_hwm_offset; hc < cd->hwm;
4052
143k
     hc += LINK_SIZE)
4053
22.0k
  {
4054
22.0k
  offset = (int)GET(hc, 0);
4055
22.0k
  PUT(hc, 0, offset + adjust);
4056
22.0k
  }
4057
143k
}
4058
4059
4060
4061
/*************************************************
4062
*        Insert an automatic callout point       *
4063
*************************************************/
4064
4065
/* This function is called when the PCRE_AUTO_CALLOUT option is set, to insert
4066
callout points before each pattern item.
4067
4068
Arguments:
4069
  code           current code pointer
4070
  ptr            current pattern pointer
4071
  cd             pointers to tables etc
4072
4073
Returns:         new code pointer
4074
*/
4075
4076
static pcre_uchar *
4077
auto_callout(pcre_uchar *code, const pcre_uchar *ptr, compile_data *cd)
4078
0
{
4079
0
*code++ = OP_CALLOUT;
4080
0
*code++ = 255;
4081
0
PUT(code, 0, (int)(ptr - cd->start_pattern));  /* Pattern offset */
4082
0
PUT(code, LINK_SIZE, 0);                       /* Default length */
4083
0
return code + 2 * LINK_SIZE;
4084
0
}
4085
4086
4087
4088
/*************************************************
4089
*         Complete a callout item                *
4090
*************************************************/
4091
4092
/* A callout item contains the length of the next item in the pattern, which
4093
we can't fill in till after we have reached the relevant point. This is used
4094
for both automatic and manual callouts.
4095
4096
Arguments:
4097
  previous_callout   points to previous callout item
4098
  ptr                current pattern pointer
4099
  cd                 pointers to tables etc
4100
4101
Returns:             nothing
4102
*/
4103
4104
static void
4105
complete_callout(pcre_uchar *previous_callout, const pcre_uchar *ptr, compile_data *cd)
4106
699
{
4107
699
int length = (int)(ptr - cd->start_pattern - GET(previous_callout, 2));
4108
699
PUT(previous_callout, 2 + LINK_SIZE, length);
4109
699
}
4110
4111
4112
4113
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
4114
/*************************************************
4115
*           Get othercase range                  *
4116
*************************************************/
4117
4118
/* This function is passed the start and end of a class range, in UTF-8 mode
4119
with UCP support. It searches up the characters, looking for ranges of
4120
characters in the "other" case. Each call returns the next one, updating the
4121
start address. A character with multiple other cases is returned on its own
4122
with a special return value.
4123
4124
Arguments:
4125
  cptr        points to starting character value; updated
4126
  d           end value
4127
  ocptr       where to put start of othercase range
4128
  odptr       where to put end of othercase range
4129
4130
Yield:        -1 when no more
4131
               0 when a range is returned
4132
              >0 the CASESET offset for char with multiple other cases
4133
                in this case, ocptr contains the original
4134
*/
4135
4136
static int
4137
get_othercase_range(pcre_uint32 *cptr, pcre_uint32 d, pcre_uint32 *ocptr,
4138
  pcre_uint32 *odptr)
4139
{
4140
pcre_uint32 c, othercase, next;
4141
unsigned int co;
4142
4143
/* Find the first character that has an other case. If it has multiple other
4144
cases, return its case offset value. */
4145
4146
for (c = *cptr; c <= d; c++)
4147
  {
4148
  if ((co = UCD_CASESET(c)) != 0)
4149
    {
4150
    *ocptr = c++;   /* Character that has the set */
4151
    *cptr = c;      /* Rest of input range */
4152
    return (int)co;
4153
    }
4154
  if ((othercase = UCD_OTHERCASE(c)) != c) break;
4155
  }
4156
4157
if (c > d) return -1;  /* Reached end of range */
4158
4159
/* Found a character that has a single other case. Search for the end of the
4160
range, which is either the end of the input range, or a character that has zero
4161
or more than one other cases. */
4162
4163
*ocptr = othercase;
4164
next = othercase + 1;
4165
4166
for (++c; c <= d; c++)
4167
  {
4168
  if ((co = UCD_CASESET(c)) != 0 || UCD_OTHERCASE(c) != next) break;
4169
  next++;
4170
  }
4171
4172
*odptr = next - 1;     /* End of othercase range */
4173
*cptr = c;             /* Rest of input range */
4174
return 0;
4175
}
4176
#endif  /* SUPPORT_UCP */
4177
4178
4179
4180
/*************************************************
4181
*        Add a character or range to a class     *
4182
*************************************************/
4183
4184
/* This function packages up the logic of adding a character or range of
4185
characters to a class. The character values in the arguments will be within the
4186
valid values for the current mode (8-bit, 16-bit, UTF, etc). This function is
4187
mutually recursive with the function immediately below.
4188
4189
Arguments:
4190
  classbits     the bit map for characters < 256
4191
  uchardptr     points to the pointer for extra data
4192
  options       the options word
4193
  cd            contains pointers to tables etc.
4194
  start         start of range character
4195
  end           end of range character
4196
4197
Returns:        the number of < 256 characters added
4198
                the pointer to extra data is updated
4199
*/
4200
4201
static int
4202
add_to_class(pcre_uint8 *classbits, pcre_uchar **uchardptr, int options,
4203
  compile_data *cd, pcre_uint32 start, pcre_uint32 end)
4204
759k
{
4205
759k
pcre_uint32 c;
4206
759k
pcre_uint32 classbits_end = (end <= 0xff ? end : 0xff);
4207
759k
int n8 = 0;
4208
4209
759k
((void)uchardptr);
4210
759k
((void)propposstab);
4211
759k
((void)catposstab);
4212
759k
((void)posspropstab);
4213
4214
/* If caseless matching is required, scan the range and process alternate
4215
cases. In Unicode, there are 8-bit characters that have alternate cases that
4216
are greater than 255 and vice-versa. Sometimes we can just extend the original
4217
range. */
4218
4219
759k
if ((options & PCRE_CASELESS) != 0)
4220
2.61k
  {
4221
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
4222
  if ((options & PCRE_UTF8) != 0)
4223
    {
4224
    int rc;
4225
    pcre_uint32 oc, od;
4226
4227
    options &= ~PCRE_CASELESS;   /* Remove for recursive calls */
4228
    c = start;
4229
4230
    while ((rc = get_othercase_range(&c, end, &oc, &od)) >= 0)
4231
      {
4232
      /* Handle a single character that has more than one other case. */
4233
4234
      if (rc > 0) n8 += add_list_to_class(classbits, uchardptr, options, cd,
4235
        PRIV(ucd_caseless_sets) + rc, oc);
4236
4237
      /* Do nothing if the other case range is within the original range. */
4238
4239
      else if (oc >= start && od <= end) continue;
4240
4241
      /* Extend the original range if there is overlap, noting that if oc < c, we
4242
      can't have od > end because a subrange is always shorter than the basic
4243
      range. Otherwise, use a recursive call to add the additional range. */
4244
4245
      else if (oc < start && od >= start - 1) start = oc; /* Extend downwards */
4246
      else if (od > end && oc <= end + 1)
4247
        {
4248
        end = od;       /* Extend upwards */
4249
        if (end > classbits_end) classbits_end = (end <= 0xff ? end : 0xff);
4250
        }
4251
      else n8 += add_to_class(classbits, uchardptr, options, cd, oc, od);
4252
      }
4253
    }
4254
  else
4255
#endif  /* SUPPORT_UCP */
4256
4257
  /* Not UTF-mode, or no UCP */
4258
4259
9.42k
  for (c = start; c <= classbits_end; c++)
4260
6.81k
    {
4261
6.81k
    SETBIT(classbits, cd->fcc[c]);
4262
6.81k
    n8++;
4263
6.81k
    }
4264
2.61k
  }
4265
4266
/* Now handle the original range. Adjust the final value according to the bit
4267
length - this means that the same lists of (e.g.) horizontal spaces can be used
4268
in all cases. */
4269
4270
759k
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE8
4271
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
4272
  if ((options & PCRE_UTF8) == 0)
4273
#endif
4274
759k
  if (end > 0xff) end = 0xff;
4275
4276
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16
4277
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
4278
  if ((options & PCRE_UTF16) == 0)
4279
#endif
4280
  if (end > 0xffff) end = 0xffff;
4281
4282
#endif /* COMPILE_PCRE[8|16] */
4283
4284
/* Use the bitmap for characters < 256. Otherwise use extra data.*/
4285
4286
1.84M
for (c = start; c <= classbits_end; c++)
4287
1.08M
  {
4288
  /* Regardless of start, c will always be <= 255. */
4289
1.08M
  SETBIT(classbits, c);
4290
1.08M
  n8++;
4291
1.08M
  }
4292
4293
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
4294
if (start <= 0xff) start = 0xff + 1;
4295
4296
if (end >= start)
4297
  {
4298
  pcre_uchar *uchardata = *uchardptr;
4299
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
4300
  if ((options & PCRE_UTF8) != 0)  /* All UTFs use the same flag bit */
4301
    {
4302
    if (start < end)
4303
      {
4304
      *uchardata++ = XCL_RANGE;
4305
      uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(start, uchardata);
4306
      uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(end, uchardata);
4307
      }
4308
    else if (start == end)
4309
      {
4310
      *uchardata++ = XCL_SINGLE;
4311
      uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(start, uchardata);
4312
      }
4313
    }
4314
  else
4315
#endif  /* SUPPORT_UTF */
4316
4317
  /* Without UTF support, character values are constrained by the bit length,
4318
  and can only be > 256 for 16-bit and 32-bit libraries. */
4319
4320
#ifdef COMPILE_PCRE8
4321
    {}
4322
#else
4323
  if (start < end)
4324
    {
4325
    *uchardata++ = XCL_RANGE;
4326
    *uchardata++ = start;
4327
    *uchardata++ = end;
4328
    }
4329
  else if (start == end)
4330
    {
4331
    *uchardata++ = XCL_SINGLE;
4332
    *uchardata++ = start;
4333
    }
4334
#endif
4335
4336
  *uchardptr = uchardata;   /* Updata extra data pointer */
4337
  }
4338
#endif /* SUPPORT_UTF || !COMPILE_PCRE8 */
4339
4340
759k
return n8;    /* Number of 8-bit characters */
4341
759k
}
4342
4343
4344
4345
4346
/*************************************************
4347
*        Add a list of characters to a class     *
4348
*************************************************/
4349
4350
/* This function is used for adding a list of case-equivalent characters to a
4351
class, and also for adding a list of horizontal or vertical whitespace. If the
4352
list is in order (which it should be), ranges of characters are detected and
4353
handled appropriately. This function is mutually recursive with the function
4354
above.
4355
4356
Arguments:
4357
  classbits     the bit map for characters < 256
4358
  uchardptr     points to the pointer for extra data
4359
  options       the options word
4360
  cd            contains pointers to tables etc.
4361
  p             points to row of 32-bit values, terminated by NOTACHAR
4362
  except        character to omit; this is used when adding lists of
4363
                  case-equivalent characters to avoid including the one we
4364
                  already know about
4365
4366
Returns:        the number of < 256 characters added
4367
                the pointer to extra data is updated
4368
*/
4369
4370
static int
4371
add_list_to_class(pcre_uint8 *classbits, pcre_uchar **uchardptr, int options,
4372
  compile_data *cd, const pcre_uint32 *p, unsigned int except)
4373
751
{
4374
751
int n8 = 0;
4375
5.04k
while (p[0] < NOTACHAR)
4376
4.29k
  {
4377
4.29k
  int n = 0;
4378
4.29k
  if (p[0] != except)
4379
4.29k
    {
4380
9.33k
    while(p[n+1] == p[0] + n + 1) n++;
4381
4.29k
    n8 += add_to_class(classbits, uchardptr, options, cd, p[0], p[n]);
4382
4.29k
    }
4383
4.29k
  p += n + 1;
4384
4.29k
  }
4385
751
return n8;
4386
751
}
4387
4388
4389
4390
/*************************************************
4391
*    Add characters not in a list to a class     *
4392
*************************************************/
4393
4394
/* This function is used for adding the complement of a list of horizontal or
4395
vertical whitespace to a class. The list must be in order.
4396
4397
Arguments:
4398
  classbits     the bit map for characters < 256
4399
  uchardptr     points to the pointer for extra data
4400
  options       the options word
4401
  cd            contains pointers to tables etc.
4402
  p             points to row of 32-bit values, terminated by NOTACHAR
4403
4404
Returns:        the number of < 256 characters added
4405
                the pointer to extra data is updated
4406
*/
4407
4408
static int
4409
add_not_list_to_class(pcre_uint8 *classbits, pcre_uchar **uchardptr,
4410
  int options, compile_data *cd, const pcre_uint32 *p)
4411
1.01k
{
4412
1.01k
BOOL utf = (options & PCRE_UTF8) != 0;
4413
1.01k
int n8 = 0;
4414
1.01k
if (p[0] > 0)
4415
1.01k
  n8 += add_to_class(classbits, uchardptr, options, cd, 0, p[0] - 1);
4416
8.09k
while (p[0] < NOTACHAR)
4417
7.07k
  {
4418
15.1k
  while (p[1] == p[0] + 1) p++;
4419
7.07k
  n8 += add_to_class(classbits, uchardptr, options, cd, p[0] + 1,
4420
7.07k
    (p[1] == NOTACHAR) ? (utf ? 0x10ffffu : 0xffffffffu) : p[1] - 1);
4421
7.07k
  p++;
4422
7.07k
  }
4423
1.01k
return n8;
4424
1.01k
}
4425
4426
4427
4428
/*************************************************
4429
*           Compile one branch                   *
4430
*************************************************/
4431
4432
/* Scan the pattern, compiling it into the a vector. If the options are
4433
changed during the branch, the pointer is used to change the external options
4434
bits. This function is used during the pre-compile phase when we are trying
4435
to find out the amount of memory needed, as well as during the real compile
4436
phase. The value of lengthptr distinguishes the two phases.
4437
4438
Arguments:
4439
  optionsptr        pointer to the option bits
4440
  codeptr           points to the pointer to the current code point
4441
  ptrptr            points to the current pattern pointer
4442
  errorcodeptr      points to error code variable
4443
  firstcharptr      place to put the first required character
4444
  firstcharflagsptr place to put the first character flags, or a negative number
4445
  reqcharptr        place to put the last required character
4446
  reqcharflagsptr   place to put the last required character flags, or a negative number
4447
  bcptr             points to current branch chain
4448
  cond_depth        conditional nesting depth
4449
  cd                contains pointers to tables etc.
4450
  lengthptr         NULL during the real compile phase
4451
                    points to length accumulator during pre-compile phase
4452
4453
Returns:            TRUE on success
4454
                    FALSE, with *errorcodeptr set non-zero on error
4455
*/
4456
4457
static BOOL
4458
compile_branch(int *optionsptr, pcre_uchar **codeptr,
4459
  const pcre_uchar **ptrptr, int *errorcodeptr,
4460
  pcre_uint32 *firstcharptr, pcre_int32 *firstcharflagsptr,
4461
  pcre_uint32 *reqcharptr, pcre_int32 *reqcharflagsptr,
4462
  branch_chain *bcptr, int cond_depth,
4463
  compile_data *cd, int *lengthptr)
4464
778k
{
4465
778k
int repeat_type, op_type;
4466
778k
int repeat_min = 0, repeat_max = 0;      /* To please picky compilers */
4467
778k
int bravalue = 0;
4468
778k
int greedy_default, greedy_non_default;
4469
778k
pcre_uint32 firstchar, reqchar;
4470
778k
pcre_int32 firstcharflags, reqcharflags;
4471
778k
pcre_uint32 zeroreqchar, zerofirstchar;
4472
778k
pcre_int32 zeroreqcharflags, zerofirstcharflags;
4473
778k
pcre_int32 req_caseopt, reqvary, tempreqvary;
4474
778k
int options = *optionsptr;               /* May change dynamically */
4475
778k
int after_manual_callout = 0;
4476
778k
int length_prevgroup = 0;
4477
778k
register pcre_uint32 c;
4478
778k
int escape;
4479
778k
register pcre_uchar *code = *codeptr;
4480
778k
pcre_uchar *last_code = code;
4481
778k
pcre_uchar *orig_code = code;
4482
778k
pcre_uchar *tempcode;
4483
778k
BOOL inescq = FALSE;
4484
778k
BOOL groupsetfirstchar = FALSE;
4485
778k
const pcre_uchar *ptr = *ptrptr;
4486
778k
const pcre_uchar *tempptr;
4487
778k
const pcre_uchar *nestptr = NULL;
4488
778k
pcre_uchar *previous = NULL;
4489
778k
pcre_uchar *previous_callout = NULL;
4490
778k
size_t item_hwm_offset = 0;
4491
778k
pcre_uint8 classbits[32];
4492
4493
/* We can fish out the UTF-8 setting once and for all into a BOOL, but we
4494
must not do this for other options (e.g. PCRE_EXTENDED) because they may change
4495
dynamically as we process the pattern. */
4496
4497
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
4498
/* PCRE_UTF[16|32] have the same value as PCRE_UTF8. */
4499
BOOL utf = (options & PCRE_UTF8) != 0;
4500
#ifndef COMPILE_PCRE32
4501
pcre_uchar utf_chars[6];
4502
#endif
4503
#else
4504
778k
BOOL utf = FALSE;
4505
778k
#endif
4506
4507
/* Helper variables for OP_XCLASS opcode (for characters > 255). We define
4508
class_uchardata always so that it can be passed to add_to_class() always,
4509
though it will not be used in non-UTF 8-bit cases. This avoids having to supply
4510
alternative calls for the different cases. */
4511
4512
778k
pcre_uchar *class_uchardata;
4513
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
4514
BOOL xclass;
4515
pcre_uchar *class_uchardata_base;
4516
#endif
4517
4518
#ifdef PCRE_DEBUG
4519
if (lengthptr != NULL) DPRINTF((">> start branch\n"));
4520
#endif
4521
4522
/* Set up the default and non-default settings for greediness */
4523
4524
778k
greedy_default = ((options & PCRE_UNGREEDY) != 0);
4525
778k
greedy_non_default = greedy_default ^ 1;
4526
4527
/* Initialize no first byte, no required byte. REQ_UNSET means "no char
4528
matching encountered yet". It gets changed to REQ_NONE if we hit something that
4529
matches a non-fixed char first char; reqchar just remains unset if we never
4530
find one.
4531
4532
When we hit a repeat whose minimum is zero, we may have to adjust these values
4533
to take the zero repeat into account. This is implemented by setting them to
4534
zerofirstbyte and zeroreqchar when such a repeat is encountered. The individual
4535
item types that can be repeated set these backoff variables appropriately. */
4536
4537
778k
firstchar = reqchar = zerofirstchar = zeroreqchar = 0;
4538
778k
firstcharflags = reqcharflags = zerofirstcharflags = zeroreqcharflags = REQ_UNSET;
4539
4540
/* The variable req_caseopt contains either the REQ_CASELESS value
4541
or zero, according to the current setting of the caseless flag. The
4542
REQ_CASELESS leaves the lower 28 bit empty. It is added into the
4543
firstchar or reqchar variables to record the case status of the
4544
value. This is used only for ASCII characters. */
4545
4546
778k
req_caseopt = ((options & PCRE_CASELESS) != 0)? REQ_CASELESS:0;
4547
4548
/* Switch on next character until the end of the branch */
4549
4550
2.01M
for (;; ptr++)
4551
2.78M
  {
4552
2.78M
  BOOL negate_class;
4553
2.78M
  BOOL should_flip_negation;
4554
2.78M
  BOOL possessive_quantifier;
4555
2.78M
  BOOL is_quantifier;
4556
2.78M
  BOOL is_recurse;
4557
2.78M
  BOOL reset_bracount;
4558
2.78M
  int class_has_8bitchar;
4559
2.78M
  int class_one_char;
4560
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
4561
  BOOL xclass_has_prop;
4562
#endif
4563
2.78M
  int newoptions;
4564
2.78M
  int recno;
4565
2.78M
  int refsign;
4566
2.78M
  int skipbytes;
4567
2.78M
  pcre_uint32 subreqchar, subfirstchar;
4568
2.78M
  pcre_int32 subreqcharflags, subfirstcharflags;
4569
2.78M
  int terminator;
4570
2.78M
  unsigned int mclength;
4571
2.78M
  unsigned int tempbracount;
4572
2.78M
  pcre_uint32 ec;
4573
2.78M
  pcre_uchar mcbuffer[8];
4574
4575
  /* Come here to restart the loop without advancing the pointer. */
4576
4577
2.79M
  REDO_LOOP:
4578
4579
  /* Get next character in the pattern */
4580
4581
2.79M
  c = *ptr;
4582
4583
  /* If we are at the end of a nested substitution, revert to the outer level
4584
  string. Nesting only happens one level deep. */
4585
4586
2.79M
  if (c == CHAR_NULL && nestptr != NULL)
4587
406
    {
4588
406
    ptr = nestptr;
4589
406
    nestptr = NULL;
4590
406
    c = *ptr;
4591
406
    }
4592
4593
  /* If we are in the pre-compile phase, accumulate the length used for the
4594
  previous cycle of this loop. */
4595
4596
2.79M
  if (lengthptr != NULL)
4597
2.09M
    {
4598
#ifdef PCRE_DEBUG
4599
    if (code > cd->hwm) cd->hwm = code;                 /* High water info */
4600
#endif
4601
2.09M
    if (code > cd->start_workspace + cd->workspace_size -
4602
2.09M
        WORK_SIZE_SAFETY_MARGIN)                       /* Check for overrun */
4603
0
      {
4604
0
      *errorcodeptr = (code >= cd->start_workspace + cd->workspace_size)?
4605
0
        ERR52 : ERR87;
4606
0
      goto FAILED;
4607
0
      }
4608
4609
    /* There is at least one situation where code goes backwards: this is the
4610
    case of a zero quantifier after a class (e.g. [ab]{0}). At compile time,
4611
    the class is simply eliminated. However, it is created first, so we have to
4612
    allow memory for it. Therefore, don't ever reduce the length at this point.
4613
    */
4614
4615
2.09M
    if (code < last_code) code = last_code;
4616
4617
    /* Paranoid check for integer overflow */
4618
4619
2.09M
    if (OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < code - last_code)
4620
6
      {
4621
6
      *errorcodeptr = ERR20;
4622
6
      goto FAILED;
4623
6
      }
4624
4625
2.09M
    *lengthptr += (int)(code - last_code);
4626
2.09M
    DPRINTF(("length=%d added %d c=%c (0x%x)\n", *lengthptr,
4627
2.09M
      (int)(code - last_code), c, c));
4628
4629
    /* If "previous" is set and it is not at the start of the work space, move
4630
    it back to there, in order to avoid filling up the work space. Otherwise,
4631
    if "previous" is NULL, reset the current code pointer to the start. */
4632
4633
2.09M
    if (previous != NULL)
4634
1.23M
      {
4635
1.23M
      if (previous > orig_code)
4636
829k
        {
4637
829k
        memmove(orig_code, previous, IN_UCHARS(code - previous));
4638
829k
        code -= previous - orig_code;
4639
829k
        previous = orig_code;
4640
829k
        }
4641
1.23M
      }
4642
863k
    else code = orig_code;
4643
4644
    /* Remember where this code item starts so we can pick up the length
4645
    next time round. */
4646
4647
2.09M
    last_code = code;
4648
2.09M
    }
4649
4650
  /* In the real compile phase, just check the workspace used by the forward
4651
  reference list. */
4652
4653
697k
  else if (cd->hwm > cd->start_workspace + cd->workspace_size)
4654
0
    {
4655
0
    *errorcodeptr = ERR52;
4656
0
    goto FAILED;
4657
0
    }
4658
4659
  /* If in \Q...\E, check for the end; if not, we have a literal. Otherwise an
4660
  isolated \E is ignored. */
4661
4662
2.79M
  if (c != CHAR_NULL)
4663
2.75M
    {
4664
2.75M
    if (c == CHAR_BACKSLASH && ptr[1] == CHAR_E)
4665
1.07k
      {
4666
1.07k
      inescq = FALSE;
4667
1.07k
      ptr++;
4668
1.07k
      continue;
4669
1.07k
      }
4670
2.75M
    else if (inescq)
4671
968
      {
4672
968
      if (previous_callout != NULL)
4673
397
        {
4674
397
        if (lengthptr == NULL)  /* Don't attempt in pre-compile phase */
4675
194
          complete_callout(previous_callout, ptr, cd);
4676
397
        previous_callout = NULL;
4677
397
        }
4678
968
      if ((options & PCRE_AUTO_CALLOUT) != 0)
4679
0
        {
4680
0
        previous_callout = code;
4681
0
        code = auto_callout(code, ptr, cd);
4682
0
        }
4683
968
      goto NORMAL_CHAR;
4684
968
      }
4685
4686
    /* Check for the start of a \Q...\E sequence. We must do this here rather
4687
    than later in case it is immediately followed by \E, which turns it into a
4688
    "do nothing" sequence. */
4689
4690
2.75M
    if (c == CHAR_BACKSLASH && ptr[1] == CHAR_Q)
4691
617
      {
4692
617
      inescq = TRUE;
4693
617
      ptr++;
4694
617
      continue;
4695
617
      }
4696
2.75M
    }
4697
4698
  /* In extended mode, skip white space and comments. */
4699
4700
2.79M
  if ((options & PCRE_EXTENDED) != 0)
4701
12.0k
    {
4702
12.0k
    const pcre_uchar *wscptr = ptr;
4703
12.9k
    while (MAX_255(c) && (cd->ctypes[c] & ctype_space) != 0) c = *(++ptr);
4704
12.0k
    if (c == CHAR_NUMBER_SIGN)
4705
3.47k
      {
4706
3.47k
      ptr++;
4707
6.01k
      while (*ptr != CHAR_NULL)
4708
5.92k
        {
4709
5.92k
        if (IS_NEWLINE(ptr))         /* For non-fixed-length newline cases, */
4710
3.38k
          {                          /* IS_NEWLINE sets cd->nllen. */
4711
3.38k
          ptr += cd->nllen;
4712
3.38k
          break;
4713
3.38k
          }
4714
2.54k
        ptr++;
4715
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
4716
        if (utf) FORWARDCHAR(ptr);
4717
#endif
4718
2.54k
        }
4719
3.47k
      }
4720
4721
    /* If we skipped any characters, restart the loop. Otherwise, we didn't see
4722
    a comment. */
4723
4724
12.0k
    if (ptr > wscptr) goto REDO_LOOP;
4725
12.0k
    }
4726
4727
  /* Skip over (?# comments. We need to do this here because we want to know if
4728
  the next thing is a quantifier, and these comments may come between an item
4729
  and its quantifier. */
4730
4731
2.78M
  if (c == CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS && ptr[1] == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK &&
4732
159k
      ptr[2] == CHAR_NUMBER_SIGN)
4733
304
    {
4734
304
    ptr += 3;
4735
8.30k
    while (*ptr != CHAR_NULL && *ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS) ptr++;
4736
304
    if (*ptr == CHAR_NULL)
4737
16
      {
4738
16
      *errorcodeptr = ERR18;
4739
16
      goto FAILED;
4740
16
      }
4741
288
    continue;
4742
304
    }
4743
4744
  /* See if the next thing is a quantifier. */
4745
4746
2.78M
  is_quantifier =
4747
2.78M
    c == CHAR_ASTERISK || c == CHAR_PLUS || c == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK ||
4748
2.54M
    (c == CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET && is_counted_repeat(ptr+1));
4749
4750
  /* Fill in length of a previous callout, except when the next thing is a
4751
  quantifier or when processing a property substitution string in UCP mode. */
4752
4753
2.78M
  if (!is_quantifier && previous_callout != NULL && nestptr == NULL &&
4754
2.25k
       after_manual_callout-- <= 0)
4755
1.03k
    {
4756
1.03k
    if (lengthptr == NULL)      /* Don't attempt in pre-compile phase */
4757
505
      complete_callout(previous_callout, ptr, cd);
4758
1.03k
    previous_callout = NULL;
4759
1.03k
    }
4760
4761
  /* Create auto callout, except for quantifiers, or while processing property
4762
  strings that are substituted for \w etc in UCP mode. */
4763
4764
2.78M
  if ((options & PCRE_AUTO_CALLOUT) != 0 && !is_quantifier && nestptr == NULL)
4765
0
    {
4766
0
    previous_callout = code;
4767
0
    code = auto_callout(code, ptr, cd);
4768
0
    }
4769
4770
  /* Process the next pattern item. */
4771
4772
2.78M
  switch(c)
4773
2.78M
    {
4774
    /* ===================================================================*/
4775
33.8k
    case CHAR_NULL:                /* The branch terminates at string end */
4776
119k
    case CHAR_VERTICAL_LINE:       /* or | or ) */
4777
765k
    case CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS:
4778
765k
    *firstcharptr = firstchar;
4779
765k
    *firstcharflagsptr = firstcharflags;
4780
765k
    *reqcharptr = reqchar;
4781
765k
    *reqcharflagsptr = reqcharflags;
4782
765k
    *codeptr = code;
4783
765k
    *ptrptr = ptr;
4784
765k
    if (lengthptr != NULL)
4785
617k
      {
4786
617k
      if (OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < code - last_code)
4787
0
        {
4788
0
        *errorcodeptr = ERR20;
4789
0
        goto FAILED;
4790
0
        }
4791
617k
      *lengthptr += (int)(code - last_code);   /* To include callout length */
4792
617k
      DPRINTF((">> end branch\n"));
4793
617k
      }
4794
765k
    return TRUE;
4795
4796
4797
    /* ===================================================================*/
4798
    /* Handle single-character metacharacters. In multiline mode, ^ disables
4799
    the setting of any following char as a first character. */
4800
4801
9.12k
    case CHAR_CIRCUMFLEX_ACCENT:
4802
9.12k
    previous = NULL;
4803
9.12k
    if ((options & PCRE_MULTILINE) != 0)
4804
1.37k
      {
4805
1.37k
      if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET)
4806
624
        zerofirstcharflags = firstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
4807
1.37k
      *code++ = OP_CIRCM;
4808
1.37k
      }
4809
7.74k
    else *code++ = OP_CIRC;
4810
9.12k
    break;
4811
4812
1.19k
    case CHAR_DOLLAR_SIGN:
4813
1.19k
    previous = NULL;
4814
1.19k
    *code++ = ((options & PCRE_MULTILINE) != 0)? OP_DOLLM : OP_DOLL;
4815
1.19k
    break;
4816
4817
    /* There can never be a first char if '.' is first, whatever happens about
4818
    repeats. The value of reqchar doesn't change either. */
4819
4820
29.1k
    case CHAR_DOT:
4821
29.1k
    if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
4822
29.1k
    zerofirstchar = firstchar;
4823
29.1k
    zerofirstcharflags = firstcharflags;
4824
29.1k
    zeroreqchar = reqchar;
4825
29.1k
    zeroreqcharflags = reqcharflags;
4826
29.1k
    previous = code;
4827
29.1k
    item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;
4828
29.1k
    *code++ = ((options & PCRE_DOTALL) != 0)? OP_ALLANY: OP_ANY;
4829
29.1k
    break;
4830
4831
4832
    /* ===================================================================*/
4833
    /* Character classes. If the included characters are all < 256, we build a
4834
    32-byte bitmap of the permitted characters, except in the special case
4835
    where there is only one such character. For negated classes, we build the
4836
    map as usual, then invert it at the end. However, we use a different opcode
4837
    so that data characters > 255 can be handled correctly.
4838
4839
    If the class contains characters outside the 0-255 range, a different
4840
    opcode is compiled. It may optionally have a bit map for characters < 256,
4841
    but those above are are explicitly listed afterwards. A flag byte tells
4842
    whether the bitmap is present, and whether this is a negated class or not.
4843
4844
    In JavaScript compatibility mode, an isolated ']' causes an error. In
4845
    default (Perl) mode, it is treated as a data character. */
4846
4847
3.50k
    case CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET:
4848
3.50k
    if ((cd->external_options & PCRE_JAVASCRIPT_COMPAT) != 0)
4849
0
      {
4850
0
      *errorcodeptr = ERR64;
4851
0
      goto FAILED;
4852
0
      }
4853
3.50k
    goto NORMAL_CHAR;
4854
4855
    /* In another (POSIX) regex library, the ugly syntax [[:<:]] and [[:>:]] is
4856
    used for "start of word" and "end of word". As these are otherwise illegal
4857
    sequences, we don't break anything by recognizing them. They are replaced
4858
    by \b(?=\w) and \b(?<=\w) respectively. Sequences like [a[:<:]] are
4859
    erroneous and are handled by the normal code below. */
4860
4861
10.7k
    case CHAR_LEFT_SQUARE_BRACKET:
4862
10.7k
    if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+1, STRING_WEIRD_STARTWORD, 6) == 0)
4863
86
      {
4864
86
      nestptr = ptr + 7;
4865
86
      ptr = sub_start_of_word;
4866
86
      goto REDO_LOOP;
4867
86
      }
4868
4869
10.6k
    if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+1, STRING_WEIRD_ENDWORD, 6) == 0)
4870
320
      {
4871
320
      nestptr = ptr + 7;
4872
320
      ptr = sub_end_of_word;
4873
320
      goto REDO_LOOP;
4874
320
      }
4875
4876
    /* Handle a real character class. */
4877
4878
10.3k
    previous = code;
4879
10.3k
    item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;
4880
4881
    /* PCRE supports POSIX class stuff inside a class. Perl gives an error if
4882
    they are encountered at the top level, so we'll do that too. */
4883
4884
10.3k
    if ((ptr[1] == CHAR_COLON || ptr[1] == CHAR_DOT ||
4885
9.43k
         ptr[1] == CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN) &&
4886
1.18k
        check_posix_syntax(ptr, &tempptr))
4887
2
      {
4888
2
      *errorcodeptr = (ptr[1] == CHAR_COLON)? ERR13 : ERR31;
4889
2
      goto FAILED;
4890
2
      }
4891
4892
    /* If the first character is '^', set the negation flag and skip it. Also,
4893
    if the first few characters (either before or after ^) are \Q\E or \E we
4894
    skip them too. This makes for compatibility with Perl. */
4895
4896
10.3k
    negate_class = FALSE;
4897
10.3k
    for (;;)
4898
13.6k
      {
4899
13.6k
      c = *(++ptr);
4900
13.6k
      if (c == CHAR_BACKSLASH)
4901
2.45k
        {
4902
2.45k
        if (ptr[1] == CHAR_E)
4903
220
          ptr++;
4904
2.23k
        else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr + 1, STR_Q STR_BACKSLASH STR_E, 3) == 0)
4905
194
          ptr += 3;
4906
2.03k
        else
4907
2.03k
          break;
4908
2.45k
        }
4909
11.2k
      else if (!negate_class && c == CHAR_CIRCUMFLEX_ACCENT)
4910
2.92k
        negate_class = TRUE;
4911
8.28k
      else break;
4912
13.6k
      }
4913
4914
    /* Empty classes are allowed in JavaScript compatibility mode. Otherwise,
4915
    an initial ']' is taken as a data character -- the code below handles
4916
    that. In JS mode, [] must always fail, so generate OP_FAIL, whereas
4917
    [^] must match any character, so generate OP_ALLANY. */
4918
4919
10.3k
    if (c == CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET &&
4920
460
        (cd->external_options & PCRE_JAVASCRIPT_COMPAT) != 0)
4921
0
      {
4922
0
      *code++ = negate_class? OP_ALLANY : OP_FAIL;
4923
0
      if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
4924
0
      zerofirstchar = firstchar;
4925
0
      zerofirstcharflags = firstcharflags;
4926
0
      break;
4927
0
      }
4928
4929
    /* If a class contains a negative special such as \S, we need to flip the
4930
    negation flag at the end, so that support for characters > 255 works
4931
    correctly (they are all included in the class). */
4932
4933
10.3k
    should_flip_negation = FALSE;
4934
4935
    /* Extended class (xclass) will be used when characters > 255
4936
    might match. */
4937
4938
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
4939
    xclass = FALSE;
4940
    class_uchardata = code + LINK_SIZE + 2;   /* For XCLASS items */
4941
    class_uchardata_base = class_uchardata;   /* Save the start */
4942
#endif
4943
4944
    /* For optimization purposes, we track some properties of the class:
4945
    class_has_8bitchar will be non-zero if the class contains at least one <
4946
    256 character; class_one_char will be 1 if the class contains just one
4947
    character; xclass_has_prop will be TRUE if unicode property checks
4948
    are present in the class. */
4949
4950
10.3k
    class_has_8bitchar = 0;
4951
10.3k
    class_one_char = 0;
4952
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
4953
    xclass_has_prop = FALSE;
4954
#endif
4955
4956
    /* Initialize the 32-char bit map to all zeros. We build the map in a
4957
    temporary bit of memory, in case the class contains fewer than two
4958
    8-bit characters because in that case the compiled code doesn't use the bit
4959
    map. */
4960
4961
10.3k
    memset(classbits, 0, 32 * sizeof(pcre_uint8));
4962
4963
    /* Process characters until ] is reached. By writing this as a "do" it
4964
    means that an initial ] is taken as a data character. At the start of the
4965
    loop, c contains the first byte of the character. */
4966
4967
10.3k
    if (c != CHAR_NULL) do
4968
1.52M
      {
4969
1.52M
      const pcre_uchar *oldptr;
4970
4971
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
4972
      if (utf && HAS_EXTRALEN(c))
4973
        {                           /* Braces are required because the */
4974
        GETCHARLEN(c, ptr, ptr);    /* macro generates multiple statements */
4975
        }
4976
#endif
4977
4978
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
4979
      /* In the pre-compile phase, accumulate the length of any extra
4980
      data and reset the pointer. This is so that very large classes that
4981
      contain a zillion > 255 characters no longer overwrite the work space
4982
      (which is on the stack). We have to remember that there was XCLASS data,
4983
      however. */
4984
4985
      if (class_uchardata > class_uchardata_base) xclass = TRUE;
4986
4987
      if (lengthptr != NULL && class_uchardata > class_uchardata_base)
4988
        {
4989
        *lengthptr += (int)(class_uchardata - class_uchardata_base);
4990
        class_uchardata = class_uchardata_base;
4991
        }
4992
#endif
4993
4994
      /* Inside \Q...\E everything is literal except \E */
4995
4996
1.52M
      if (inescq)
4997
2.38k
        {
4998
2.38k
        if (c == CHAR_BACKSLASH && ptr[1] == CHAR_E)  /* If we are at \E */
4999
465
          {
5000
465
          inescq = FALSE;                   /* Reset literal state */
5001
465
          ptr++;                            /* Skip the 'E' */
5002
465
          continue;                         /* Carry on with next */
5003
465
          }
5004
1.91k
        goto CHECK_RANGE;                   /* Could be range if \E follows */
5005
2.38k
        }
5006
5007
      /* Handle POSIX class names. Perl allows a negation extension of the
5008
      form [:^name:]. A square bracket that doesn't match the syntax is
5009
      treated as a literal. We also recognize the POSIX constructions
5010
      [.ch.] and [=ch=] ("collating elements") and fault them, as Perl
5011
      5.6 and 5.8 do. */
5012
5013
1.51M
      if (c == CHAR_LEFT_SQUARE_BRACKET &&
5014
109k
          (ptr[1] == CHAR_COLON || ptr[1] == CHAR_DOT ||
5015
107k
           ptr[1] == CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN) && check_posix_syntax(ptr, &tempptr))
5016
1.07k
        {
5017
1.07k
        BOOL local_negate = FALSE;
5018
1.07k
        int posix_class, taboffset, tabopt;
5019
1.07k
        register const pcre_uint8 *cbits = cd->cbits;
5020
1.07k
        pcre_uint8 pbits[32];
5021
5022
1.07k
        if (ptr[1] != CHAR_COLON)
5023
1
          {
5024
1
          *errorcodeptr = ERR31;
5025
1
          goto FAILED;
5026
1
          }
5027
5028
1.06k
        ptr += 2;
5029
1.06k
        if (*ptr == CHAR_CIRCUMFLEX_ACCENT)
5030
72
          {
5031
72
          local_negate = TRUE;
5032
72
          should_flip_negation = TRUE;  /* Note negative special */
5033
72
          ptr++;
5034
72
          }
5035
5036
1.06k
        posix_class = check_posix_name(ptr, (int)(tempptr - ptr));
5037
1.06k
        if (posix_class < 0)
5038
93
          {
5039
93
          *errorcodeptr = ERR30;
5040
93
          goto FAILED;
5041
93
          }
5042
5043
        /* If matching is caseless, upper and lower are converted to
5044
        alpha. This relies on the fact that the class table starts with
5045
        alpha, lower, upper as the first 3 entries. */
5046
5047
976
        if ((options & PCRE_CASELESS) != 0 && posix_class <= 2)
5048
178
          posix_class = 0;
5049
5050
        /* When PCRE_UCP is set, some of the POSIX classes are converted to
5051
        different escape sequences that use Unicode properties \p or \P. Others
5052
        that are not available via \p or \P generate XCL_PROP/XCL_NOTPROP
5053
        directly. */
5054
5055
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
5056
        if ((options & PCRE_UCP) != 0)
5057
          {
5058
          unsigned int ptype = 0;
5059
          int pc = posix_class + ((local_negate)? POSIX_SUBSIZE/2 : 0);
5060
5061
          /* The posix_substitutes table specifies which POSIX classes can be
5062
          converted to \p or \P items. */
5063
5064
          if (posix_substitutes[pc] != NULL)
5065
            {
5066
            nestptr = tempptr + 1;
5067
            ptr = posix_substitutes[pc] - 1;
5068
            continue;
5069
            }
5070
5071
          /* There are three other classes that generate special property calls
5072
          that are recognized only in an XCLASS. */
5073
5074
          else switch(posix_class)
5075
            {
5076
            case PC_GRAPH:
5077
            ptype = PT_PXGRAPH;
5078
            /* Fall through */
5079
            case PC_PRINT:
5080
            if (ptype == 0) ptype = PT_PXPRINT;
5081
            /* Fall through */
5082
            case PC_PUNCT:
5083
            if (ptype == 0) ptype = PT_PXPUNCT;
5084
            *class_uchardata++ = local_negate? XCL_NOTPROP : XCL_PROP;
5085
            *class_uchardata++ = ptype;
5086
            *class_uchardata++ = 0;
5087
            xclass_has_prop = TRUE;
5088
            ptr = tempptr + 1;
5089
            continue;
5090
5091
            /* For the other POSIX classes (ascii, cntrl, xdigit) we are going
5092
            to fall through to the non-UCP case and build a bit map for
5093
            characters with code points less than 256. If we are in a negated
5094
            POSIX class, characters with code points greater than 255 must
5095
            either all match or all not match. In the special case where we
5096
            have not yet generated any xclass data, and this is the final item
5097
            in the overall class, we need do nothing: later on, the opcode
5098
            OP_NCLASS will be used to indicate that characters greater than 255
5099
            are acceptable. If we have already seen an xclass item or one may
5100
            follow (we have to assume that it might if this is not the end of
5101
            the class), explicitly list all wide codepoints, which will then
5102
            either not match or match, depending on whether the class is or is
5103
            not negated. */
5104
5105
            default:
5106
            if (local_negate &&
5107
                (xclass || tempptr[2] != CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET))
5108
              {
5109
              *class_uchardata++ = XCL_RANGE;
5110
              class_uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(0x100, class_uchardata);
5111
              class_uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(0x10ffff, class_uchardata);
5112
              }
5113
            break;
5114
            }
5115
          }
5116
#endif
5117
        /* In the non-UCP case, or when UCP makes no difference, we build the
5118
        bit map for the POSIX class in a chunk of local store because we may be
5119
        adding and subtracting from it, and we don't want to subtract bits that
5120
        may be in the main map already. At the end we or the result into the
5121
        bit map that is being built. */
5122
5123
976
        posix_class *= 3;
5124
5125
        /* Copy in the first table (always present) */
5126
5127
976
        memcpy(pbits, cbits + posix_class_maps[posix_class],
5128
976
          32 * sizeof(pcre_uint8));
5129
5130
        /* If there is a second table, add or remove it as required. */
5131
5132
976
        taboffset = posix_class_maps[posix_class + 1];
5133
976
        tabopt = posix_class_maps[posix_class + 2];
5134
5135
976
        if (taboffset >= 0)
5136
474
          {
5137
474
          if (tabopt >= 0)
5138
6.53k
            for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) pbits[c] |= cbits[c + taboffset];
5139
276
          else
5140
9.10k
            for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) pbits[c] &= ~cbits[c + taboffset];
5141
474
          }
5142
5143
        /* Now see if we need to remove any special characters. An option
5144
        value of 1 removes vertical space and 2 removes underscore. */
5145
5146
976
        if (tabopt < 0) tabopt = -tabopt;
5147
976
        if (tabopt == 1) pbits[1] &= ~0x3c;
5148
695
          else if (tabopt == 2) pbits[11] &= 0x7f;
5149
5150
        /* Add the POSIX table or its complement into the main table that is
5151
        being built and we are done. */
5152
5153
976
        if (local_negate)
5154
2.24k
          for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) classbits[c] |= ~pbits[c];
5155
908
        else
5156
29.9k
          for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) classbits[c] |= pbits[c];
5157
5158
976
        ptr = tempptr + 1;
5159
        /* Every class contains at least one < 256 character. */
5160
976
        class_has_8bitchar = 1;
5161
        /* Every class contains at least two characters. */
5162
976
        class_one_char = 2;
5163
976
        continue;    /* End of POSIX syntax handling */
5164
1.06k
        }
5165
5166
      /* Backslash may introduce a single character, or it may introduce one
5167
      of the specials, which just set a flag. The sequence \b is a special
5168
      case. Inside a class (and only there) it is treated as backspace. We
5169
      assume that other escapes have more than one character in them, so
5170
      speculatively set both class_has_8bitchar and class_one_char bigger
5171
      than one. Unrecognized escapes fall through and are either treated
5172
      as literal characters (by default), or are faulted if
5173
      PCRE_EXTRA is set. */
5174
5175
1.51M
      if (c == CHAR_BACKSLASH)
5176
941k
        {
5177
941k
        escape = check_escape(&ptr, &ec, errorcodeptr, cd->bracount, options,
5178
941k
          TRUE);
5179
941k
        if (*errorcodeptr != 0) goto FAILED;
5180
941k
        if (escape == 0) c = ec;
5181
790k
        else if (escape == ESC_b) c = CHAR_BS; /* \b is backspace in a class */
5182
790k
        else if (escape == ESC_N)          /* \N is not supported in a class */
5183
1
          {
5184
1
          *errorcodeptr = ERR71;
5185
1
          goto FAILED;
5186
1
          }
5187
790k
        else if (escape == ESC_Q)            /* Handle start of quoted string */
5188
604
          {
5189
604
          if (ptr[1] == CHAR_BACKSLASH && ptr[2] == CHAR_E)
5190
241
            {
5191
241
            ptr += 2; /* avoid empty string */
5192
241
            }
5193
363
          else inescq = TRUE;
5194
604
          continue;
5195
604
          }
5196
789k
        else if (escape == ESC_E) continue;  /* Ignore orphan \E */
5197
5198
789k
        else
5199
789k
          {
5200
789k
          register const pcre_uint8 *cbits = cd->cbits;
5201
          /* Every class contains at least two < 256 characters. */
5202
789k
          class_has_8bitchar++;
5203
          /* Every class contains at least two characters. */
5204
789k
          class_one_char += 2;
5205
5206
789k
          switch (escape)
5207
789k
            {
5208
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
5209
            case ESC_du:     /* These are the values given for \d etc */
5210
            case ESC_DU:     /* when PCRE_UCP is set. We replace the */
5211
            case ESC_wu:     /* escape sequence with an appropriate \p */
5212
            case ESC_WU:     /* or \P to test Unicode properties instead */
5213
            case ESC_su:     /* of the default ASCII testing. */
5214
            case ESC_SU:
5215
            nestptr = ptr;
5216
            ptr = substitutes[escape - ESC_DU] - 1;  /* Just before substitute */
5217
            class_has_8bitchar--;                /* Undo! */
5218
            continue;
5219
#endif
5220
245
            case ESC_d:
5221
8.08k
            for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) classbits[c] |= cbits[c+cbit_digit];
5222
245
            continue;
5223
5224
1.02k
            case ESC_D:
5225
1.02k
            should_flip_negation = TRUE;
5226
33.9k
            for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) classbits[c] |= ~cbits[c+cbit_digit];
5227
1.02k
            continue;
5228
5229
211
            case ESC_w:
5230
6.96k
            for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) classbits[c] |= cbits[c+cbit_word];
5231
211
            continue;
5232
5233
967
            case ESC_W:
5234
967
            should_flip_negation = TRUE;
5235
31.9k
            for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) classbits[c] |= ~cbits[c+cbit_word];
5236
967
            continue;
5237
5238
            /* Perl 5.004 onwards omitted VT from \s, but restored it at Perl
5239
            5.18. Before PCRE 8.34, we had to preserve the VT bit if it was
5240
            previously set by something earlier in the character class.
5241
            Luckily, the value of CHAR_VT is 0x0b in both ASCII and EBCDIC, so
5242
            we could just adjust the appropriate bit. From PCRE 8.34 we no
5243
            longer treat \s and \S specially. */
5244
5245
453k
            case ESC_s:
5246
14.9M
            for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) classbits[c] |= cbits[c+cbit_space];
5247
453k
            continue;
5248
5249
310k
            case ESC_S:
5250
310k
            should_flip_negation = TRUE;
5251
10.2M
            for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) classbits[c] |= ~cbits[c+cbit_space];
5252
310k
            continue;
5253
5254
            /* The rest apply in both UCP and non-UCP cases. */
5255
5256
340
            case ESC_h:
5257
340
            (void)add_list_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, options, cd,
5258
340
              PRIV(hspace_list), NOTACHAR);
5259
340
            continue;
5260
5261
673
            case ESC_H:
5262
673
            (void)add_not_list_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, options,
5263
673
              cd, PRIV(hspace_list));
5264
673
            continue;
5265
5266
411
            case ESC_v:
5267
411
            (void)add_list_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, options, cd,
5268
411
              PRIV(vspace_list), NOTACHAR);
5269
411
            continue;
5270
5271
340
            case ESC_V:
5272
340
            (void)add_not_list_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, options,
5273
340
              cd, PRIV(vspace_list));
5274
340
            continue;
5275
5276
1
            case ESC_p:
5277
2
            case ESC_P:
5278
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
5279
              {
5280
              BOOL negated;
5281
              unsigned int ptype = 0, pdata = 0;
5282
              if (!get_ucp(&ptr, &negated, &ptype, &pdata, errorcodeptr))
5283
                goto FAILED;
5284
              *class_uchardata++ = ((escape == ESC_p) != negated)?
5285
                XCL_PROP : XCL_NOTPROP;
5286
              *class_uchardata++ = ptype;
5287
              *class_uchardata++ = pdata;
5288
              xclass_has_prop = TRUE;
5289
              class_has_8bitchar--;                /* Undo! */
5290
              continue;
5291
              }
5292
#else
5293
2
            *errorcodeptr = ERR45;
5294
2
            goto FAILED;
5295
0
#endif
5296
            /* Unrecognized escapes are faulted if PCRE is running in its
5297
            strict mode. By default, for compatibility with Perl, they are
5298
            treated as literals. */
5299
5300
20.3k
            default:
5301
20.3k
            if ((options & PCRE_EXTRA) != 0)
5302
1
              {
5303
1
              *errorcodeptr = ERR7;
5304
1
              goto FAILED;
5305
1
              }
5306
20.3k
            class_has_8bitchar--;    /* Undo the speculative increase. */
5307
20.3k
            class_one_char -= 2;     /* Undo the speculative increase. */
5308
20.3k
            c = *ptr;                /* Get the final character and fall through */
5309
20.3k
            break;
5310
789k
            }
5311
789k
          }
5312
5313
        /* Fall through if the escape just defined a single character (c >= 0).
5314
        This may be greater than 256. */
5315
5316
171k
        escape = 0;
5317
5318
171k
        }   /* End of backslash handling */
5319
5320
      /* A character may be followed by '-' to form a range. However, Perl does
5321
      not permit ']' to be the end of the range. A '-' character at the end is
5322
      treated as a literal. Perl ignores orphaned \E sequences entirely. The
5323
      code for handling \Q and \E is messy. */
5324
5325
750k
      CHECK_RANGE:
5326
750k
      while (ptr[1] == CHAR_BACKSLASH && ptr[2] == CHAR_E)
5327
738
        {
5328
738
        inescq = FALSE;
5329
738
        ptr += 2;
5330
738
        }
5331
750k
      oldptr = ptr;
5332
5333
      /* Remember if \r or \n were explicitly used */
5334
5335
750k
      if (c == CHAR_CR || c == CHAR_NL) cd->external_flags |= PCRE_HASCRORLF;
5336
5337
      /* Check for range */
5338
5339
750k
      if (!inescq && ptr[1] == CHAR_MINUS)
5340
4.15k
        {
5341
4.15k
        pcre_uint32 d;
5342
4.15k
        ptr += 2;
5343
4.35k
        while (*ptr == CHAR_BACKSLASH && ptr[1] == CHAR_E) ptr += 2;
5344
5345
        /* If we hit \Q (not followed by \E) at this point, go into escaped
5346
        mode. */
5347
5348
4.35k
        while (*ptr == CHAR_BACKSLASH && ptr[1] == CHAR_Q)
5349
824
          {
5350
824
          ptr += 2;
5351
824
          if (*ptr == CHAR_BACKSLASH && ptr[1] == CHAR_E)
5352
197
            { ptr += 2; continue; }
5353
627
          inescq = TRUE;
5354
627
          break;
5355
824
          }
5356
5357
        /* Minus (hyphen) at the end of a class is treated as a literal, so put
5358
        back the pointer and jump to handle the character that preceded it. */
5359
5360
4.15k
        if (*ptr == CHAR_NULL || (!inescq && *ptr == CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET))
5361
340
          {
5362
340
          ptr = oldptr;
5363
340
          goto CLASS_SINGLE_CHARACTER;
5364
340
          }
5365
5366
        /* Otherwise, we have a potential range; pick up the next character */
5367
5368
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
5369
        if (utf)
5370
          {                           /* Braces are required because the */
5371
          GETCHARLEN(d, ptr, ptr);    /* macro generates multiple statements */
5372
          }
5373
        else
5374
#endif
5375
3.81k
        d = *ptr;  /* Not UTF-8 mode */
5376
5377
        /* The second part of a range can be a single-character escape
5378
        sequence, but not any of the other escapes. Perl treats a hyphen as a
5379
        literal in such circumstances. However, in Perl's warning mode, a
5380
        warning is given, so PCRE now faults it as it is almost certainly a
5381
        mistake on the user's part. */
5382
5383
3.81k
        if (!inescq)
5384
3.18k
          {
5385
3.18k
          if (d == CHAR_BACKSLASH)
5386
429
            {
5387
429
            int descape;
5388
429
            descape = check_escape(&ptr, &d, errorcodeptr, cd->bracount, options, TRUE);
5389
429
            if (*errorcodeptr != 0) goto FAILED;
5390
5391
            /* 0 means a character was put into d; \b is backspace; any other
5392
            special causes an error. */
5393
5394
428
            if (descape != 0)
5395
212
              {
5396
212
              if (descape == ESC_b) d = CHAR_BS; else
5397
4
                {
5398
4
                *errorcodeptr = ERR83;
5399
4
                goto FAILED;
5400
4
                }
5401
212
              }
5402
428
            }
5403
5404
          /* A hyphen followed by a POSIX class is treated in the same way. */
5405
5406
2.75k
          else if (d == CHAR_LEFT_SQUARE_BRACKET &&
5407
782
                   (ptr[1] == CHAR_COLON || ptr[1] == CHAR_DOT ||
5408
486
                    ptr[1] == CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN) &&
5409
521
                   check_posix_syntax(ptr, &tempptr))
5410
1
            {
5411
1
            *errorcodeptr = ERR83;
5412
1
            goto FAILED;
5413
1
            }
5414
3.18k
          }
5415
5416
        /* Check that the two values are in the correct order. Optimize
5417
        one-character ranges. */
5418
5419
3.80k
        if (d < c)
5420
15
          {
5421
15
          *errorcodeptr = ERR8;
5422
15
          goto FAILED;
5423
15
          }
5424
3.79k
        if (d == c) goto CLASS_SINGLE_CHARACTER;  /* A few lines below */
5425
5426
        /* We have found a character range, so single character optimizations
5427
        cannot be done anymore. Any value greater than 1 indicates that there
5428
        is more than one character. */
5429
5430
3.44k
        class_one_char = 2;
5431
5432
        /* Remember an explicit \r or \n, and add the range to the class. */
5433
5434
3.44k
        if (d == CHAR_CR || d == CHAR_NL) cd->external_flags |= PCRE_HASCRORLF;
5435
5436
3.44k
        class_has_8bitchar +=
5437
3.44k
          add_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, options, cd, c, d);
5438
5439
3.44k
        continue;   /* Go get the next char in the class */
5440
3.79k
        }
5441
5442
      /* Handle a single character - we can get here for a normal non-escape
5443
      char, or after \ that introduces a single character or for an apparent
5444
      range that isn't. Only the value 1 matters for class_one_char, so don't
5445
      increase it if it is already 2 or more ... just in case there's a class
5446
      with a zillion characters in it. */
5447
5448
746k
      CLASS_SINGLE_CHARACTER:
5449
746k
      if (class_one_char < 2) class_one_char++;
5450
5451
      /* If xclass_has_prop is false and class_one_char is 1, we have the first
5452
      single character in the class, and there have been no prior ranges, or
5453
      XCLASS items generated by escapes. If this is the final character in the
5454
      class, we can optimize by turning the item into a 1-character OP_CHAR[I]
5455
      if it's positive, or OP_NOT[I] if it's negative. In the positive case, it
5456
      can cause firstchar to be set. Otherwise, there can be no first char if
5457
      this item is first, whatever repeat count may follow. In the case of
5458
      reqchar, save the previous value for reinstating. */
5459
5460
746k
      if (!inescq &&
5461
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
5462
          !xclass_has_prop &&
5463
#endif
5464
745k
          class_one_char == 1 && ptr[1] == CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET)
5465
3.10k
        {
5466
3.10k
        ptr++;
5467
3.10k
        zeroreqchar = reqchar;
5468
3.10k
        zeroreqcharflags = reqcharflags;
5469
5470
3.10k
        if (negate_class)
5471
2.24k
          {
5472
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
5473
          int d;
5474
#endif
5475
2.24k
          if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
5476
2.24k
          zerofirstchar = firstchar;
5477
2.24k
          zerofirstcharflags = firstcharflags;
5478
5479
          /* For caseless UTF-8 mode when UCP support is available, check
5480
          whether this character has more than one other case. If so, generate
5481
          a special OP_NOTPROP item instead of OP_NOTI. */
5482
5483
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
5484
          if (utf && (options & PCRE_CASELESS) != 0 &&
5485
              (d = UCD_CASESET(c)) != 0)
5486
            {
5487
            *code++ = OP_NOTPROP;
5488
            *code++ = PT_CLIST;
5489
            *code++ = d;
5490
            }
5491
          else
5492
#endif
5493
          /* Char has only one other case, or UCP not available */
5494
5495
2.24k
            {
5496
2.24k
            *code++ = ((options & PCRE_CASELESS) != 0)? OP_NOTI: OP_NOT;
5497
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32
5498
            if (utf && c > MAX_VALUE_FOR_SINGLE_CHAR)
5499
              code += PRIV(ord2utf)(c, code);
5500
            else
5501
#endif
5502
2.24k
              *code++ = c;
5503
2.24k
            }
5504
5505
          /* We are finished with this character class */
5506
5507
2.24k
          goto END_CLASS;
5508
2.24k
          }
5509
5510
        /* For a single, positive character, get the value into mcbuffer, and
5511
        then we can handle this with the normal one-character code. */
5512
5513
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32
5514
        if (utf && c > MAX_VALUE_FOR_SINGLE_CHAR)
5515
          mclength = PRIV(ord2utf)(c, mcbuffer);
5516
        else
5517
#endif
5518
856
          {
5519
856
          mcbuffer[0] = c;
5520
856
          mclength = 1;
5521
856
          }
5522
856
        goto ONE_CHAR;
5523
3.10k
        }       /* End of 1-char optimization */
5524
5525
      /* There is more than one character in the class, or an XCLASS item
5526
      has been generated. Add this character to the class. */
5527
5528
743k
      class_has_8bitchar +=
5529
743k
        add_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, options, cd, c, c);
5530
743k
      }
5531
5532
    /* Loop until ']' reached. This "while" is the end of the "do" far above.
5533
    If we are at the end of an internal nested string, revert to the outer
5534
    string. */
5535
5536
1.51M
    while (((c = *(++ptr)) != CHAR_NULL ||
5537
326
           (nestptr != NULL &&
5538
0
             (ptr = nestptr, nestptr = NULL, c = *(++ptr)) != CHAR_NULL)) &&
5539
1.51M
           (c != CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET || inescq));
5540
5541
    /* Check for missing terminating ']' */
5542
5543
7.08k
    if (c == CHAR_NULL)
5544
355
      {
5545
355
      *errorcodeptr = ERR6;
5546
355
      goto FAILED;
5547
355
      }
5548
5549
    /* We will need an XCLASS if data has been placed in class_uchardata. In
5550
    the second phase this is a sufficient test. However, in the pre-compile
5551
    phase, class_uchardata gets emptied to prevent workspace overflow, so it
5552
    only if the very last character in the class needs XCLASS will it contain
5553
    anything at this point. For this reason, xclass gets set TRUE above when
5554
    uchar_classdata is emptied, and that's why this code is the way it is here
5555
    instead of just doing a test on class_uchardata below. */
5556
5557
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
5558
    if (class_uchardata > class_uchardata_base) xclass = TRUE;
5559
#endif
5560
5561
    /* If this is the first thing in the branch, there can be no first char
5562
    setting, whatever the repeat count. Any reqchar setting must remain
5563
    unchanged after any kind of repeat. */
5564
5565
6.72k
    if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
5566
6.72k
    zerofirstchar = firstchar;
5567
6.72k
    zerofirstcharflags = firstcharflags;
5568
6.72k
    zeroreqchar = reqchar;
5569
6.72k
    zeroreqcharflags = reqcharflags;
5570
5571
    /* If there are characters with values > 255, we have to compile an
5572
    extended class, with its own opcode, unless there was a negated special
5573
    such as \S in the class, and PCRE_UCP is not set, because in that case all
5574
    characters > 255 are in the class, so any that were explicitly given as
5575
    well can be ignored. If (when there are explicit characters > 255 that must
5576
    be listed) there are no characters < 256, we can omit the bitmap in the
5577
    actual compiled code. */
5578
5579
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
5580
    if (xclass && (xclass_has_prop || !should_flip_negation ||
5581
        (options & PCRE_UCP) != 0))
5582
#elif !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
5583
    if (xclass && (xclass_has_prop || !should_flip_negation))
5584
#endif
5585
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
5586
      {
5587
      /* For non-UCP wide characters, in a non-negative class containing \S or
5588
      similar (should_flip_negation is set), all characters greater than 255
5589
      must be in the class. */
5590
5591
      if (
5592
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE8
5593
           utf &&
5594
#endif
5595
           should_flip_negation && !negate_class && (options & PCRE_UCP) == 0)
5596
        {
5597
        *class_uchardata++ = XCL_RANGE;
5598
        if (utf)   /* Will always be utf in the 8-bit library */
5599
          {
5600
          class_uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(0x100, class_uchardata);
5601
          class_uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(0x10ffff, class_uchardata);
5602
          }
5603
        else       /* Can only happen for the 16-bit & 32-bit libraries */
5604
          {
5605
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE16
5606
          *class_uchardata++ = 0x100;
5607
          *class_uchardata++ = 0xffffu;
5608
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32
5609
          *class_uchardata++ = 0x100;
5610
          *class_uchardata++ = 0xffffffffu;
5611
#endif
5612
          }
5613
        }
5614
5615
      *class_uchardata++ = XCL_END;    /* Marks the end of extra data */
5616
      *code++ = OP_XCLASS;
5617
      code += LINK_SIZE;
5618
      *code = negate_class? XCL_NOT:0;
5619
      if (xclass_has_prop) *code |= XCL_HASPROP;
5620
5621
      /* If the map is required, move up the extra data to make room for it;
5622
      otherwise just move the code pointer to the end of the extra data. */
5623
5624
      if (class_has_8bitchar > 0)
5625
        {
5626
        *code++ |= XCL_MAP;
5627
        memmove(code + (32 / sizeof(pcre_uchar)), code,
5628
          IN_UCHARS(class_uchardata - code));
5629
        if (negate_class && !xclass_has_prop)
5630
          for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) classbits[c] = ~classbits[c];
5631
        memcpy(code, classbits, 32);
5632
        code = class_uchardata + (32 / sizeof(pcre_uchar));
5633
        }
5634
      else code = class_uchardata;
5635
5636
      /* Now fill in the complete length of the item */
5637
5638
      PUT(previous, 1, (int)(code - previous));
5639
      break;   /* End of class handling */
5640
      }
5641
5642
    /* Even though any XCLASS list is now discarded, we must allow for
5643
    its memory. */
5644
5645
    if (lengthptr != NULL)
5646
      *lengthptr += (int)(class_uchardata - class_uchardata_base);
5647
#endif
5648
5649
    /* If there are no characters > 255, or they are all to be included or
5650
    excluded, set the opcode to OP_CLASS or OP_NCLASS, depending on whether the
5651
    whole class was negated and whether there were negative specials such as \S
5652
    (non-UCP) in the class. Then copy the 32-byte map into the code vector,
5653
    negating it if necessary. */
5654
5655
6.72k
    *code++ = (negate_class == should_flip_negation) ? OP_CLASS : OP_NCLASS;
5656
6.72k
    if (lengthptr == NULL)    /* Save time in the pre-compile phase */
5657
3.27k
      {
5658
3.27k
      if (negate_class)
5659
10.9k
        for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) classbits[c] = ~classbits[c];
5660
3.27k
      memcpy(code, classbits, 32);
5661
3.27k
      }
5662
6.72k
    code += 32 / sizeof(pcre_uchar);
5663
5664
8.97k
    END_CLASS:
5665
8.97k
    break;
5666
5667
5668
    /* ===================================================================*/
5669
    /* Various kinds of repeat; '{' is not necessarily a quantifier, but this
5670
    has been tested above. */
5671
5672
26.2k
    case CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET:
5673
26.2k
    if (!is_quantifier) goto NORMAL_CHAR;
5674
15.6k
    ptr = read_repeat_counts(ptr+1, &repeat_min, &repeat_max, errorcodeptr);
5675
15.6k
    if (*errorcodeptr != 0) goto FAILED;
5676
15.6k
    goto REPEAT;
5677
5678
30.5k
    case CHAR_ASTERISK:
5679
30.5k
    repeat_min = 0;
5680
30.5k
    repeat_max = -1;
5681
30.5k
    goto REPEAT;
5682
5683
21.4k
    case CHAR_PLUS:
5684
21.4k
    repeat_min = 1;
5685
21.4k
    repeat_max = -1;
5686
21.4k
    goto REPEAT;
5687
5688
190k
    case CHAR_QUESTION_MARK:
5689
190k
    repeat_min = 0;
5690
190k
    repeat_max = 1;
5691
5692
258k
    REPEAT:
5693
258k
    if (previous == NULL)
5694
70
      {
5695
70
      *errorcodeptr = ERR9;
5696
70
      goto FAILED;
5697
70
      }
5698
5699
257k
    if (repeat_min == 0)
5700
222k
      {
5701
222k
      firstchar = zerofirstchar;    /* Adjust for zero repeat */
5702
222k
      firstcharflags = zerofirstcharflags;
5703
222k
      reqchar = zeroreqchar;        /* Ditto */
5704
222k
      reqcharflags = zeroreqcharflags;
5705
222k
      }
5706
5707
    /* Remember whether this is a variable length repeat */
5708
5709
257k
    reqvary = (repeat_min == repeat_max)? 0 : REQ_VARY;
5710
5711
257k
    op_type = 0;                    /* Default single-char op codes */
5712
257k
    possessive_quantifier = FALSE;  /* Default not possessive quantifier */
5713
5714
    /* Save start of previous item, in case we have to move it up in order to
5715
    insert something before it. */
5716
5717
257k
    tempcode = previous;
5718
5719
    /* Before checking for a possessive quantifier, we must skip over
5720
    whitespace and comments in extended mode because Perl allows white space at
5721
    this point. */
5722
5723
257k
    if ((options & PCRE_EXTENDED) != 0)
5724
546
      {
5725
546
      const pcre_uchar *p = ptr + 1;
5726
546
      for (;;)
5727
1.40k
        {
5728
1.76k
        while (MAX_255(*p) && (cd->ctypes[*p] & ctype_space) != 0) p++;
5729
1.40k
        if (*p != CHAR_NUMBER_SIGN) break;
5730
855
        p++;
5731
5.50k
        while (*p != CHAR_NULL)
5732
5.45k
          {
5733
5.45k
          if (IS_NEWLINE(p))         /* For non-fixed-length newline cases, */
5734
807
            {                        /* IS_NEWLINE sets cd->nllen. */
5735
807
            p += cd->nllen;
5736
807
            break;
5737
807
            }
5738
4.64k
          p++;
5739
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
5740
          if (utf) FORWARDCHAR(p);
5741
#endif
5742
4.64k
          }           /* Loop for comment characters */
5743
855
        }             /* Loop for multiple comments */
5744
546
      ptr = p - 1;    /* Character before the next significant one. */
5745
546
      }
5746
5747
    /* We also need to skip over (?# comments, which are not dependent on
5748
    extended mode. */
5749
5750
257k
    if (ptr[1] == CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS && ptr[2] == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK &&
5751
3.31k
        ptr[3] == CHAR_NUMBER_SIGN)
5752
220
      {
5753
220
      ptr += 4;
5754
1.11k
      while (*ptr != CHAR_NULL && *ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS) ptr++;
5755
220
      if (*ptr == CHAR_NULL)
5756
7
        {
5757
7
        *errorcodeptr = ERR18;
5758
7
        goto FAILED;
5759
7
        }
5760
220
      }
5761
5762
    /* If the next character is '+', we have a possessive quantifier. This
5763
    implies greediness, whatever the setting of the PCRE_UNGREEDY option.
5764
    If the next character is '?' this is a minimizing repeat, by default,
5765
    but if PCRE_UNGREEDY is set, it works the other way round. We change the
5766
    repeat type to the non-default. */
5767
5768
257k
    if (ptr[1] == CHAR_PLUS)
5769
10.2k
      {
5770
10.2k
      repeat_type = 0;                  /* Force greedy */
5771
10.2k
      possessive_quantifier = TRUE;
5772
10.2k
      ptr++;
5773
10.2k
      }
5774
247k
    else if (ptr[1] == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK)
5775
2.47k
      {
5776
2.47k
      repeat_type = greedy_non_default;
5777
2.47k
      ptr++;
5778
2.47k
      }
5779
245k
    else repeat_type = greedy_default;
5780
5781
    /* If previous was a recursion call, wrap it in atomic brackets so that
5782
    previous becomes the atomic group. All recursions were so wrapped in the
5783
    past, but it no longer happens for non-repeated recursions. In fact, the
5784
    repeated ones could be re-implemented independently so as not to need this,
5785
    but for the moment we rely on the code for repeating groups. */
5786
5787
257k
    if (*previous == OP_RECURSE)
5788
3.91k
      {
5789
3.91k
      memmove(previous + 1 + LINK_SIZE, previous, IN_UCHARS(1 + LINK_SIZE));
5790
3.91k
      *previous = OP_ONCE;
5791
3.91k
      PUT(previous, 1, 2 + 2*LINK_SIZE);
5792
3.91k
      previous[2 + 2*LINK_SIZE] = OP_KET;
5793
3.91k
      PUT(previous, 3 + 2*LINK_SIZE, 2 + 2*LINK_SIZE);
5794
3.91k
      code += 2 + 2 * LINK_SIZE;
5795
3.91k
      length_prevgroup = 3 + 3*LINK_SIZE;
5796
5797
      /* When actually compiling, we need to check whether this was a forward
5798
      reference, and if so, adjust the offset. */
5799
5800
3.91k
      if (lengthptr == NULL && cd->hwm >= cd->start_workspace + LINK_SIZE)
5801
1.44k
        {
5802
1.44k
        int offset = GET(cd->hwm, -LINK_SIZE);
5803
1.44k
        if (offset == previous + 1 - cd->start_code)
5804
576
          PUT(cd->hwm, -LINK_SIZE, offset + 1 + LINK_SIZE);
5805
1.44k
        }
5806
3.91k
      }
5807
5808
    /* Now handle repetition for the different types of item. */
5809
5810
    /* If previous was a character or negated character match, abolish the item
5811
    and generate a repeat item instead. If a char item has a minimum of more
5812
    than one, ensure that it is set in reqchar - it might not be if a sequence
5813
    such as x{3} is the first thing in a branch because the x will have gone
5814
    into firstchar instead.  */
5815
5816
257k
    if (*previous == OP_CHAR || *previous == OP_CHARI
5817
192k
        || *previous == OP_NOT || *previous == OP_NOTI)
5818
67.0k
      {
5819
67.0k
      switch (*previous)
5820
67.0k
        {
5821
0
        default: /* Make compiler happy. */
5822
60.5k
        case OP_CHAR:  op_type = OP_STAR - OP_STAR; break;
5823
4.85k
        case OP_CHARI: op_type = OP_STARI - OP_STAR; break;
5824
968
        case OP_NOT:   op_type = OP_NOTSTAR - OP_STAR; break;
5825
653
        case OP_NOTI:  op_type = OP_NOTSTARI - OP_STAR; break;
5826
67.0k
        }
5827
5828
      /* Deal with UTF characters that take up more than one character. It's
5829
      easier to write this out separately than try to macrify it. Use c to
5830
      hold the length of the character in bytes, plus UTF_LENGTH to flag that
5831
      it's a length rather than a small character. */
5832
5833
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32
5834
      if (utf && NOT_FIRSTCHAR(code[-1]))
5835
        {
5836
        pcre_uchar *lastchar = code - 1;
5837
        BACKCHAR(lastchar);
5838
        c = (int)(code - lastchar);     /* Length of UTF-8 character */
5839
        memcpy(utf_chars, lastchar, IN_UCHARS(c)); /* Save the char */
5840
        c |= UTF_LENGTH;                /* Flag c as a length */
5841
        }
5842
      else
5843
#endif /* SUPPORT_UTF */
5844
5845
      /* Handle the case of a single charater - either with no UTF support, or
5846
      with UTF disabled, or for a single character UTF character. */
5847
67.0k
        {
5848
67.0k
        c = code[-1];
5849
67.0k
        if (*previous <= OP_CHARI && repeat_min > 1)
5850
2.43k
          {
5851
2.43k
          reqchar = c;
5852
2.43k
          reqcharflags = req_caseopt | cd->req_varyopt;
5853
2.43k
          }
5854
67.0k
        }
5855
5856
67.0k
      goto OUTPUT_SINGLE_REPEAT;   /* Code shared with single character types */
5857
67.0k
      }
5858
5859
    /* If previous was a character type match (\d or similar), abolish it and
5860
    create a suitable repeat item. The code is shared with single-character
5861
    repeats by setting op_type to add a suitable offset into repeat_type. Note
5862
    the the Unicode property types will be present only when SUPPORT_UCP is
5863
    defined, but we don't wrap the little bits of code here because it just
5864
    makes it horribly messy. */
5865
5866
190k
    else if (*previous < OP_EODN)
5867
28.4k
      {
5868
28.4k
      pcre_uchar *oldcode;
5869
28.4k
      int prop_type, prop_value;
5870
28.4k
      op_type = OP_TYPESTAR - OP_STAR;  /* Use type opcodes */
5871
28.4k
      c = *previous;
5872
5873
95.4k
      OUTPUT_SINGLE_REPEAT:
5874
95.4k
      if (*previous == OP_PROP || *previous == OP_NOTPROP)
5875
0
        {
5876
0
        prop_type = previous[1];
5877
0
        prop_value = previous[2];
5878
0
        }
5879
95.4k
      else prop_type = prop_value = -1;
5880
5881
95.4k
      oldcode = code;
5882
95.4k
      code = previous;                  /* Usually overwrite previous item */
5883
5884
      /* If the maximum is zero then the minimum must also be zero; Perl allows
5885
      this case, so we do too - by simply omitting the item altogether. */
5886
5887
95.4k
      if (repeat_max == 0) goto END_REPEAT;
5888
5889
      /* Combine the op_type with the repeat_type */
5890
5891
94.8k
      repeat_type += op_type;
5892
5893
      /* A minimum of zero is handled either as the special case * or ?, or as
5894
      an UPTO, with the maximum given. */
5895
5896
94.8k
      if (repeat_min == 0)
5897
78.9k
        {
5898
78.9k
        if (repeat_max == -1) *code++ = OP_STAR + repeat_type;
5899
52.7k
          else if (repeat_max == 1) *code++ = OP_QUERY + repeat_type;
5900
437
        else
5901
437
          {
5902
437
          *code++ = OP_UPTO + repeat_type;
5903
437
          PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_max);
5904
437
          }
5905
78.9k
        }
5906
5907
      /* A repeat minimum of 1 is optimized into some special cases. If the
5908
      maximum is unlimited, we use OP_PLUS. Otherwise, the original item is
5909
      left in place and, if the maximum is greater than 1, we use OP_UPTO with
5910
      one less than the maximum. */
5911
5912
15.9k
      else if (repeat_min == 1)
5913
12.4k
        {
5914
12.4k
        if (repeat_max == -1)
5915
10.9k
          *code++ = OP_PLUS + repeat_type;
5916
1.54k
        else
5917
1.54k
          {
5918
1.54k
          code = oldcode;                 /* leave previous item in place */
5919
1.54k
          if (repeat_max == 1) goto END_REPEAT;
5920
1.13k
          *code++ = OP_UPTO + repeat_type;
5921
1.13k
          PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_max - 1);
5922
1.13k
          }
5923
12.4k
        }
5924
5925
      /* The case {n,n} is just an EXACT, while the general case {n,m} is
5926
      handled as an EXACT followed by an UPTO. */
5927
5928
3.48k
      else
5929
3.48k
        {
5930
3.48k
        *code++ = OP_EXACT + op_type;  /* NB EXACT doesn't have repeat_type */
5931
3.48k
        PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_min);
5932
5933
        /* If the maximum is unlimited, insert an OP_STAR. Before doing so,
5934
        we have to insert the character for the previous code. For a repeated
5935
        Unicode property match, there are two extra bytes that define the
5936
        required property. In UTF-8 mode, long characters have their length in
5937
        c, with the UTF_LENGTH bit as a flag. */
5938
5939
3.48k
        if (repeat_max < 0)
5940
238
          {
5941
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32
5942
          if (utf && (c & UTF_LENGTH) != 0)
5943
            {
5944
            memcpy(code, utf_chars, IN_UCHARS(c & 7));
5945
            code += c & 7;
5946
            }
5947
          else
5948
#endif
5949
238
            {
5950
238
            *code++ = c;
5951
238
            if (prop_type >= 0)
5952
0
              {
5953
0
              *code++ = prop_type;
5954
0
              *code++ = prop_value;
5955
0
              }
5956
238
            }
5957
238
          *code++ = OP_STAR + repeat_type;
5958
238
          }
5959
5960
        /* Else insert an UPTO if the max is greater than the min, again
5961
        preceded by the character, for the previously inserted code. If the
5962
        UPTO is just for 1 instance, we can use QUERY instead. */
5963
5964
3.24k
        else if (repeat_max != repeat_min)
5965
396
          {
5966
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32
5967
          if (utf && (c & UTF_LENGTH) != 0)
5968
            {
5969
            memcpy(code, utf_chars, IN_UCHARS(c & 7));
5970
            code += c & 7;
5971
            }
5972
          else
5973
#endif
5974
396
          *code++ = c;
5975
396
          if (prop_type >= 0)
5976
0
            {
5977
0
            *code++ = prop_type;
5978
0
            *code++ = prop_value;
5979
0
            }
5980
396
          repeat_max -= repeat_min;
5981
5982
396
          if (repeat_max == 1)
5983
214
            {
5984
214
            *code++ = OP_QUERY + repeat_type;
5985
214
            }
5986
182
          else
5987
182
            {
5988
182
            *code++ = OP_UPTO + repeat_type;
5989
182
            PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_max);
5990
182
            }
5991
396
          }
5992
3.48k
        }
5993
5994
      /* The character or character type itself comes last in all cases. */
5995
5996
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32
5997
      if (utf && (c & UTF_LENGTH) != 0)
5998
        {
5999
        memcpy(code, utf_chars, IN_UCHARS(c & 7));
6000
        code += c & 7;
6001
        }
6002
      else
6003
#endif
6004
94.4k
      *code++ = c;
6005
6006
      /* For a repeated Unicode property match, there are two extra bytes that
6007
      define the required property. */
6008
6009
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
6010
      if (prop_type >= 0)
6011
        {
6012
        *code++ = prop_type;
6013
        *code++ = prop_value;
6014
        }
6015
#endif
6016
94.4k
      }
6017
6018
    /* If previous was a character class or a back reference, we put the repeat
6019
    stuff after it, but just skip the item if the repeat was {0,0}. */
6020
6021
162k
    else if (*previous == OP_CLASS || *previous == OP_NCLASS ||
6022
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
6023
             *previous == OP_XCLASS ||
6024
#endif
6025
159k
             *previous == OP_REF   || *previous == OP_REFI ||
6026
156k
             *previous == OP_DNREF || *previous == OP_DNREFI)
6027
6.52k
      {
6028
6.52k
      if (repeat_max == 0)
6029
67
        {
6030
67
        code = previous;
6031
67
        goto END_REPEAT;
6032
67
        }
6033
6034
6.45k
      if (repeat_min == 0 && repeat_max == -1)
6035
817
        *code++ = OP_CRSTAR + repeat_type;
6036
5.64k
      else if (repeat_min == 1 && repeat_max == -1)
6037
2.01k
        *code++ = OP_CRPLUS + repeat_type;
6038
3.62k
      else if (repeat_min == 0 && repeat_max == 1)
6039
2.25k
        *code++ = OP_CRQUERY + repeat_type;
6040
1.36k
      else
6041
1.36k
        {
6042
1.36k
        *code++ = OP_CRRANGE + repeat_type;
6043
1.36k
        PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_min);
6044
1.36k
        if (repeat_max == -1) repeat_max = 0;  /* 2-byte encoding for max */
6045
1.36k
        PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_max);
6046
1.36k
        }
6047
6.45k
      }
6048
6049
    /* If previous was a bracket group, we may have to replicate it in certain
6050
    cases. Note that at this point we can encounter only the "basic" bracket
6051
    opcodes such as BRA and CBRA, as this is the place where they get converted
6052
    into the more special varieties such as BRAPOS and SBRA. A test for >=
6053
    OP_ASSERT and <= OP_COND includes ASSERT, ASSERT_NOT, ASSERTBACK,
6054
    ASSERTBACK_NOT, ONCE, ONCE_NC, BRA, BRAPOS, CBRA, CBRAPOS, and COND.
6055
    Originally, PCRE did not allow repetition of assertions, but now it does,
6056
    for Perl compatibility. */
6057
6058
155k
    else if (*previous >= OP_ASSERT && *previous <= OP_COND)
6059
155k
      {
6060
155k
      register int i;
6061
155k
      int len = (int)(code - previous);
6062
155k
      size_t base_hwm_offset = item_hwm_offset;
6063
155k
      pcre_uchar *bralink = NULL;
6064
155k
      pcre_uchar *brazeroptr = NULL;
6065
6066
      /* Repeating a DEFINE group is pointless, but Perl allows the syntax, so
6067
      we just ignore the repeat. */
6068
6069
155k
      if (*previous == OP_COND && previous[LINK_SIZE+1] == OP_DEF)
6070
77
        goto END_REPEAT;
6071
6072
      /* There is no sense in actually repeating assertions. The only potential
6073
      use of repetition is in cases when the assertion is optional. Therefore,
6074
      if the minimum is greater than zero, just ignore the repeat. If the
6075
      maximum is not zero or one, set it to 1. */
6076
6077
155k
      if (*previous < OP_ONCE)    /* Assertion */
6078
1.52k
        {
6079
1.52k
        if (repeat_min > 0) goto END_REPEAT;
6080
910
        if (repeat_max < 0 || repeat_max > 1) repeat_max = 1;
6081
910
        }
6082
6083
      /* The case of a zero minimum is special because of the need to stick
6084
      OP_BRAZERO in front of it, and because the group appears once in the
6085
      data, whereas in other cases it appears the minimum number of times. For
6086
      this reason, it is simplest to treat this case separately, as otherwise
6087
      the code gets far too messy. There are several special subcases when the
6088
      minimum is zero. */
6089
6090
155k
      if (repeat_min == 0)
6091
139k
        {
6092
        /* If the maximum is also zero, we used to just omit the group from the
6093
        output altogether, like this:
6094
6095
        ** if (repeat_max == 0)
6096
        **   {
6097
        **   code = previous;
6098
        **   goto END_REPEAT;
6099
        **   }
6100
6101
        However, that fails when a group or a subgroup within it is referenced
6102
        as a subroutine from elsewhere in the pattern, so now we stick in
6103
        OP_SKIPZERO in front of it so that it is skipped on execution. As we
6104
        don't have a list of which groups are referenced, we cannot do this
6105
        selectively.
6106
6107
        If the maximum is 1 or unlimited, we just have to stick in the BRAZERO
6108
        and do no more at this point. However, we do need to adjust any
6109
        OP_RECURSE calls inside the group that refer to the group itself or any
6110
        internal or forward referenced group, because the offset is from the
6111
        start of the whole regex. Temporarily terminate the pattern while doing
6112
        this. */
6113
6114
139k
        if (repeat_max <= 1)    /* Covers 0, 1, and unlimited */
6115
139k
          {
6116
139k
          *code = OP_END;
6117
139k
          adjust_recurse(previous, 1, utf, cd, item_hwm_offset);
6118
139k
          memmove(previous + 1, previous, IN_UCHARS(len));
6119
139k
          code++;
6120
139k
          if (repeat_max == 0)
6121
129
            {
6122
129
            *previous++ = OP_SKIPZERO;
6123
129
            goto END_REPEAT;
6124
129
            }
6125
139k
          brazeroptr = previous;    /* Save for possessive optimizing */
6126
139k
          *previous++ = OP_BRAZERO + repeat_type;
6127
139k
          }
6128
6129
        /* If the maximum is greater than 1 and limited, we have to replicate
6130
        in a nested fashion, sticking OP_BRAZERO before each set of brackets.
6131
        The first one has to be handled carefully because it's the original
6132
        copy, which has to be moved up. The remainder can be handled by code
6133
        that is common with the non-zero minimum case below. We have to
6134
        adjust the value or repeat_max, since one less copy is required. Once
6135
        again, we may have to adjust any OP_RECURSE calls inside the group. */
6136
6137
202
        else
6138
202
          {
6139
202
          int offset;
6140
202
          *code = OP_END;
6141
202
          adjust_recurse(previous, 2 + LINK_SIZE, utf, cd, item_hwm_offset);
6142
202
          memmove(previous + 2 + LINK_SIZE, previous, IN_UCHARS(len));
6143
202
          code += 2 + LINK_SIZE;
6144
202
          *previous++ = OP_BRAZERO + repeat_type;
6145
202
          *previous++ = OP_BRA;
6146
6147
          /* We chain together the bracket offset fields that have to be
6148
          filled in later when the ends of the brackets are reached. */
6149
6150
202
          offset = (bralink == NULL)? 0 : (int)(previous - bralink);
6151
202
          bralink = previous;
6152
202
          PUTINC(previous, 0, offset);
6153
202
          }
6154
6155
139k
        repeat_max--;
6156
139k
        }
6157
6158
      /* If the minimum is greater than zero, replicate the group as many
6159
      times as necessary, and adjust the maximum to the number of subsequent
6160
      copies that we need. If we set a first char from the group, and didn't
6161
      set a required char, copy the latter from the former. If there are any
6162
      forward reference subroutine calls in the group, there will be entries on
6163
      the workspace list; replicate these with an appropriate increment. */
6164
6165
15.5k
      else
6166
15.5k
        {
6167
15.5k
        if (repeat_min > 1)
6168
7.14k
          {
6169
          /* In the pre-compile phase, we don't actually do the replication. We
6170
          just adjust the length as if we had. Do some paranoid checks for
6171
          potential integer overflow. The INT64_OR_DOUBLE type is a 64-bit
6172
          integer type when available, otherwise double. */
6173
6174
7.14k
          if (lengthptr != NULL)
6175
3.77k
            {
6176
3.77k
            int delta = (repeat_min - 1)*length_prevgroup;
6177
3.77k
            if ((INT64_OR_DOUBLE)(repeat_min - 1)*
6178
3.77k
                  (INT64_OR_DOUBLE)length_prevgroup >
6179
3.77k
                    (INT64_OR_DOUBLE)INT_MAX ||
6180
3.76k
                OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < delta)
6181
27
              {
6182
27
              *errorcodeptr = ERR20;
6183
27
              goto FAILED;
6184
27
              }
6185
3.75k
            *lengthptr += delta;
6186
3.75k
            }
6187
6188
          /* This is compiling for real. If there is a set first byte for
6189
          the group, and we have not yet set a "required byte", set it. Make
6190
          sure there is enough workspace for copying forward references before
6191
          doing the copy. */
6192
6193
3.36k
          else
6194
3.36k
            {
6195
3.36k
            if (groupsetfirstchar && reqcharflags < 0)
6196
309
              {
6197
309
              reqchar = firstchar;
6198
309
              reqcharflags = firstcharflags;
6199
309
              }
6200
6201
913k
            for (i = 1; i < repeat_min; i++)
6202
909k
              {
6203
909k
              pcre_uchar *hc;
6204
909k
              size_t this_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;
6205
909k
              memcpy(code, previous, IN_UCHARS(len));
6206
6207
909k
              while (cd->hwm > cd->start_workspace + cd->workspace_size -
6208
909k
                     WORK_SIZE_SAFETY_MARGIN -
6209
909k
                     (this_hwm_offset - base_hwm_offset))
6210
26
                {
6211
26
                *errorcodeptr = expand_workspace(cd);
6212
26
                if (*errorcodeptr != 0) goto FAILED;
6213
26
                }
6214
6215
909k
              for (hc = (pcre_uchar *)cd->start_workspace + base_hwm_offset;
6216
1.01M
                   hc < (pcre_uchar *)cd->start_workspace + this_hwm_offset;
6217
909k
                   hc += LINK_SIZE)
6218
104k
                {
6219
104k
                PUT(cd->hwm, 0, GET(hc, 0) + len);
6220
104k
                cd->hwm += LINK_SIZE;
6221
104k
                }
6222
909k
              base_hwm_offset = this_hwm_offset;
6223
909k
              code += len;
6224
909k
              }
6225
3.36k
            }
6226
7.14k
          }
6227
6228
15.4k
        if (repeat_max > 0) repeat_max -= repeat_min;
6229
15.4k
        }
6230
6231
      /* This code is common to both the zero and non-zero minimum cases. If
6232
      the maximum is limited, it replicates the group in a nested fashion,
6233
      remembering the bracket starts on a stack. In the case of a zero minimum,
6234
      the first one was set up above. In all cases the repeat_max now specifies
6235
      the number of additional copies needed. Again, we must remember to
6236
      replicate entries on the forward reference list. */
6237
6238
155k
      if (repeat_max >= 0)
6239
143k
        {
6240
        /* In the pre-compile phase, we don't actually do the replication. We
6241
        just adjust the length as if we had. For each repetition we must add 1
6242
        to the length for BRAZERO and for all but the last repetition we must
6243
        add 2 + 2*LINKSIZE to allow for the nesting that occurs. Do some
6244
        paranoid checks to avoid integer overflow. The INT64_OR_DOUBLE type is
6245
        a 64-bit integer type when available, otherwise double. */
6246
6247
143k
        if (lengthptr != NULL && repeat_max > 0)
6248
474
          {
6249
474
          int delta = repeat_max * (length_prevgroup + 1 + 2 + 2*LINK_SIZE) -
6250
474
                      2 - 2*LINK_SIZE;   /* Last one doesn't nest */
6251
474
          if ((INT64_OR_DOUBLE)repeat_max *
6252
474
                (INT64_OR_DOUBLE)(length_prevgroup + 1 + 2 + 2*LINK_SIZE)
6253
474
                  > (INT64_OR_DOUBLE)INT_MAX ||
6254
458
              OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < delta)
6255
33
            {
6256
33
            *errorcodeptr = ERR20;
6257
33
            goto FAILED;
6258
33
            }
6259
441
          *lengthptr += delta;
6260
441
          }
6261
6262
        /* This is compiling for real */
6263
6264
172k
        else for (i = repeat_max - 1; i >= 0; i--)
6265
29.7k
          {
6266
29.7k
          pcre_uchar *hc;
6267
29.7k
          size_t this_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;
6268
6269
29.7k
          *code++ = OP_BRAZERO + repeat_type;
6270
6271
          /* All but the final copy start a new nesting, maintaining the
6272
          chain of brackets outstanding. */
6273
6274
29.7k
          if (i != 0)
6275
29.4k
            {
6276
29.4k
            int offset;
6277
29.4k
            *code++ = OP_BRA;
6278
29.4k
            offset = (bralink == NULL)? 0 : (int)(code - bralink);
6279
29.4k
            bralink = code;
6280
29.4k
            PUTINC(code, 0, offset);
6281
29.4k
            }
6282
6283
29.7k
          memcpy(code, previous, IN_UCHARS(len));
6284
6285
          /* Ensure there is enough workspace for forward references before
6286
          copying them. */
6287
6288
29.7k
          while (cd->hwm > cd->start_workspace + cd->workspace_size -
6289
29.7k
                 WORK_SIZE_SAFETY_MARGIN -
6290
29.7k
                 (this_hwm_offset - base_hwm_offset))
6291
8
            {
6292
8
            *errorcodeptr = expand_workspace(cd);
6293
8
            if (*errorcodeptr != 0) goto FAILED;
6294
8
            }
6295
6296
29.7k
          for (hc = (pcre_uchar *)cd->start_workspace + base_hwm_offset;
6297
52.7k
               hc < (pcre_uchar *)cd->start_workspace + this_hwm_offset;
6298
29.7k
               hc += LINK_SIZE)
6299
23.0k
            {
6300
23.0k
            PUT(cd->hwm, 0, GET(hc, 0) + len + ((i != 0)? 2+LINK_SIZE : 1));
6301
23.0k
            cd->hwm += LINK_SIZE;
6302
23.0k
            }
6303
29.7k
          base_hwm_offset = this_hwm_offset;
6304
29.7k
          code += len;
6305
29.7k
          }
6306
6307
        /* Now chain through the pending brackets, and fill in their length
6308
        fields (which are holding the chain links pro tem). */
6309
6310
173k
        while (bralink != NULL)
6311
29.6k
          {
6312
29.6k
          int oldlinkoffset;
6313
29.6k
          int offset = (int)(code - bralink + 1);
6314
29.6k
          pcre_uchar *bra = code - offset;
6315
29.6k
          oldlinkoffset = GET(bra, 1);
6316
29.6k
          bralink = (oldlinkoffset == 0)? NULL : bralink - oldlinkoffset;
6317
29.6k
          *code++ = OP_KET;
6318
29.6k
          PUTINC(code, 0, offset);
6319
29.6k
          PUT(bra, 1, offset);
6320
29.6k
          }
6321
143k
        }
6322
6323
      /* If the maximum is unlimited, set a repeater in the final copy. For
6324
      ONCE brackets, that's all we need to do. However, possessively repeated
6325
      ONCE brackets can be converted into non-capturing brackets, as the
6326
      behaviour of (?:xx)++ is the same as (?>xx)++ and this saves having to
6327
      deal with possessive ONCEs specially.
6328
6329
      Otherwise, when we are doing the actual compile phase, check to see
6330
      whether this group is one that could match an empty string. If so,
6331
      convert the initial operator to the S form (e.g. OP_BRA -> OP_SBRA) so
6332
      that runtime checking can be done. [This check is also applied to ONCE
6333
      groups at runtime, but in a different way.]
6334
6335
      Then, if the quantifier was possessive and the bracket is not a
6336
      conditional, we convert the BRA code to the POS form, and the KET code to
6337
      KETRPOS. (It turns out to be convenient at runtime to detect this kind of
6338
      subpattern at both the start and at the end.) The use of special opcodes
6339
      makes it possible to reduce greatly the stack usage in pcre_exec(). If
6340
      the group is preceded by OP_BRAZERO, convert this to OP_BRAPOSZERO.
6341
6342
      Then, if the minimum number of matches is 1 or 0, cancel the possessive
6343
      flag so that the default action below, of wrapping everything inside
6344
      atomic brackets, does not happen. When the minimum is greater than 1,
6345
      there will be earlier copies of the group, and so we still have to wrap
6346
      the whole thing. */
6347
6348
11.6k
      else
6349
11.6k
        {
6350
11.6k
        pcre_uchar *ketcode = code - 1 - LINK_SIZE;
6351
11.6k
        pcre_uchar *bracode = ketcode - GET(ketcode, 1);
6352
6353
        /* Convert possessive ONCE brackets to non-capturing */
6354
6355
11.6k
        if ((*bracode == OP_ONCE || *bracode == OP_ONCE_NC) &&
6356
4.22k
            possessive_quantifier) *bracode = OP_BRA;
6357
6358
        /* For non-possessive ONCE brackets, all we need to do is to
6359
        set the KET. */
6360
6361
11.6k
        if (*bracode == OP_ONCE || *bracode == OP_ONCE_NC)
6362
2.20k
          *ketcode = OP_KETRMAX + repeat_type;
6363
6364
        /* Handle non-ONCE brackets and possessive ONCEs (which have been
6365
        converted to non-capturing above). */
6366
6367
9.47k
        else
6368
9.47k
          {
6369
          /* In the compile phase, check for empty string matching. */
6370
6371
9.47k
          if (lengthptr == NULL)
6372
4.33k
            {
6373
4.33k
            pcre_uchar *scode = bracode;
6374
4.33k
            do
6375
5.04k
              {
6376
5.04k
              if (could_be_empty_branch(scode, ketcode, utf, cd, NULL))
6377
1.92k
                {
6378
1.92k
                *bracode += OP_SBRA - OP_BRA;
6379
1.92k
                break;
6380
1.92k
                }
6381
3.12k
              scode += GET(scode, 1);
6382
3.12k
              }
6383
4.33k
            while (*scode == OP_ALT);
6384
4.33k
            }
6385
6386
          /* A conditional group with only one branch has an implicit empty
6387
          alternative branch. */
6388
6389
9.47k
          if (*bracode == OP_COND && bracode[GET(bracode,1)] != OP_ALT)
6390
1.11k
            *bracode = OP_SCOND;
6391
6392
          /* Handle possessive quantifiers. */
6393
6394
9.47k
          if (possessive_quantifier)
6395
5.19k
            {
6396
            /* For COND brackets, we wrap the whole thing in a possessively
6397
            repeated non-capturing bracket, because we have not invented POS
6398
            versions of the COND opcodes. Because we are moving code along, we
6399
            must ensure that any pending recursive references are updated. */
6400
6401
5.19k
            if (*bracode == OP_COND || *bracode == OP_SCOND)
6402
1.16k
              {
6403
1.16k
              int nlen = (int)(code - bracode);
6404
1.16k
              *code = OP_END;
6405
1.16k
              adjust_recurse(bracode, 1 + LINK_SIZE, utf, cd, item_hwm_offset);
6406
1.16k
              memmove(bracode + 1 + LINK_SIZE, bracode, IN_UCHARS(nlen));
6407
1.16k
              code += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
6408
1.16k
              nlen += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
6409
1.16k
              *bracode = (*bracode == OP_COND)? OP_BRAPOS : OP_SBRAPOS;
6410
1.16k
              *code++ = OP_KETRPOS;
6411
1.16k
              PUTINC(code, 0, nlen);
6412
1.16k
              PUT(bracode, 1, nlen);
6413
1.16k
              }
6414
6415
            /* For non-COND brackets, we modify the BRA code and use KETRPOS. */
6416
6417
4.03k
            else
6418
4.03k
              {
6419
4.03k
              *bracode += 1;              /* Switch to xxxPOS opcodes */
6420
4.03k
              *ketcode = OP_KETRPOS;
6421
4.03k
              }
6422
6423
            /* If the minimum is zero, mark it as possessive, then unset the
6424
            possessive flag when the minimum is 0 or 1. */
6425
6426
5.19k
            if (brazeroptr != NULL) *brazeroptr = OP_BRAPOSZERO;
6427
5.19k
            if (repeat_min < 2) possessive_quantifier = FALSE;
6428
5.19k
            }
6429
6430
          /* Non-possessive quantifier */
6431
6432
4.27k
          else *ketcode = OP_KETRMAX + repeat_type;
6433
9.47k
          }
6434
11.6k
        }
6435
155k
      }
6436
6437
    /* If previous is OP_FAIL, it was generated by an empty class [] in
6438
    JavaScript mode. The other ways in which OP_FAIL can be generated, that is
6439
    by (*FAIL) or (?!) set previous to NULL, which gives a "nothing to repeat"
6440
    error above. We can just ignore the repeat in JS case. */
6441
6442
0
    else if (*previous == OP_FAIL) goto END_REPEAT;
6443
6444
    /* Else there's some kind of shambles */
6445
6446
0
    else
6447
0
      {
6448
0
      *errorcodeptr = ERR11;
6449
0
      goto FAILED;
6450
0
      }
6451
6452
    /* If the character following a repeat is '+', possessive_quantifier is
6453
    TRUE. For some opcodes, there are special alternative opcodes for this
6454
    case. For anything else, we wrap the entire repeated item inside OP_ONCE
6455
    brackets. Logically, the '+' notation is just syntactic sugar, taken from
6456
    Sun's Java package, but the special opcodes can optimize it.
6457
6458
    Some (but not all) possessively repeated subpatterns have already been
6459
    completely handled in the code just above. For them, possessive_quantifier
6460
    is always FALSE at this stage. Note that the repeated item starts at
6461
    tempcode, not at previous, which might be the first part of a string whose
6462
    (former) last char we repeated. */
6463
6464
256k
    if (possessive_quantifier)
6465
5.50k
      {
6466
5.50k
      int len;
6467
6468
      /* Possessifying an EXACT quantifier has no effect, so we can ignore it.
6469
      However, QUERY, STAR, or UPTO may follow (for quantifiers such as {5,6},
6470
      {5,}, or {5,10}). We skip over an EXACT item; if the length of what
6471
      remains is greater than zero, there's a further opcode that can be
6472
      handled. If not, do nothing, leaving the EXACT alone. */
6473
6474
5.50k
      switch(*tempcode)
6475
5.50k
        {
6476
218
        case OP_TYPEEXACT:
6477
218
        tempcode += PRIV(OP_lengths)[*tempcode] +
6478
218
          ((tempcode[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_PROP
6479
218
          || tempcode[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_NOTPROP)? 2 : 0);
6480
218
        break;
6481
6482
        /* CHAR opcodes are used for exacts whose count is 1. */
6483
6484
286
        case OP_CHAR:
6485
484
        case OP_CHARI:
6486
752
        case OP_NOT:
6487
945
        case OP_NOTI:
6488
1.16k
        case OP_EXACT:
6489
1.37k
        case OP_EXACTI:
6490
1.59k
        case OP_NOTEXACT:
6491
1.79k
        case OP_NOTEXACTI:
6492
1.79k
        tempcode += PRIV(OP_lengths)[*tempcode];
6493
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
6494
        if (utf && HAS_EXTRALEN(tempcode[-1]))
6495
          tempcode += GET_EXTRALEN(tempcode[-1]);
6496
#endif
6497
1.79k
        break;
6498
6499
        /* For the class opcodes, the repeat operator appears at the end;
6500
        adjust tempcode to point to it. */
6501
6502
382
        case OP_CLASS:
6503
742
        case OP_NCLASS:
6504
742
        tempcode += 1 + 32/sizeof(pcre_uchar);
6505
742
        break;
6506
6507
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
6508
        case OP_XCLASS:
6509
        tempcode += GET(tempcode, 1);
6510
        break;
6511
#endif
6512
5.50k
        }
6513
6514
      /* If tempcode is equal to code (which points to the end of the repeated
6515
      item), it means we have skipped an EXACT item but there is no following
6516
      QUERY, STAR, or UPTO; the value of len will be 0, and we do nothing. In
6517
      all other cases, tempcode will be pointing to the repeat opcode, and will
6518
      be less than code, so the value of len will be greater than 0. */
6519
6520
5.50k
      len = (int)(code - tempcode);
6521
5.50k
      if (len > 0)
6522
4.46k
        {
6523
4.46k
        unsigned int repcode = *tempcode;
6524
6525
        /* There is a table for possessifying opcodes, all of which are less
6526
        than OP_CALLOUT. A zero entry means there is no possessified version.
6527
        */
6528
6529
4.46k
        if (repcode < OP_CALLOUT && opcode_possessify[repcode] > 0)
6530
2.99k
          *tempcode = opcode_possessify[repcode];
6531
6532
        /* For opcode without a special possessified version, wrap the item in
6533
        ONCE brackets. Because we are moving code along, we must ensure that any
6534
        pending recursive references are updated. */
6535
6536
1.47k
        else
6537
1.47k
          {
6538
1.47k
          *code = OP_END;
6539
1.47k
          adjust_recurse(tempcode, 1 + LINK_SIZE, utf, cd, item_hwm_offset);
6540
1.47k
          memmove(tempcode + 1 + LINK_SIZE, tempcode, IN_UCHARS(len));
6541
1.47k
          code += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
6542
1.47k
          len += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
6543
1.47k
          tempcode[0] = OP_ONCE;
6544
1.47k
          *code++ = OP_KET;
6545
1.47k
          PUTINC(code, 0, len);
6546
1.47k
          PUT(tempcode, 1, len);
6547
1.47k
          }
6548
4.46k
        }
6549
6550
#ifdef NEVER
6551
      if (len > 0) switch (*tempcode)
6552
        {
6553
        case OP_STAR:  *tempcode = OP_POSSTAR; break;
6554
        case OP_PLUS:  *tempcode = OP_POSPLUS; break;
6555
        case OP_QUERY: *tempcode = OP_POSQUERY; break;
6556
        case OP_UPTO:  *tempcode = OP_POSUPTO; break;
6557
6558
        case OP_STARI:  *tempcode = OP_POSSTARI; break;
6559
        case OP_PLUSI:  *tempcode = OP_POSPLUSI; break;
6560
        case OP_QUERYI: *tempcode = OP_POSQUERYI; break;
6561
        case OP_UPTOI:  *tempcode = OP_POSUPTOI; break;
6562
6563
        case OP_NOTSTAR:  *tempcode = OP_NOTPOSSTAR; break;
6564
        case OP_NOTPLUS:  *tempcode = OP_NOTPOSPLUS; break;
6565
        case OP_NOTQUERY: *tempcode = OP_NOTPOSQUERY; break;
6566
        case OP_NOTUPTO:  *tempcode = OP_NOTPOSUPTO; break;
6567
6568
        case OP_NOTSTARI:  *tempcode = OP_NOTPOSSTARI; break;
6569
        case OP_NOTPLUSI:  *tempcode = OP_NOTPOSPLUSI; break;
6570
        case OP_NOTQUERYI: *tempcode = OP_NOTPOSQUERYI; break;
6571
        case OP_NOTUPTOI:  *tempcode = OP_NOTPOSUPTOI; break;
6572
6573
        case OP_TYPESTAR:  *tempcode = OP_TYPEPOSSTAR; break;
6574
        case OP_TYPEPLUS:  *tempcode = OP_TYPEPOSPLUS; break;
6575
        case OP_TYPEQUERY: *tempcode = OP_TYPEPOSQUERY; break;
6576
        case OP_TYPEUPTO:  *tempcode = OP_TYPEPOSUPTO; break;
6577
6578
        case OP_CRSTAR:   *tempcode = OP_CRPOSSTAR; break;
6579
        case OP_CRPLUS:   *tempcode = OP_CRPOSPLUS; break;
6580
        case OP_CRQUERY:  *tempcode = OP_CRPOSQUERY; break;
6581
        case OP_CRRANGE:  *tempcode = OP_CRPOSRANGE; break;
6582
6583
        /* Because we are moving code along, we must ensure that any
6584
        pending recursive references are updated. */
6585
6586
        default:
6587
        *code = OP_END;
6588
        adjust_recurse(tempcode, 1 + LINK_SIZE, utf, cd, item_hwm_offset);
6589
        memmove(tempcode + 1 + LINK_SIZE, tempcode, IN_UCHARS(len));
6590
        code += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
6591
        len += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
6592
        tempcode[0] = OP_ONCE;
6593
        *code++ = OP_KET;
6594
        PUTINC(code, 0, len);
6595
        PUT(tempcode, 1, len);
6596
        break;
6597
        }
6598
#endif
6599
5.50k
      }
6600
6601
    /* In all case we no longer have a previous item. We also set the
6602
    "follows varying string" flag for subsequently encountered reqchars if
6603
    it isn't already set and we have just passed a varying length item. */
6604
6605
257k
    END_REPEAT:
6606
257k
    previous = NULL;
6607
257k
    cd->req_varyopt |= reqvary;
6608
257k
    break;
6609
6610
6611
    /* ===================================================================*/
6612
    /* Start of nested parenthesized sub-expression, or comment or lookahead or
6613
    lookbehind or option setting or condition or all the other extended
6614
    parenthesis forms.  */
6615
6616
676k
    case CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS:
6617
676k
    ptr++;
6618
6619
    /* Now deal with various "verbs" that can be introduced by '*'. */
6620
6621
676k
    if (ptr[0] == CHAR_ASTERISK && (ptr[1] == ':'
6622
2.67k
         || (MAX_255(ptr[1]) && ((cd->ctypes[ptr[1]] & ctype_letter) != 0))))
6623
3.30k
      {
6624
3.30k
      int i, namelen;
6625
3.30k
      int arglen = 0;
6626
3.30k
      const char *vn = verbnames;
6627
3.30k
      const pcre_uchar *name = ptr + 1;
6628
3.30k
      const pcre_uchar *arg = NULL;
6629
3.30k
      previous = NULL;
6630
3.30k
      ptr++;
6631
143k
      while (MAX_255(*ptr) && (cd->ctypes[*ptr] & ctype_letter) != 0) ptr++;
6632
3.30k
      namelen = (int)(ptr - name);
6633
6634
      /* It appears that Perl allows any characters whatsoever, other than
6635
      a closing parenthesis, to appear in arguments, so we no longer insist on
6636
      letters, digits, and underscores. */
6637
6638
3.30k
      if (*ptr == CHAR_COLON)
6639
1.48k
        {
6640
1.48k
        arg = ++ptr;
6641
55.7k
        while (*ptr != CHAR_NULL && *ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS) ptr++;
6642
1.48k
        arglen = (int)(ptr - arg);
6643
1.48k
        if ((unsigned int)arglen > MAX_MARK)
6644
6
          {
6645
6
          *errorcodeptr = ERR75;
6646
6
          goto FAILED;
6647
6
          }
6648
1.48k
        }
6649
6650
3.30k
      if (*ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
6651
658
        {
6652
658
        *errorcodeptr = ERR60;
6653
658
        goto FAILED;
6654
658
        }
6655
6656
      /* Scan the table of verb names */
6657
6658
13.8k
      for (i = 0; i < verbcount; i++)
6659
13.8k
        {
6660
13.8k
        if (namelen == verbs[i].len &&
6661
4.82k
            STRNCMP_UC_C8(name, vn, namelen) == 0)
6662
2.60k
          {
6663
2.60k
          int setverb;
6664
6665
          /* Check for open captures before ACCEPT and convert it to
6666
          ASSERT_ACCEPT if in an assertion. */
6667
6668
2.60k
          if (verbs[i].op == OP_ACCEPT)
6669
514
            {
6670
514
            open_capitem *oc;
6671
514
            if (arglen != 0)
6672
0
              {
6673
0
              *errorcodeptr = ERR59;
6674
0
              goto FAILED;
6675
0
              }
6676
514
            cd->had_accept = TRUE;
6677
1.21k
            for (oc = cd->open_caps; oc != NULL; oc = oc->next)
6678
702
              {
6679
702
              if (lengthptr != NULL)
6680
449
                {
6681
449
#ifdef COMPILE_PCRE8
6682
449
                *lengthptr += 1 + IMM2_SIZE;
6683
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16
6684
                *lengthptr += 2 + IMM2_SIZE;
6685
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32
6686
                *lengthptr += 4 + IMM2_SIZE;
6687
#endif
6688
449
                }
6689
253
              else
6690
253
                {
6691
253
                *code++ = OP_CLOSE;
6692
253
                PUT2INC(code, 0, oc->number);
6693
253
                }
6694
702
              }
6695
514
            setverb = *code++ =
6696
514
              (cd->assert_depth > 0)? OP_ASSERT_ACCEPT : OP_ACCEPT;
6697
6698
            /* Do not set firstchar after *ACCEPT */
6699
514
            if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
6700
514
            }
6701
6702
          /* Handle other cases with/without an argument */
6703
6704
2.09k
          else if (arglen == 0)
6705
644
            {
6706
644
            if (verbs[i].op < 0)   /* Argument is mandatory */
6707
3
              {
6708
3
              *errorcodeptr = ERR66;
6709
3
              goto FAILED;
6710
3
              }
6711
641
            setverb = *code++ = verbs[i].op;
6712
641
            }
6713
6714
1.44k
          else
6715
1.44k
            {
6716
1.44k
            if (verbs[i].op_arg < 0)   /* Argument is forbidden */
6717
2
              {
6718
2
              *errorcodeptr = ERR59;
6719
2
              goto FAILED;
6720
2
              }
6721
1.44k
            setverb = *code++ = verbs[i].op_arg;
6722
1.44k
            if (lengthptr != NULL)    /* In pass 1 just add in the length */
6723
732
              {                       /* to avoid potential workspace */
6724
732
              *lengthptr += arglen;   /* overflow. */
6725
732
              *code++ = 0;
6726
732
              }
6727
712
            else
6728
712
              {
6729
712
              *code++ = arglen;
6730
712
              memcpy(code, arg, IN_UCHARS(arglen));
6731
712
              code += arglen;
6732
712
              }
6733
1.44k
            *code++ = 0;
6734
1.44k
            }
6735
6736
2.59k
          switch (setverb)
6737
2.59k
            {
6738
100
            case OP_THEN:
6739
402
            case OP_THEN_ARG:
6740
402
            cd->external_flags |= PCRE_HASTHEN;
6741
402
            break;
6742
6743
224
            case OP_PRUNE:
6744
482
            case OP_PRUNE_ARG:
6745
696
            case OP_SKIP:
6746
953
            case OP_SKIP_ARG:
6747
953
            cd->had_pruneorskip = TRUE;
6748
953
            break;
6749
2.59k
            }
6750
6751
2.59k
          break;  /* Found verb, exit loop */
6752
2.59k
          }
6753
6754
11.2k
        vn += verbs[i].len + 1;
6755
11.2k
        }
6756
6757
2.64k
      if (i < verbcount) continue;    /* Successfully handled a verb */
6758
41
      *errorcodeptr = ERR60;          /* Verb not recognized */
6759
41
      goto FAILED;
6760
2.64k
      }
6761
6762
    /* Initialize for "real" parentheses */
6763
6764
673k
    newoptions = options;
6765
673k
    skipbytes = 0;
6766
673k
    bravalue = OP_CBRA;
6767
673k
    item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;
6768
673k
    reset_bracount = FALSE;
6769
6770
    /* Deal with the extended parentheses; all are introduced by '?', and the
6771
    appearance of any of them means that this is not a capturing group. */
6772
6773
673k
    if (*ptr == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK)
6774
159k
      {
6775
159k
      int i, set, unset, namelen;
6776
159k
      int *optset;
6777
159k
      const pcre_uchar *name;
6778
159k
      pcre_uchar *slot;
6779
6780
159k
      switch (*(++ptr))
6781
159k
        {
6782
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
6783
1.39k
        case CHAR_VERTICAL_LINE:  /* Reset capture count for each branch */
6784
1.39k
        reset_bracount = TRUE;
6785
1.39k
        cd->dupgroups = TRUE;     /* Record (?| encountered */
6786
        /* Fall through */
6787
6788
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
6789
2.61k
        case CHAR_COLON:          /* Non-capturing bracket */
6790
2.61k
        bravalue = OP_BRA;
6791
2.61k
        ptr++;
6792
2.61k
        break;
6793
6794
6795
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
6796
10.6k
        case CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS:
6797
10.6k
        bravalue = OP_COND;       /* Conditional group */
6798
10.6k
        tempptr = ptr;
6799
6800
        /* A condition can be an assertion, a number (referring to a numbered
6801
        group's having been set), a name (referring to a named group), or 'R',
6802
        referring to recursion. R<digits> and R&name are also permitted for
6803
        recursion tests.
6804
6805
        There are ways of testing a named group: (?(name)) is used by Python;
6806
        Perl 5.10 onwards uses (?(<name>) or (?('name')).
6807
6808
        There is one unfortunate ambiguity, caused by history. 'R' can be the
6809
        recursive thing or the name 'R' (and similarly for 'R' followed by
6810
        digits). We look for a name first; if not found, we try the other case.
6811
6812
        For compatibility with auto-callouts, we allow a callout to be
6813
        specified before a condition that is an assertion. First, check for the
6814
        syntax of a callout; if found, adjust the temporary pointer that is
6815
        used to check for an assertion condition. That's all that is needed! */
6816
6817
10.6k
        if (ptr[1] == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK && ptr[2] == CHAR_C)
6818
400
          {
6819
596
          for (i = 3;; i++) if (!IS_DIGIT(ptr[i])) break;
6820
400
          if (ptr[i] == CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
6821
386
            tempptr += i + 1;
6822
6823
          /* tempptr should now be pointing to the opening parenthesis of the
6824
          assertion condition. */
6825
6826
400
          if (*tempptr != CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS)
6827
10
            {
6828
10
            *errorcodeptr = ERR28;
6829
10
            goto FAILED;
6830
10
            }
6831
400
          }
6832
6833
        /* For conditions that are assertions, check the syntax, and then exit
6834
        the switch. This will take control down to where bracketed groups,
6835
        including assertions, are processed. */
6836
6837
10.6k
        if (tempptr[1] == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK &&
6838
1.87k
              (tempptr[2] == CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN ||
6839
1.12k
               tempptr[2] == CHAR_EXCLAMATION_MARK ||
6840
387
                 (tempptr[2] == CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN &&
6841
355
                   (tempptr[3] == CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN ||
6842
293
                    tempptr[3] == CHAR_EXCLAMATION_MARK))))
6843
1.83k
          {
6844
1.83k
          cd->iscondassert = TRUE;
6845
1.83k
          break;
6846
1.83k
          }
6847
6848
        /* Other conditions use OP_CREF/OP_DNCREF/OP_RREF/OP_DNRREF, and all
6849
        need to skip at least 1+IMM2_SIZE bytes at the start of the group. */
6850
6851
8.80k
        code[1+LINK_SIZE] = OP_CREF;
6852
8.80k
        skipbytes = 1+IMM2_SIZE;
6853
8.80k
        refsign = -1;     /* => not a number */
6854
8.80k
        namelen = -1;     /* => not a name; must set to avoid warning */
6855
8.80k
        name = NULL;      /* Always set to avoid warning */
6856
8.80k
        recno = 0;        /* Always set to avoid warning */
6857
6858
        /* Check for a test for recursion in a named group. */
6859
6860
8.80k
        ptr++;
6861
8.80k
        if (*ptr == CHAR_R && ptr[1] == CHAR_AMPERSAND)
6862
237
          {
6863
237
          terminator = -1;
6864
237
          ptr += 2;
6865
237
          code[1+LINK_SIZE] = OP_RREF;    /* Change the type of test */
6866
237
          }
6867
6868
        /* Check for a test for a named group's having been set, using the Perl
6869
        syntax (?(<name>) or (?('name'), and also allow for the original PCRE
6870
        syntax of (?(name) or for (?(+n), (?(-n), and just (?(n). */
6871
6872
8.56k
        else if (*ptr == CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN)
6873
270
          {
6874
270
          terminator = CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN;
6875
270
          ptr++;
6876
270
          }
6877
8.29k
        else if (*ptr == CHAR_APOSTROPHE)
6878
390
          {
6879
390
          terminator = CHAR_APOSTROPHE;
6880
390
          ptr++;
6881
390
          }
6882
7.90k
        else
6883
7.90k
          {
6884
7.90k
          terminator = CHAR_NULL;
6885
7.90k
          if (*ptr == CHAR_MINUS || *ptr == CHAR_PLUS) refsign = *ptr++;
6886
6.56k
            else if (IS_DIGIT(*ptr)) refsign = 0;
6887
7.90k
          }
6888
6889
        /* Handle a number */
6890
6891
8.80k
        if (refsign >= 0)
6892
2.48k
          {
6893
5.85k
          while (IS_DIGIT(*ptr))
6894
3.38k
            {
6895
3.38k
            if (recno > INT_MAX / 10 - 1)  /* Integer overflow */
6896
22
              {
6897
232
              while (IS_DIGIT(*ptr)) ptr++;
6898
22
              *errorcodeptr = ERR61;
6899
22
              goto FAILED;
6900
22
              }
6901
3.36k
            recno = recno * 10 + (int)(*ptr - CHAR_0);
6902
3.36k
            ptr++;
6903
3.36k
            }
6904
2.48k
          }
6905
6906
        /* Otherwise we expect to read a name; anything else is an error. When
6907
        a name is one of a number of duplicates, a different opcode is used and
6908
        it needs more memory. Unfortunately we cannot tell whether a name is a
6909
        duplicate in the first pass, so we have to allow for more memory. */
6910
6911
6.31k
        else
6912
6.31k
          {
6913
6.31k
          if (IS_DIGIT(*ptr))
6914
2
            {
6915
2
            *errorcodeptr = ERR84;
6916
2
            goto FAILED;
6917
2
            }
6918
6.31k
          if (!MAX_255(*ptr) || (cd->ctypes[*ptr] & ctype_word) == 0)
6919
54
            {
6920
54
            *errorcodeptr = ERR28;   /* Assertion expected */
6921
54
            goto FAILED;
6922
54
            }
6923
6.26k
          name = ptr++;
6924
43.1k
          while (MAX_255(*ptr) && (cd->ctypes[*ptr] & ctype_word) != 0)
6925
36.9k
            {
6926
36.9k
            ptr++;
6927
36.9k
            }
6928
6.26k
          namelen = (int)(ptr - name);
6929
6.26k
          if (lengthptr != NULL) skipbytes += IMM2_SIZE;
6930
6.26k
          }
6931
6932
        /* Check the terminator */
6933
6934
8.72k
        if ((terminator > 0 && *ptr++ != (pcre_uchar)terminator) ||
6935
8.71k
            *ptr++ != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
6936
40
          {
6937
40
          ptr--;                  /* Error offset */
6938
40
          *errorcodeptr = ERR26;  /* Malformed number or name */
6939
40
          goto FAILED;
6940
40
          }
6941
6942
        /* Do no further checking in the pre-compile phase. */
6943
6944
8.68k
        if (lengthptr != NULL) break;
6945
6946
        /* In the real compile we do the work of looking for the actual
6947
        reference. If refsign is not negative, it means we have a number in
6948
        recno. */
6949
6950
4.26k
        if (refsign >= 0)
6951
1.20k
          {
6952
1.20k
          if (recno <= 0)
6953
7
            {
6954
7
            *errorcodeptr = ERR35;
6955
7
            goto FAILED;
6956
7
            }
6957
1.19k
          if (refsign != 0) recno = (refsign == CHAR_MINUS)?
6958
411
            cd->bracount - recno + 1 : recno + cd->bracount;
6959
1.19k
          if (recno <= 0 || recno > cd->final_bracount)
6960
71
            {
6961
71
            *errorcodeptr = ERR15;
6962
71
            goto FAILED;
6963
71
            }
6964
1.12k
          PUT2(code, 2+LINK_SIZE, recno);
6965
1.12k
          if (recno > cd->top_backref) cd->top_backref = recno;
6966
1.12k
          break;
6967
1.19k
          }
6968
6969
        /* Otherwise look for the name. */
6970
6971
3.06k
        slot = cd->name_table;
6972
17.9k
        for (i = 0; i < cd->names_found; i++)
6973
16.2k
          {
6974
16.2k
          if (STRNCMP_UC_UC(name, slot+IMM2_SIZE, namelen) == 0 &&
6975
1.60k
            slot[IMM2_SIZE+namelen] == 0) break;
6976
14.9k
          slot += cd->name_entry_size;
6977
14.9k
          }
6978
6979
        /* Found the named subpattern. If the name is duplicated, add one to
6980
        the opcode to change CREF/RREF into DNCREF/DNRREF and insert
6981
        appropriate data values. Otherwise, just insert the unique subpattern
6982
        number. */
6983
6984
3.06k
        if (i < cd->names_found)
6985
1.36k
          {
6986
1.36k
          int offset = i++;
6987
1.36k
          int count = 1;
6988
1.36k
          recno = GET2(slot, 0);   /* Number from first found */
6989
1.36k
          if (recno > cd->top_backref) cd->top_backref = recno;
6990
6.94k
          for (; i < cd->names_found; i++)
6991
6.19k
            {
6992
6.19k
            slot += cd->name_entry_size;
6993
6.19k
            if (STRNCMP_UC_UC(name, slot+IMM2_SIZE, namelen) != 0 ||
6994
5.94k
              (slot+IMM2_SIZE)[namelen] != 0) break;
6995
5.58k
            count++;
6996
5.58k
            }
6997
6998
1.36k
          if (count > 1)
6999
613
            {
7000
613
            PUT2(code, 2+LINK_SIZE, offset);
7001
613
            PUT2(code, 2+LINK_SIZE+IMM2_SIZE, count);
7002
613
            skipbytes += IMM2_SIZE;
7003
613
            code[1+LINK_SIZE]++;
7004
613
            }
7005
749
          else  /* Not a duplicated name */
7006
749
            {
7007
749
            PUT2(code, 2+LINK_SIZE, recno);
7008
749
            }
7009
1.36k
          }
7010
7011
        /* If terminator == CHAR_NULL it means that the name followed directly
7012
        after the opening parenthesis [e.g. (?(abc)...] and in this case there
7013
        are some further alternatives to try. For the cases where terminator !=
7014
        CHAR_NULL [things like (?(<name>... or (?('name')... or (?(R&name)... ]
7015
        we have now checked all the possibilities, so give an error. */
7016
7017
1.69k
        else if (terminator != CHAR_NULL)
7018
12
          {
7019
12
          *errorcodeptr = ERR15;
7020
12
          goto FAILED;
7021
12
          }
7022
7023
        /* Check for (?(R) for recursion. Allow digits after R to specify a
7024
        specific group number. */
7025
7026
1.68k
        else if (*name == CHAR_R)
7027
1.23k
          {
7028
1.23k
          recno = 0;
7029
16.1k
          for (i = 1; i < namelen; i++)
7030
14.9k
            {
7031
14.9k
            if (!IS_DIGIT(name[i]))
7032
11
              {
7033
11
              *errorcodeptr = ERR15;
7034
11
              goto FAILED;
7035
11
              }
7036
14.9k
            if (recno > INT_MAX / 10 - 1)   /* Integer overflow */
7037
8
              {
7038
8
              *errorcodeptr = ERR61;
7039
8
              goto FAILED;
7040
8
              }
7041
14.9k
            recno = recno * 10 + name[i] - CHAR_0;
7042
14.9k
            }
7043
1.21k
          if (recno == 0) recno = RREF_ANY;
7044
1.21k
          code[1+LINK_SIZE] = OP_RREF;      /* Change test type */
7045
1.21k
          PUT2(code, 2+LINK_SIZE, recno);
7046
1.21k
          }
7047
7048
        /* Similarly, check for the (?(DEFINE) "condition", which is always
7049
        false. */
7050
7051
455
        else if (namelen == 6 && STRNCMP_UC_C8(name, STRING_DEFINE, 6) == 0)
7052
324
          {
7053
324
          code[1+LINK_SIZE] = OP_DEF;
7054
324
          skipbytes = 1;
7055
324
          }
7056
7057
        /* Reference to an unidentified subpattern. */
7058
7059
131
        else
7060
131
          {
7061
131
          *errorcodeptr = ERR15;
7062
131
          goto FAILED;
7063
131
          }
7064
2.89k
        break;
7065
7066
7067
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
7068
4.54k
        case CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN:                 /* Positive lookahead */
7069
4.54k
        bravalue = OP_ASSERT;
7070
4.54k
        cd->assert_depth += 1;
7071
4.54k
        ptr++;
7072
4.54k
        break;
7073
7074
        /* Optimize (?!) to (*FAIL) unless it is quantified - which is a weird
7075
        thing to do, but Perl allows all assertions to be quantified, and when
7076
        they contain capturing parentheses there may be a potential use for
7077
        this feature. Not that that applies to a quantified (?!) but we allow
7078
        it for uniformity. */
7079
7080
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
7081
3.21k
        case CHAR_EXCLAMATION_MARK:            /* Negative lookahead */
7082
3.21k
        ptr++;
7083
3.21k
        if (*ptr == CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS && ptr[1] != CHAR_ASTERISK &&
7084
2.01k
             ptr[1] != CHAR_PLUS && ptr[1] != CHAR_QUESTION_MARK &&
7085
1.21k
            (ptr[1] != CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET || !is_counted_repeat(ptr+2)))
7086
960
          {
7087
960
          *code++ = OP_FAIL;
7088
960
          previous = NULL;
7089
960
          continue;
7090
960
          }
7091
2.25k
        bravalue = OP_ASSERT_NOT;
7092
2.25k
        cd->assert_depth += 1;
7093
2.25k
        break;
7094
7095
7096
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
7097
8.41k
        case CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN:              /* Lookbehind or named define */
7098
8.41k
        switch (ptr[1])
7099
8.41k
          {
7100
1.31k
          case CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN:               /* Positive lookbehind */
7101
1.31k
          bravalue = OP_ASSERTBACK;
7102
1.31k
          cd->assert_depth += 1;
7103
1.31k
          ptr += 2;
7104
1.31k
          break;
7105
7106
2.24k
          case CHAR_EXCLAMATION_MARK:          /* Negative lookbehind */
7107
2.24k
          bravalue = OP_ASSERTBACK_NOT;
7108
2.24k
          cd->assert_depth += 1;
7109
2.24k
          ptr += 2;
7110
2.24k
          break;
7111
7112
4.85k
          default:                /* Could be name define, else bad */
7113
4.85k
          if (MAX_255(ptr[1]) && (cd->ctypes[ptr[1]] & ctype_word) != 0)
7114
4.85k
            goto DEFINE_NAME;
7115
1
          ptr++;                  /* Correct offset for error */
7116
1
          *errorcodeptr = ERR24;
7117
1
          goto FAILED;
7118
8.41k
          }
7119
3.55k
        break;
7120
7121
7122
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
7123
3.55k
        case CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN:           /* One-time brackets */
7124
3.38k
        bravalue = OP_ONCE;
7125
3.38k
        ptr++;
7126
3.38k
        break;
7127
7128
7129
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
7130
1.63k
        case CHAR_C:                 /* Callout - may be followed by digits; */
7131
1.63k
        previous_callout = code;     /* Save for later completion */
7132
1.63k
        after_manual_callout = 1;    /* Skip one item before completing */
7133
1.63k
        *code++ = OP_CALLOUT;
7134
1.63k
          {
7135
1.63k
          int n = 0;
7136
1.63k
          ptr++;
7137
1.83k
          while(IS_DIGIT(*ptr))
7138
201
            {
7139
201
            n = n * 10 + *ptr++ - CHAR_0;
7140
201
            if (n > 255)
7141
1
              {
7142
1
              *errorcodeptr = ERR38;
7143
1
              goto FAILED;
7144
1
              }
7145
201
            }
7146
1.63k
          if (*ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
7147
13
            {
7148
13
            *errorcodeptr = ERR39;
7149
13
            goto FAILED;
7150
13
            }
7151
1.61k
          *code++ = n;
7152
1.61k
          PUT(code, 0, (int)(ptr - cd->start_pattern + 1)); /* Pattern offset */
7153
1.61k
          PUT(code, LINK_SIZE, 0);                          /* Default length */
7154
1.61k
          code += 2 * LINK_SIZE;
7155
1.61k
          }
7156
1.61k
        previous = NULL;
7157
1.61k
        continue;
7158
7159
7160
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
7161
621
        case CHAR_P:              /* Python-style named subpattern handling */
7162
621
        if (*(++ptr) == CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN ||
7163
417
            *ptr == CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN)  /* Reference or recursion */
7164
396
          {
7165
396
          is_recurse = *ptr == CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN;
7166
396
          terminator = CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS;
7167
396
          goto NAMED_REF_OR_RECURSE;
7168
396
          }
7169
225
        else if (*ptr != CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN)  /* Test for Python-style defn */
7170
12
          {
7171
12
          *errorcodeptr = ERR41;
7172
12
          goto FAILED;
7173
12
          }
7174
        /* Fall through to handle (?P< as (?< is handled */
7175
7176
7177
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
7178
5.06k
        DEFINE_NAME:    /* Come here from (?< handling */
7179
111k
        case CHAR_APOSTROPHE:
7180
111k
        terminator = (*ptr == CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN)?
7181
106k
          CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN : CHAR_APOSTROPHE;
7182
111k
        name = ++ptr;
7183
111k
        if (IS_DIGIT(*ptr))
7184
1
          {
7185
1
          *errorcodeptr = ERR84;   /* Group name must start with non-digit */
7186
1
          goto FAILED;
7187
1
          }
7188
1.27M
        while (MAX_255(*ptr) && (cd->ctypes[*ptr] & ctype_word) != 0) ptr++;
7189
111k
        namelen = (int)(ptr - name);
7190
7191
        /* In the pre-compile phase, do a syntax check, remember the longest
7192
        name, and then remember the group in a vector, expanding it if
7193
        necessary. Duplicates for the same number are skipped; other duplicates
7194
        are checked for validity. In the actual compile, there is nothing to
7195
        do. */
7196
7197
111k
        if (lengthptr != NULL)
7198
86.6k
          {
7199
86.6k
          named_group *ng;
7200
86.6k
          pcre_uint32 number = cd->bracount + 1;
7201
7202
86.6k
          if (*ptr != (pcre_uchar)terminator)
7203
25
            {
7204
25
            *errorcodeptr = ERR42;
7205
25
            goto FAILED;
7206
25
            }
7207
7208
86.5k
          if (cd->names_found >= MAX_NAME_COUNT)
7209
1
            {
7210
1
            *errorcodeptr = ERR49;
7211
1
            goto FAILED;
7212
1
            }
7213
7214
86.5k
          if (namelen + IMM2_SIZE + 1 > cd->name_entry_size)
7215
1.18k
            {
7216
1.18k
            cd->name_entry_size = namelen + IMM2_SIZE + 1;
7217
1.18k
            if (namelen > MAX_NAME_SIZE)
7218
28
              {
7219
28
              *errorcodeptr = ERR48;
7220
28
              goto FAILED;
7221
28
              }
7222
1.18k
            }
7223
7224
          /* Scan the list to check for duplicates. For duplicate names, if the
7225
          number is the same, break the loop, which causes the name to be
7226
          discarded; otherwise, if DUPNAMES is not set, give an error.
7227
          If it is set, allow the name with a different number, but continue
7228
          scanning in case this is a duplicate with the same number. For
7229
          non-duplicate names, give an error if the number is duplicated. */
7230
7231
86.5k
          ng = cd->named_groups;
7232
248M
          for (i = 0; i < cd->names_found; i++, ng++)
7233
248M
            {
7234
248M
            if (namelen == ng->length &&
7235
244M
                STRNCMP_UC_UC(name, ng->name, namelen) == 0)
7236
244M
              {
7237
244M
              if (ng->number == number) break;
7238
244M
              if ((options & PCRE_DUPNAMES) == 0)
7239
8
                {
7240
8
                *errorcodeptr = ERR43;
7241
8
                goto FAILED;
7242
8
                }
7243
244M
              cd->dupnames = TRUE;  /* Duplicate names exist */
7244
244M
              }
7245
3.61M
            else if (ng->number == number)
7246
2
              {
7247
2
              *errorcodeptr = ERR65;
7248
2
              goto FAILED;
7249
2
              }
7250
248M
            }
7251
7252
86.5k
          if (i >= cd->names_found)     /* Not a duplicate with same number */
7253
86.4k
            {
7254
            /* Increase the list size if necessary */
7255
7256
86.4k
            if (cd->names_found >= cd->named_group_list_size)
7257
277
              {
7258
277
              int newsize = cd->named_group_list_size * 2;
7259
277
              named_group *newspace = (PUBL(malloc))
7260
277
                (newsize * sizeof(named_group));
7261
7262
277
              if (newspace == NULL)
7263
0
                {
7264
0
                *errorcodeptr = ERR21;
7265
0
                goto FAILED;
7266
0
                }
7267
7268
277
              memcpy(newspace, cd->named_groups,
7269
277
                cd->named_group_list_size * sizeof(named_group));
7270
277
              if (cd->named_group_list_size > NAMED_GROUP_LIST_SIZE)
7271
203
                (PUBL(free))((void *)cd->named_groups);
7272
277
              cd->named_groups = newspace;
7273
277
              cd->named_group_list_size = newsize;
7274
277
              }
7275
7276
86.4k
            cd->named_groups[cd->names_found].name = name;
7277
86.4k
            cd->named_groups[cd->names_found].length = namelen;
7278
86.4k
            cd->named_groups[cd->names_found].number = number;
7279
86.4k
            cd->names_found++;
7280
86.4k
            }
7281
86.5k
          }
7282
7283
111k
        ptr++;                    /* Move past > or ' in both passes. */
7284
111k
        goto NUMBERED_GROUP;
7285
7286
7287
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
7288
407
        case CHAR_AMPERSAND:            /* Perl recursion/subroutine syntax */
7289
407
        terminator = CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS;
7290
407
        is_recurse = TRUE;
7291
        /* Fall through */
7292
7293
        /* We come here from the Python syntax above that handles both
7294
        references (?P=name) and recursion (?P>name), as well as falling
7295
        through from the Perl recursion syntax (?&name). We also come here from
7296
        the Perl \k<name> or \k'name' back reference syntax and the \k{name}
7297
        .NET syntax, and the Oniguruma \g<...> and \g'...' subroutine syntax. */
7298
7299
5.92k
        NAMED_REF_OR_RECURSE:
7300
5.92k
        name = ++ptr;
7301
5.92k
        if (IS_DIGIT(*ptr))
7302
3
          {
7303
3
          *errorcodeptr = ERR84;   /* Group name must start with non-digit */
7304
3
          goto FAILED;
7305
3
          }
7306
16.6k
        while (MAX_255(*ptr) && (cd->ctypes[*ptr] & ctype_word) != 0) ptr++;
7307
5.91k
        namelen = (int)(ptr - name);
7308
7309
        /* In the pre-compile phase, do a syntax check. We used to just set
7310
        a dummy reference number, because it was not used in the first pass.
7311
        However, with the change of recursive back references to be atomic,
7312
        we have to look for the number so that this state can be identified, as
7313
        otherwise the incorrect length is computed. If it's not a backwards
7314
        reference, the dummy number will do. */
7315
7316
5.91k
        if (lengthptr != NULL)
7317
3.73k
          {
7318
3.73k
          named_group *ng;
7319
3.73k
          recno = 0;
7320
7321
3.73k
          if (namelen == 0)
7322
27
            {
7323
27
            *errorcodeptr = ERR62;
7324
27
            goto FAILED;
7325
27
            }
7326
3.71k
          if (*ptr != (pcre_uchar)terminator)
7327
11
            {
7328
11
            *errorcodeptr = ERR42;
7329
11
            goto FAILED;
7330
11
            }
7331
3.70k
          if (namelen > MAX_NAME_SIZE)
7332
1
            {
7333
1
            *errorcodeptr = ERR48;
7334
1
            goto FAILED;
7335
1
            }
7336
7337
          /* Count named back references. */
7338
7339
3.70k
          if (!is_recurse) cd->namedrefcount++;
7340
7341
          /* We have to allow for a named reference to a duplicated name (this
7342
          cannot be determined until the second pass). This needs an extra
7343
          16-bit data item. */
7344
7345
3.70k
          *lengthptr += IMM2_SIZE;
7346
7347
          /* If this is a forward reference and we are within a (?|...) group,
7348
          the reference may end up as the number of a group which we are
7349
          currently inside, that is, it could be a recursive reference. In the
7350
          real compile this will be picked up and the reference wrapped with
7351
          OP_ONCE to make it atomic, so we must space in case this occurs. */
7352
7353
          /* In fact, this can happen for a non-forward reference because
7354
          another group with the same number might be created later. This
7355
          issue is fixed "properly" in PCRE2. As PCRE1 is now in maintenance
7356
          only mode, we finesse the bug by allowing more memory always. */
7357
7358
3.70k
          *lengthptr += 4 + 4*LINK_SIZE;
7359
7360
          /* It is even worse than that. The current reference may be to an
7361
          existing named group with a different number (so apparently not
7362
          recursive) but which later on is also attached to a group with the
7363
          current number. This can only happen if $(| has been previous
7364
          encountered. In that case, we allow yet more memory, just in case.
7365
          (Again, this is fixed "properly" in PCRE2. */
7366
7367
3.70k
          if (cd->dupgroups) *lengthptr += 4 + 4*LINK_SIZE;
7368
7369
          /* Otherwise, check for recursion here. The name table does not exist
7370
          in the first pass; instead we must scan the list of names encountered
7371
          so far in order to get the number. If the name is not found, leave
7372
          the value of recno as 0 for a forward reference. */
7373
7374
          /* This patch (removing "else") fixes a problem when a reference is
7375
          to multiple identically named nested groups from within the nest.
7376
          Once again, it is not the "proper" fix, and it results in an
7377
          over-allocation of memory. */
7378
7379
          /* else */
7380
3.70k
            {
7381
3.70k
            ng = cd->named_groups;
7382
393k
            for (i = 0; i < cd->names_found; i++, ng++)
7383
390k
              {
7384
390k
              if (namelen == ng->length &&
7385
95.1k
                  STRNCMP_UC_UC(name, ng->name, namelen) == 0)
7386
80.3k
                {
7387
80.3k
                open_capitem *oc;
7388
80.3k
                recno = ng->number;
7389
80.3k
                if (is_recurse) break;
7390
843k
                for (oc = cd->open_caps; oc != NULL; oc = oc->next)
7391
766k
                  {
7392
766k
                  if (oc->number == recno)
7393
2.74k
                    {
7394
2.74k
                    oc->flag = TRUE;
7395
2.74k
                    break;
7396
2.74k
                    }
7397
766k
                  }
7398
80.0k
                }
7399
390k
              }
7400
3.70k
            }
7401
3.70k
          }
7402
7403
        /* In the real compile, search the name table. We check the name
7404
        first, and then check that we have reached the end of the name in the
7405
        table. That way, if the name is longer than any in the table, the
7406
        comparison will fail without reading beyond the table entry. */
7407
7408
2.17k
        else
7409
2.17k
          {
7410
2.17k
          slot = cd->name_table;
7411
154k
          for (i = 0; i < cd->names_found; i++)
7412
153k
            {
7413
153k
            if (STRNCMP_UC_UC(name, slot+IMM2_SIZE, namelen) == 0 &&
7414
2.28k
                slot[IMM2_SIZE+namelen] == 0)
7415
2.01k
              break;
7416
151k
            slot += cd->name_entry_size;
7417
151k
            }
7418
7419
2.17k
          if (i < cd->names_found)
7420
2.01k
            {
7421
2.01k
            recno = GET2(slot, 0);
7422
2.01k
            }
7423
164
          else
7424
164
            {
7425
164
            *errorcodeptr = ERR15;
7426
164
            goto FAILED;
7427
164
            }
7428
2.17k
          }
7429
7430
        /* In both phases, for recursions, we can now go to the code than
7431
        handles numerical recursion. */
7432
7433
5.71k
        if (is_recurse) goto HANDLE_RECURSION;
7434
7435
        /* In the second pass we must see if the name is duplicated. If so, we
7436
        generate a different opcode. */
7437
7438
4.78k
        if (lengthptr == NULL && cd->dupnames)
7439
1.57k
          {
7440
1.57k
          int count = 1;
7441
1.57k
          unsigned int index = i;
7442
1.57k
          pcre_uchar *cslot = slot + cd->name_entry_size;
7443
7444
75.1k
          for (i++; i < cd->names_found; i++)
7445
74.0k
            {
7446
74.0k
            if (STRCMP_UC_UC(slot + IMM2_SIZE, cslot + IMM2_SIZE) != 0) break;
7447
73.5k
            count++;
7448
73.5k
            cslot += cd->name_entry_size;
7449
73.5k
            }
7450
7451
1.57k
          if (count > 1)
7452
1.28k
            {
7453
1.28k
            if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
7454
1.28k
            previous = code;
7455
1.28k
            item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;
7456
1.28k
            *code++ = ((options & PCRE_CASELESS) != 0)? OP_DNREFI : OP_DNREF;
7457
1.28k
            PUT2INC(code, 0, index);
7458
1.28k
            PUT2INC(code, 0, count);
7459
7460
            /* Process each potentially referenced group. */
7461
7462
76.1k
            for (; slot < cslot; slot += cd->name_entry_size)
7463
74.8k
              {
7464
74.8k
              open_capitem *oc;
7465
74.8k
              recno = GET2(slot, 0);
7466
74.8k
              cd->backref_map |= (recno < 32)? (1U << recno) : 1;
7467
74.8k
              if (recno > cd->top_backref) cd->top_backref = recno;
7468
7469
              /* Check to see if this back reference is recursive, that it, it
7470
              is inside the group that it references. A flag is set so that the
7471
              group can be made atomic. */
7472
7473
977k
              for (oc = cd->open_caps; oc != NULL; oc = oc->next)
7474
904k
                {
7475
904k
                if (oc->number == recno)
7476
1.95k
                  {
7477
1.95k
                  oc->flag = TRUE;
7478
1.95k
                  break;
7479
1.95k
                  }
7480
904k
                }
7481
74.8k
              }
7482
7483
1.28k
            continue;  /* End of back ref handling */
7484
1.28k
            }
7485
1.57k
          }
7486
7487
        /* First pass, or a non-duplicated name. */
7488
7489
3.50k
        goto HANDLE_REFERENCE;
7490
7491
7492
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
7493
3.50k
        case CHAR_R:              /* Recursion, same as (?0) */
7494
998
        recno = 0;
7495
998
        if (*(++ptr) != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
7496
2
          {
7497
2
          *errorcodeptr = ERR29;
7498
2
          goto FAILED;
7499
2
          }
7500
996
        goto HANDLE_RECURSION;
7501
7502
7503
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
7504
1.12k
        case CHAR_MINUS: case CHAR_PLUS:  /* Recursion or subroutine */
7505
8.31k
        case CHAR_0: case CHAR_1: case CHAR_2: case CHAR_3: case CHAR_4:
7506
10.7k
        case CHAR_5: case CHAR_6: case CHAR_7: case CHAR_8: case CHAR_9:
7507
10.7k
          {
7508
10.7k
          const pcre_uchar *called;
7509
10.7k
          terminator = CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS;
7510
7511
          /* Come here from the \g<...> and \g'...' code (Oniguruma
7512
          compatibility). However, the syntax has been checked to ensure that
7513
          the ... are a (signed) number, so that neither ERR63 nor ERR29 will
7514
          be called on this path, nor with the jump to OTHER_CHAR_AFTER_QUERY
7515
          ever be taken. */
7516
7517
12.1k
          HANDLE_NUMERICAL_RECURSION:
7518
7519
12.1k
          if ((refsign = *ptr) == CHAR_PLUS)
7520
1.41k
            {
7521
1.41k
            ptr++;
7522
1.41k
            if (!IS_DIGIT(*ptr))
7523
13
              {
7524
13
              *errorcodeptr = ERR63;
7525
13
              goto FAILED;
7526
13
              }
7527
1.41k
            }
7528
10.7k
          else if (refsign == CHAR_MINUS)
7529
746
            {
7530
746
            if (!IS_DIGIT(ptr[1]))
7531
403
              goto OTHER_CHAR_AFTER_QUERY;
7532
343
            ptr++;
7533
343
            }
7534
7535
11.7k
          recno = 0;
7536
25.6k
          while(IS_DIGIT(*ptr))
7537
13.9k
            {
7538
13.9k
            if (recno > INT_MAX / 10 - 1) /* Integer overflow */
7539
9
              {
7540
225
              while (IS_DIGIT(*ptr)) ptr++;
7541
9
              *errorcodeptr = ERR61;
7542
9
              goto FAILED;
7543
9
              }
7544
13.8k
            recno = recno * 10 + *ptr++ - CHAR_0;
7545
13.8k
            }
7546
7547
11.7k
          if (*ptr != (pcre_uchar)terminator)
7548
23
            {
7549
23
            *errorcodeptr = ERR29;
7550
23
            goto FAILED;
7551
23
            }
7552
7553
11.6k
          if (refsign == CHAR_MINUS)
7554
339
            {
7555
339
            if (recno == 0)
7556
1
              {
7557
1
              *errorcodeptr = ERR58;
7558
1
              goto FAILED;
7559
1
              }
7560
338
            recno = cd->bracount - recno + 1;
7561
338
            if (recno <= 0)
7562
42
              {
7563
42
              *errorcodeptr = ERR15;
7564
42
              goto FAILED;
7565
42
              }
7566
338
            }
7567
11.3k
          else if (refsign == CHAR_PLUS)
7568
1.40k
            {
7569
1.40k
            if (recno == 0)
7570
1
              {
7571
1
              *errorcodeptr = ERR58;
7572
1
              goto FAILED;
7573
1
              }
7574
1.40k
            recno += cd->bracount;
7575
1.40k
            }
7576
7577
          /* Come here from code above that handles a named recursion */
7578
7579
13.5k
          HANDLE_RECURSION:
7580
7581
13.5k
          previous = code;
7582
13.5k
          item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;
7583
13.5k
          called = cd->start_code;
7584
7585
          /* When we are actually compiling, find the bracket that is being
7586
          referenced. Temporarily end the regex in case it doesn't exist before
7587
          this point. If we end up with a forward reference, first check that
7588
          the bracket does occur later so we can give the error (and position)
7589
          now. Then remember this forward reference in the workspace so it can
7590
          be filled in at the end. */
7591
7592
13.5k
          if (lengthptr == NULL)
7593
6.07k
            {
7594
6.07k
            *code = OP_END;
7595
6.07k
            if (recno != 0)
7596
5.17k
              called = PRIV(find_bracket)(cd->start_code, utf, recno);
7597
7598
            /* Forward reference */
7599
7600
6.07k
            if (called == NULL)
7601
1.85k
              {
7602
1.85k
              if (recno > cd->final_bracount)
7603
297
                {
7604
297
                *errorcodeptr = ERR15;
7605
297
                goto FAILED;
7606
297
                }
7607
7608
              /* Fudge the value of "called" so that when it is inserted as an
7609
              offset below, what it actually inserted is the reference number
7610
              of the group. Then remember the forward reference. */
7611
7612
1.56k
              called = cd->start_code + recno;
7613
1.56k
              if (cd->hwm >= cd->start_workspace + cd->workspace_size -
7614
1.56k
                  WORK_SIZE_SAFETY_MARGIN)
7615
0
                {
7616
0
                *errorcodeptr = expand_workspace(cd);
7617
0
                if (*errorcodeptr != 0) goto FAILED;
7618
0
                }
7619
1.56k
              PUTINC(cd->hwm, 0, (int)(code + 1 - cd->start_code));
7620
1.56k
              }
7621
7622
            /* If not a forward reference, and the subpattern is still open,
7623
            this is a recursive call. We check to see if this is a left
7624
            recursion that could loop for ever, and diagnose that case. We
7625
            must not, however, do this check if we are in a conditional
7626
            subpattern because the condition might be testing for recursion in
7627
            a pattern such as /(?(R)a+|(?R)b)/, which is perfectly valid.
7628
            Forever loops are also detected at runtime, so those that occur in
7629
            conditional subpatterns will be picked up then. */
7630
7631
4.21k
            else if (GET(called, 1) == 0 && cond_depth <= 0 &&
7632
1.51k
                     could_be_empty(called, code, bcptr, utf, cd))
7633
29
              {
7634
29
              *errorcodeptr = ERR40;
7635
29
              goto FAILED;
7636
29
              }
7637
6.07k
            }
7638
7639
          /* Insert the recursion/subroutine item. It does not have a set first
7640
          character (relevant if it is repeated, because it will then be
7641
          wrapped with ONCE brackets). */
7642
7643
13.2k
          *code = OP_RECURSE;
7644
13.2k
          PUT(code, 1, (int)(called - cd->start_code));
7645
13.2k
          code += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
7646
13.2k
          groupsetfirstchar = FALSE;
7647
13.2k
          }
7648
7649
        /* Can't determine a first byte now */
7650
7651
13.2k
        if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
7652
13.2k
        zerofirstchar = firstchar;
7653
13.2k
        zerofirstcharflags = firstcharflags;
7654
13.2k
        continue;
7655
7656
7657
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
7658
6.04k
        default:              /* Other characters: check option setting */
7659
6.44k
        OTHER_CHAR_AFTER_QUERY:
7660
6.44k
        set = unset = 0;
7661
6.44k
        optset = &set;
7662
7663
14.3k
        while (*ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS && *ptr != CHAR_COLON)
7664
7.91k
          {
7665
7.91k
          switch (*ptr++)
7666
7.91k
            {
7667
592
            case CHAR_MINUS: optset = &unset; break;
7668
7669
3.72k
            case CHAR_J:    /* Record that it changed in the external options */
7670
3.72k
            *optset |= PCRE_DUPNAMES;
7671
3.72k
            cd->external_flags |= PCRE_JCHANGED;
7672
3.72k
            break;
7673
7674
1.49k
            case CHAR_i: *optset |= PCRE_CASELESS; break;
7675
443
            case CHAR_m: *optset |= PCRE_MULTILINE; break;
7676
373
            case CHAR_s: *optset |= PCRE_DOTALL; break;
7677
611
            case CHAR_x: *optset |= PCRE_EXTENDED; break;
7678
417
            case CHAR_U: *optset |= PCRE_UNGREEDY; break;
7679
197
            case CHAR_X: *optset |= PCRE_EXTRA; break;
7680
7681
50
            default:  *errorcodeptr = ERR12;
7682
50
                      ptr--;    /* Correct the offset */
7683
50
                      goto FAILED;
7684
7.91k
            }
7685
7.91k
          }
7686
7687
        /* Set up the changed option bits, but don't change anything yet. */
7688
7689
6.39k
        newoptions = (options | set) & (~unset);
7690
7691
        /* If the options ended with ')' this is not the start of a nested
7692
        group with option changes, so the options change at this level.
7693
        If we are not at the pattern start, reset the greedy defaults and the
7694
        case value for firstchar and reqchar. */
7695
7696
6.39k
        if (*ptr == CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
7697
2.55k
          {
7698
2.55k
          greedy_default = ((newoptions & PCRE_UNGREEDY) != 0);
7699
2.55k
          greedy_non_default = greedy_default ^ 1;
7700
2.55k
          req_caseopt = ((newoptions & PCRE_CASELESS) != 0)? REQ_CASELESS:0;
7701
7702
          /* Change options at this level, and pass them back for use
7703
          in subsequent branches. */
7704
7705
2.55k
          *optionsptr = options = newoptions;
7706
2.55k
          previous = NULL;       /* This item can't be repeated */
7707
2.55k
          continue;              /* It is complete */
7708
2.55k
          }
7709
7710
        /* If the options ended with ':' we are heading into a nested group
7711
        with possible change of options. Such groups are non-capturing and are
7712
        not assertions of any kind. All we need to do is skip over the ':';
7713
        the newoptions value is handled below. */
7714
7715
3.84k
        bravalue = OP_BRA;
7716
3.84k
        ptr++;
7717
159k
        }     /* End of switch for character following (? */
7718
159k
      }       /* End of (? handling */
7719
7720
    /* Opening parenthesis not followed by '*' or '?'. If PCRE_NO_AUTO_CAPTURE
7721
    is set, all unadorned brackets become non-capturing and behave like (?:...)
7722
    brackets. */
7723
7724
514k
    else if ((options & PCRE_NO_AUTO_CAPTURE) != 0)
7725
0
      {
7726
0
      bravalue = OP_BRA;
7727
0
      }
7728
7729
    /* Else we have a capturing group. */
7730
7731
514k
    else
7732
514k
      {
7733
625k
      NUMBERED_GROUP:
7734
625k
      cd->bracount += 1;
7735
625k
      PUT2(code, 1+LINK_SIZE, cd->bracount);
7736
625k
      skipbytes = IMM2_SIZE;
7737
625k
      }
7738
7739
    /* Process nested bracketed regex. First check for parentheses nested too
7740
    deeply. */
7741
7742
655k
    if ((cd->parens_depth += 1) > PARENS_NEST_LIMIT)
7743
3
      {
7744
3
      *errorcodeptr = ERR82;
7745
3
      goto FAILED;
7746
3
      }
7747
7748
    /* All assertions used not to be repeatable, but this was changed for Perl
7749
    compatibility. All kinds can now be repeated except for assertions that are
7750
    conditions (Perl also forbids these to be repeated). We copy code into a
7751
    non-register variable (tempcode) in order to be able to pass its address
7752
    because some compilers complain otherwise. At the start of a conditional
7753
    group whose condition is an assertion, cd->iscondassert is set. We unset it
7754
    here so as to allow assertions later in the group to be quantified. */
7755
7756
655k
    if (bravalue >= OP_ASSERT && bravalue <= OP_ASSERTBACK_NOT &&
7757
10.3k
        cd->iscondassert)
7758
1.60k
      {
7759
1.60k
      previous = NULL;
7760
1.60k
      cd->iscondassert = FALSE;
7761
1.60k
      }
7762
654k
    else
7763
654k
      {
7764
654k
      previous = code;
7765
654k
      item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;
7766
654k
      }
7767
7768
655k
    *code = bravalue;
7769
655k
    tempcode = code;
7770
655k
    tempreqvary = cd->req_varyopt;        /* Save value before bracket */
7771
655k
    tempbracount = cd->bracount;          /* Save value before bracket */
7772
655k
    length_prevgroup = 0;                 /* Initialize for pre-compile phase */
7773
7774
655k
    if (!compile_regex(
7775
655k
         newoptions,                      /* The complete new option state */
7776
655k
         &tempcode,                       /* Where to put code (updated) */
7777
655k
         &ptr,                            /* Input pointer (updated) */
7778
655k
         errorcodeptr,                    /* Where to put an error message */
7779
655k
         (bravalue == OP_ASSERTBACK ||
7780
654k
          bravalue == OP_ASSERTBACK_NOT), /* TRUE if back assert */
7781
655k
         reset_bracount,                  /* True if (?| group */
7782
655k
         skipbytes,                       /* Skip over bracket number */
7783
655k
         cond_depth +
7784
655k
           ((bravalue == OP_COND)?1:0),   /* Depth of condition subpatterns */
7785
655k
         &subfirstchar,                   /* For possible first char */
7786
655k
         &subfirstcharflags,
7787
655k
         &subreqchar,                     /* For possible last char */
7788
655k
         &subreqcharflags,
7789
655k
         bcptr,                           /* Current branch chain */
7790
655k
         cd,                              /* Tables block */
7791
655k
         (lengthptr == NULL)? NULL :      /* Actual compile phase */
7792
655k
           &length_prevgroup              /* Pre-compile phase */
7793
655k
         ))
7794
10.0k
      goto FAILED;
7795
7796
645k
    cd->parens_depth -= 1;
7797
7798
    /* If this was an atomic group and there are no capturing groups within it,
7799
    generate OP_ONCE_NC instead of OP_ONCE. */
7800
7801
645k
    if (bravalue == OP_ONCE && cd->bracount <= tempbracount)
7802
1.75k
      *code = OP_ONCE_NC;
7803
7804
645k
    if (bravalue >= OP_ASSERT && bravalue <= OP_ASSERTBACK_NOT)
7805
10.1k
      cd->assert_depth -= 1;
7806
7807
    /* At the end of compiling, code is still pointing to the start of the
7808
    group, while tempcode has been updated to point past the end of the group.
7809
    The pattern pointer (ptr) is on the bracket.
7810
7811
    If this is a conditional bracket, check that there are no more than
7812
    two branches in the group, or just one if it's a DEFINE group. We do this
7813
    in the real compile phase, not in the pre-pass, where the whole group may
7814
    not be available. */
7815
7816
645k
    if (bravalue == OP_COND && lengthptr == NULL)
7817
4.91k
      {
7818
4.91k
      pcre_uchar *tc = code;
7819
4.91k
      int condcount = 0;
7820
7821
32.4k
      do {
7822
32.4k
         condcount++;
7823
32.4k
         tc += GET(tc,1);
7824
32.4k
         }
7825
32.4k
      while (*tc != OP_KET);
7826
7827
      /* A DEFINE group is never obeyed inline (the "condition" is always
7828
      false). It must have only one branch. */
7829
7830
4.91k
      if (code[LINK_SIZE+1] == OP_DEF)
7831
324
        {
7832
324
        if (condcount > 1)
7833
9
          {
7834
9
          *errorcodeptr = ERR54;
7835
9
          goto FAILED;
7836
9
          }
7837
315
        bravalue = OP_DEF;   /* Just a flag to suppress char handling below */
7838
315
        }
7839
7840
      /* A "normal" conditional group. If there is just one branch, we must not
7841
      make use of its firstchar or reqchar, because this is equivalent to an
7842
      empty second branch. */
7843
7844
4.59k
      else
7845
4.59k
        {
7846
4.59k
        if (condcount > 2)
7847
12
          {
7848
12
          *errorcodeptr = ERR27;
7849
12
          goto FAILED;
7850
12
          }
7851
4.57k
        if (condcount == 1) subfirstcharflags = subreqcharflags = REQ_NONE;
7852
4.57k
        }
7853
4.91k
      }
7854
7855
    /* Error if hit end of pattern */
7856
7857
645k
    if (*ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
7858
607
      {
7859
607
      *errorcodeptr = ERR14;
7860
607
      goto FAILED;
7861
607
      }
7862
7863
    /* In the pre-compile phase, update the length by the length of the group,
7864
    less the brackets at either end. Then reduce the compiled code to just a
7865
    set of non-capturing brackets so that it doesn't use much memory if it is
7866
    duplicated by a quantifier.*/
7867
7868
645k
    if (lengthptr != NULL)
7869
553k
      {
7870
553k
      if (OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < length_prevgroup - 2 - 2*LINK_SIZE)
7871
1
        {
7872
1
        *errorcodeptr = ERR20;
7873
1
        goto FAILED;
7874
1
        }
7875
553k
      *lengthptr += length_prevgroup - 2 - 2*LINK_SIZE;
7876
553k
      code++;   /* This already contains bravalue */
7877
553k
      PUTINC(code, 0, 1 + LINK_SIZE);
7878
553k
      *code++ = OP_KET;
7879
553k
      PUTINC(code, 0, 1 + LINK_SIZE);
7880
553k
      break;    /* No need to waste time with special character handling */
7881
553k
      }
7882
7883
    /* Otherwise update the main code pointer to the end of the group. */
7884
7885
91.3k
    code = tempcode;
7886
7887
    /* For a DEFINE group, required and first character settings are not
7888
    relevant. */
7889
7890
91.3k
    if (bravalue == OP_DEF) break;
7891
7892
    /* Handle updating of the required and first characters for other types of
7893
    group. Update for normal brackets of all kinds, and conditions with two
7894
    branches (see code above). If the bracket is followed by a quantifier with
7895
    zero repeat, we have to back off. Hence the definition of zeroreqchar and
7896
    zerofirstchar outside the main loop so that they can be accessed for the
7897
    back off. */
7898
7899
90.9k
    zeroreqchar = reqchar;
7900
90.9k
    zeroreqcharflags = reqcharflags;
7901
90.9k
    zerofirstchar = firstchar;
7902
90.9k
    zerofirstcharflags = firstcharflags;
7903
90.9k
    groupsetfirstchar = FALSE;
7904
7905
90.9k
    if (bravalue >= OP_ONCE)
7906
86.1k
      {
7907
      /* If we have not yet set a firstchar in this branch, take it from the
7908
      subpattern, remembering that it was set here so that a repeat of more
7909
      than one can replicate it as reqchar if necessary. If the subpattern has
7910
      no firstchar, set "none" for the whole branch. In both cases, a zero
7911
      repeat forces firstchar to "none". */
7912
7913
86.1k
      if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET)
7914
33.3k
        {
7915
33.3k
        if (subfirstcharflags >= 0)
7916
19.0k
          {
7917
19.0k
          firstchar = subfirstchar;
7918
19.0k
          firstcharflags = subfirstcharflags;
7919
19.0k
          groupsetfirstchar = TRUE;
7920
19.0k
          }
7921
14.3k
        else firstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
7922
33.3k
        zerofirstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
7923
33.3k
        }
7924
7925
      /* If firstchar was previously set, convert the subpattern's firstchar
7926
      into reqchar if there wasn't one, using the vary flag that was in
7927
      existence beforehand. */
7928
7929
52.8k
      else if (subfirstcharflags >= 0 && subreqcharflags < 0)
7930
3.03k
        {
7931
3.03k
        subreqchar = subfirstchar;
7932
3.03k
        subreqcharflags = subfirstcharflags | tempreqvary;
7933
3.03k
        }
7934
7935
      /* If the subpattern set a required byte (or set a first byte that isn't
7936
      really the first byte - see above), set it. */
7937
7938
86.1k
      if (subreqcharflags >= 0)
7939
32.2k
        {
7940
32.2k
        reqchar = subreqchar;
7941
32.2k
        reqcharflags = subreqcharflags;
7942
32.2k
        }
7943
86.1k
      }
7944
7945
    /* For a forward assertion, we take the reqchar, if set, provided that the
7946
    group has also set a first char. This can be helpful if the pattern that
7947
    follows the assertion doesn't set a different char. For example, it's
7948
    useful for /(?=abcde).+/. We can't set firstchar for an assertion, however
7949
    because it leads to incorrect effect for patterns such as /(?=a)a.+/ when
7950
    the "real" "a" would then become a reqchar instead of a firstchar. This is
7951
    overcome by a scan at the end if there's no firstchar, looking for an
7952
    asserted first char. */
7953
7954
4.85k
    else if (bravalue == OP_ASSERT && subreqcharflags >= 0 &&
7955
690
             subfirstcharflags >= 0)
7956
475
      {
7957
475
      reqchar = subreqchar;
7958
475
      reqcharflags = subreqcharflags;
7959
475
      }
7960
90.9k
    break;     /* End of processing '(' */
7961
7962
7963
    /* ===================================================================*/
7964
    /* Handle metasequences introduced by \. For ones like \d, the ESC_ values
7965
    are arranged to be the negation of the corresponding OP_values in the
7966
    default case when PCRE_UCP is not set. For the back references, the values
7967
    are negative the reference number. Only back references and those types
7968
    that consume a character may be repeated. We can test for values between
7969
    ESC_b and ESC_Z for the latter; this may have to change if any new ones are
7970
    ever created. */
7971
7972
76.9k
    case CHAR_BACKSLASH:
7973
76.9k
    tempptr = ptr;
7974
76.9k
    escape = check_escape(&ptr, &ec, errorcodeptr, cd->bracount, options, FALSE);
7975
76.9k
    if (*errorcodeptr != 0) goto FAILED;
7976
7977
76.6k
    if (escape == 0)                  /* The escape coded a single character */
7978
52.2k
      c = ec;
7979
24.4k
    else
7980
24.4k
      {
7981
      /* For metasequences that actually match a character, we disable the
7982
      setting of a first character if it hasn't already been set. */
7983
7984
24.4k
      if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET && escape > ESC_b && escape < ESC_Z)
7985
3.98k
        firstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
7986
7987
      /* Set values to reset to if this is followed by a zero repeat. */
7988
7989
24.4k
      zerofirstchar = firstchar;
7990
24.4k
      zerofirstcharflags = firstcharflags;
7991
24.4k
      zeroreqchar = reqchar;
7992
24.4k
      zeroreqcharflags = reqcharflags;
7993
7994
      /* \g<name> or \g'name' is a subroutine call by name and \g<n> or \g'n'
7995
      is a subroutine call by number (Oniguruma syntax). In fact, the value
7996
      ESC_g is returned only for these cases. So we don't need to check for <
7997
      or ' if the value is ESC_g. For the Perl syntax \g{n} the value is
7998
      -n, and for the Perl syntax \g{name} the result is ESC_k (as
7999
      that is a synonym for a named back reference). */
8000
8001
24.4k
      if (escape == ESC_g)
8002
1.86k
        {
8003
1.86k
        const pcre_uchar *p;
8004
1.86k
        pcre_uint32 cf;
8005
8006
1.86k
        item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;   /* Normally this is set when '(' is read */
8007
1.86k
        terminator = (*(++ptr) == CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN)?
8008
1.43k
          CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN : CHAR_APOSTROPHE;
8009
8010
        /* These two statements stop the compiler for warning about possibly
8011
        unset variables caused by the jump to HANDLE_NUMERICAL_RECURSION. In
8012
        fact, because we do the check for a number below, the paths that
8013
        would actually be in error are never taken. */
8014
8015
1.86k
        skipbytes = 0;
8016
1.86k
        reset_bracount = FALSE;
8017
8018
        /* If it's not a signed or unsigned number, treat it as a name. */
8019
8020
1.86k
        cf = ptr[1];
8021
1.86k
        if (cf != CHAR_PLUS && cf != CHAR_MINUS && !IS_DIGIT(cf))
8022
445
          {
8023
445
          is_recurse = TRUE;
8024
445
          goto NAMED_REF_OR_RECURSE;
8025
445
          }
8026
8027
        /* Signed or unsigned number (cf = ptr[1]) is known to be plus or minus
8028
        or a digit. */
8029
8030
1.41k
        p = ptr + 2;
8031
2.69k
        while (IS_DIGIT(*p)) p++;
8032
1.41k
        if (*p != (pcre_uchar)terminator)
8033
24
          {
8034
24
          *errorcodeptr = ERR57;
8035
24
          goto FAILED;
8036
24
          }
8037
1.39k
        ptr++;
8038
1.39k
        goto HANDLE_NUMERICAL_RECURSION;
8039
1.41k
        }
8040
8041
      /* \k<name> or \k'name' is a back reference by name (Perl syntax).
8042
      We also support \k{name} (.NET syntax).  */
8043
8044
22.5k
      if (escape == ESC_k)
8045
4.67k
        {
8046
4.67k
        if ((ptr[1] != CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN &&
8047
4.39k
          ptr[1] != CHAR_APOSTROPHE && ptr[1] != CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET))
8048
5
          {
8049
5
          *errorcodeptr = ERR69;
8050
5
          goto FAILED;
8051
5
          }
8052
4.67k
        is_recurse = FALSE;
8053
4.67k
        terminator = (*(++ptr) == CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN)?
8054
4.39k
          CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN : (*ptr == CHAR_APOSTROPHE)?
8055
3.95k
          CHAR_APOSTROPHE : CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET;
8056
4.67k
        goto NAMED_REF_OR_RECURSE;
8057
4.67k
        }
8058
8059
      /* Back references are handled specially; must disable firstchar if
8060
      not set to cope with cases like (?=(\w+))\1: which would otherwise set
8061
      ':' later. */
8062
8063
17.8k
      if (escape < 0)
8064
8.49k
        {
8065
8.49k
        open_capitem *oc;
8066
8.49k
        recno = -escape;
8067
8068
        /* Come here from named backref handling when the reference is to a
8069
        single group (i.e. not to a duplicated name. */
8070
8071
11.9k
        HANDLE_REFERENCE:
8072
11.9k
        if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET) zerofirstcharflags = firstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
8073
11.9k
        previous = code;
8074
11.9k
        item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;
8075
11.9k
        *code++ = ((options & PCRE_CASELESS) != 0)? OP_REFI : OP_REF;
8076
11.9k
        PUT2INC(code, 0, recno);
8077
11.9k
        cd->backref_map |= (recno < 32)? (1U << recno) : 1;
8078
11.9k
        if (recno > cd->top_backref) cd->top_backref = recno;
8079
8080
        /* Check to see if this back reference is recursive, that it, it
8081
        is inside the group that it references. A flag is set so that the
8082
        group can be made atomic. */
8083
8084
139k
        for (oc = cd->open_caps; oc != NULL; oc = oc->next)
8085
131k
          {
8086
131k
          if (oc->number == recno)
8087
3.24k
            {
8088
3.24k
            oc->flag = TRUE;
8089
3.24k
            break;
8090
3.24k
            }
8091
131k
          }
8092
11.9k
        }
8093
8094
      /* So are Unicode property matches, if supported. */
8095
8096
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
8097
      else if (escape == ESC_P || escape == ESC_p)
8098
        {
8099
        BOOL negated;
8100
        unsigned int ptype = 0, pdata = 0;
8101
        if (!get_ucp(&ptr, &negated, &ptype, &pdata, errorcodeptr))
8102
          goto FAILED;
8103
        previous = code;
8104
        item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;
8105
        *code++ = ((escape == ESC_p) != negated)? OP_PROP : OP_NOTPROP;
8106
        *code++ = ptype;
8107
        *code++ = pdata;
8108
        }
8109
#else
8110
8111
      /* If Unicode properties are not supported, \X, \P, and \p are not
8112
      allowed. */
8113
8114
9.39k
      else if (escape == ESC_X || escape == ESC_P || escape == ESC_p)
8115
4
        {
8116
4
        *errorcodeptr = ERR45;
8117
4
        goto FAILED;
8118
4
        }
8119
9.39k
#endif
8120
8121
      /* For the rest (including \X when Unicode properties are supported), we
8122
      can obtain the OP value by negating the escape value in the default
8123
      situation when PCRE_UCP is not set. When it *is* set, we substitute
8124
      Unicode property tests. Note that \b and \B do a one-character
8125
      lookbehind, and \A also behaves as if it does. */
8126
8127
9.39k
      else
8128
9.39k
        {
8129
9.39k
        if ((escape == ESC_b || escape == ESC_B || escape == ESC_A) &&
8130
2.19k
             cd->max_lookbehind == 0)
8131
243
          cd->max_lookbehind = 1;
8132
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
8133
        if (escape >= ESC_DU && escape <= ESC_wu)
8134
          {
8135
          nestptr = ptr + 1;                   /* Where to resume */
8136
          ptr = substitutes[escape - ESC_DU] - 1;  /* Just before substitute */
8137
          }
8138
        else
8139
#endif
8140
        /* In non-UTF-8 mode, we turn \C into OP_ALLANY instead of OP_ANYBYTE
8141
        so that it works in DFA mode and in lookbehinds. */
8142
8143
9.39k
          {
8144
9.39k
          previous = (escape > ESC_b && escape < ESC_Z)? code : NULL;
8145
9.39k
          item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;
8146
9.39k
          *code++ = (!utf && escape == ESC_C)? OP_ALLANY : escape;
8147
9.39k
          }
8148
9.39k
        }
8149
21.3k
      continue;
8150
17.8k
      }
8151
8152
    /* We have a data character whose value is in c. In UTF-8 mode it may have
8153
    a value > 127. We set its representation in the length/buffer, and then
8154
    handle it as a data character. */
8155
8156
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32
8157
    if (utf && c > MAX_VALUE_FOR_SINGLE_CHAR)
8158
      mclength = PRIV(ord2utf)(c, mcbuffer);
8159
    else
8160
#endif
8161
8162
52.2k
     {
8163
52.2k
     mcbuffer[0] = c;
8164
52.2k
     mclength = 1;
8165
52.2k
     }
8166
52.2k
    goto ONE_CHAR;
8167
8168
8169
    /* ===================================================================*/
8170
    /* Handle a literal character. It is guaranteed not to be whitespace or #
8171
    when the extended flag is set. If we are in a UTF mode, it may be a
8172
    multi-unit literal character. */
8173
8174
945k
    default:
8175
960k
    NORMAL_CHAR:
8176
960k
    mclength = 1;
8177
960k
    mcbuffer[0] = c;
8178
8179
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
8180
    if (utf && HAS_EXTRALEN(c))
8181
      ACROSSCHAR(TRUE, ptr[1], mcbuffer[mclength++] = *(++ptr));
8182
#endif
8183
8184
    /* At this point we have the character's bytes in mcbuffer, and the length
8185
    in mclength. When not in UTF-8 mode, the length is always 1. */
8186
8187
1.01M
    ONE_CHAR:
8188
1.01M
    previous = code;
8189
1.01M
    item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;
8190
8191
    /* For caseless UTF-8 mode when UCP support is available, check whether
8192
    this character has more than one other case. If so, generate a special
8193
    OP_PROP item instead of OP_CHARI. */
8194
8195
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
8196
    if (utf && (options & PCRE_CASELESS) != 0)
8197
      {
8198
      GETCHAR(c, mcbuffer);
8199
      if ((c = UCD_CASESET(c)) != 0)
8200
        {
8201
        *code++ = OP_PROP;
8202
        *code++ = PT_CLIST;
8203
        *code++ = c;
8204
        if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET)
8205
          firstcharflags = zerofirstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
8206
        break;
8207
        }
8208
      }
8209
#endif
8210
8211
    /* Caseful matches, or not one of the multicase characters. */
8212
8213
1.01M
    *code++ = ((options & PCRE_CASELESS) != 0)? OP_CHARI : OP_CHAR;
8214
2.02M
    for (c = 0; c < mclength; c++) *code++ = mcbuffer[c];
8215
8216
    /* Remember if \r or \n were seen */
8217
8218
1.01M
    if (mcbuffer[0] == CHAR_CR || mcbuffer[0] == CHAR_NL)
8219
4.19k
      cd->external_flags |= PCRE_HASCRORLF;
8220
8221
    /* Set the first and required bytes appropriately. If no previous first
8222
    byte, set it from this character, but revert to none on a zero repeat.
8223
    Otherwise, leave the firstchar value alone, and don't change it on a zero
8224
    repeat. */
8225
8226
1.01M
    if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET)
8227
93.7k
      {
8228
93.7k
      zerofirstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
8229
93.7k
      zeroreqchar = reqchar;
8230
93.7k
      zeroreqcharflags = reqcharflags;
8231
8232
      /* If the character is more than one byte long, we can set firstchar
8233
      only if it is not to be matched caselessly. */
8234
8235
93.7k
      if (mclength == 1 || req_caseopt == 0)
8236
93.7k
        {
8237
93.7k
        firstchar = mcbuffer[0];
8238
93.7k
        firstcharflags = req_caseopt;
8239
8240
93.7k
        if (mclength != 1)
8241
0
          {
8242
0
          reqchar = code[-1];
8243
0
          reqcharflags = cd->req_varyopt;
8244
0
          }
8245
93.7k
        }
8246
0
      else firstcharflags = reqcharflags = REQ_NONE;
8247
93.7k
      }
8248
8249
    /* firstchar was previously set; we can set reqchar only if the length is
8250
    1 or the matching is caseful. */
8251
8252
919k
    else
8253
919k
      {
8254
919k
      zerofirstchar = firstchar;
8255
919k
      zerofirstcharflags = firstcharflags;
8256
919k
      zeroreqchar = reqchar;
8257
919k
      zeroreqcharflags = reqcharflags;
8258
919k
      if (mclength == 1 || req_caseopt == 0)
8259
919k
        {
8260
919k
        reqchar = code[-1];
8261
919k
        reqcharflags = req_caseopt | cd->req_varyopt;
8262
919k
        }
8263
919k
      }
8264
8265
1.01M
    break;            /* End of literal character handling */
8266
2.78M
    }
8267
2.78M
  }                   /* end of big loop */
8268
8269
8270
/* Control never reaches here by falling through, only by a goto for all the
8271
error states. Pass back the position in the pattern so that it can be displayed
8272
to the user for diagnosing the error. */
8273
8274
13.4k
FAILED:
8275
13.4k
*ptrptr = ptr;
8276
13.4k
return FALSE;
8277
778k
}
8278
8279
8280
8281
/*************************************************
8282
*     Compile sequence of alternatives           *
8283
*************************************************/
8284
8285
/* On entry, ptr is pointing past the bracket character, but on return it
8286
points to the closing bracket, or vertical bar, or end of string. The code
8287
variable is pointing at the byte into which the BRA operator has been stored.
8288
This function is used during the pre-compile phase when we are trying to find
8289
out the amount of memory needed, as well as during the real compile phase. The
8290
value of lengthptr distinguishes the two phases.
8291
8292
Arguments:
8293
  options           option bits, including any changes for this subpattern
8294
  codeptr           -> the address of the current code pointer
8295
  ptrptr            -> the address of the current pattern pointer
8296
  errorcodeptr      -> pointer to error code variable
8297
  lookbehind        TRUE if this is a lookbehind assertion
8298
  reset_bracount    TRUE to reset the count for each branch
8299
  skipbytes         skip this many bytes at start (for brackets and OP_COND)
8300
  cond_depth        depth of nesting for conditional subpatterns
8301
  firstcharptr      place to put the first required character
8302
  firstcharflagsptr place to put the first character flags, or a negative number
8303
  reqcharptr        place to put the last required character
8304
  reqcharflagsptr   place to put the last required character flags, or a negative number
8305
  bcptr             pointer to the chain of currently open branches
8306
  cd                points to the data block with tables pointers etc.
8307
  lengthptr         NULL during the real compile phase
8308
                    points to length accumulator during pre-compile phase
8309
8310
Returns:            TRUE on success
8311
*/
8312
8313
static BOOL
8314
compile_regex(int options, pcre_uchar **codeptr, const pcre_uchar **ptrptr,
8315
  int *errorcodeptr, BOOL lookbehind, BOOL reset_bracount, int skipbytes,
8316
  int cond_depth,
8317
  pcre_uint32 *firstcharptr, pcre_int32 *firstcharflagsptr,
8318
  pcre_uint32 *reqcharptr, pcre_int32 *reqcharflagsptr,
8319
  branch_chain *bcptr, compile_data *cd, int *lengthptr)
8320
693k
{
8321
693k
const pcre_uchar *ptr = *ptrptr;
8322
693k
pcre_uchar *code = *codeptr;
8323
693k
pcre_uchar *last_branch = code;
8324
693k
pcre_uchar *start_bracket = code;
8325
693k
pcre_uchar *reverse_count = NULL;
8326
693k
open_capitem capitem;
8327
693k
int capnumber = 0;
8328
693k
pcre_uint32 firstchar, reqchar;
8329
693k
pcre_int32 firstcharflags, reqcharflags;
8330
693k
pcre_uint32 branchfirstchar, branchreqchar;
8331
693k
pcre_int32 branchfirstcharflags, branchreqcharflags;
8332
693k
int length;
8333
693k
unsigned int orig_bracount;
8334
693k
unsigned int max_bracount;
8335
693k
branch_chain bc;
8336
693k
size_t save_hwm_offset;
8337
8338
/* If set, call the external function that checks for stack availability. */
8339
8340
693k
if (PUBL(stack_guard) != NULL && PUBL(stack_guard)())
8341
0
  {
8342
0
  *errorcodeptr= ERR85;
8343
0
  return FALSE;
8344
0
  }
8345
8346
/* Miscellaneous initialization */
8347
8348
693k
bc.outer = bcptr;
8349
693k
bc.current_branch = code;
8350
8351
693k
firstchar = reqchar = 0;
8352
693k
firstcharflags = reqcharflags = REQ_UNSET;
8353
8354
693k
save_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;
8355
8356
/* Accumulate the length for use in the pre-compile phase. Start with the
8357
length of the BRA and KET and any extra bytes that are required at the
8358
beginning. We accumulate in a local variable to save frequent testing of
8359
lenthptr for NULL. We cannot do this by looking at the value of code at the
8360
start and end of each alternative, because compiled items are discarded during
8361
the pre-compile phase so that the work space is not exceeded. */
8362
8363
693k
length = 2 + 2*LINK_SIZE + skipbytes;
8364
8365
/* WARNING: If the above line is changed for any reason, you must also change
8366
the code that abstracts option settings at the start of the pattern and makes
8367
them global. It tests the value of length for (2 + 2*LINK_SIZE) in the
8368
pre-compile phase to find out whether anything has yet been compiled or not. */
8369
8370
/* If this is a capturing subpattern, add to the chain of open capturing items
8371
so that we can detect them if (*ACCEPT) is encountered. This is also used to
8372
detect groups that contain recursive back references to themselves. Note that
8373
only OP_CBRA need be tested here; changing this opcode to one of its variants,
8374
e.g. OP_SCBRAPOS, happens later, after the group has been compiled. */
8375
8376
693k
if (*code == OP_CBRA)
8377
625k
  {
8378
625k
  capnumber = GET2(code, 1 + LINK_SIZE);
8379
625k
  capitem.number = capnumber;
8380
625k
  capitem.next = cd->open_caps;
8381
625k
  capitem.flag = FALSE;
8382
625k
  cd->open_caps = &capitem;
8383
625k
  }
8384
8385
/* Offset is set zero to mark that this bracket is still open */
8386
8387
693k
PUT(code, 1, 0);
8388
693k
code += 1 + LINK_SIZE + skipbytes;
8389
8390
/* Loop for each alternative branch */
8391
8392
693k
orig_bracount = max_bracount = cd->bracount;
8393
693k
for (;;)
8394
778k
  {
8395
  /* For a (?| group, reset the capturing bracket count so that each branch
8396
  uses the same numbers. */
8397
8398
778k
  if (reset_bracount) cd->bracount = orig_bracount;
8399
8400
  /* Set up dummy OP_REVERSE if lookbehind assertion */
8401
8402
778k
  if (lookbehind)
8403
4.34k
    {
8404
4.34k
    *code++ = OP_REVERSE;
8405
4.34k
    reverse_count = code;
8406
4.34k
    PUTINC(code, 0, 0);
8407
4.34k
    length += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
8408
4.34k
    }
8409
8410
  /* Now compile the branch; in the pre-compile phase its length gets added
8411
  into the length. */
8412
8413
778k
  if (!compile_branch(&options, &code, &ptr, errorcodeptr, &branchfirstchar,
8414
778k
        &branchfirstcharflags, &branchreqchar, &branchreqcharflags, &bc,
8415
778k
        cond_depth, cd, (lengthptr == NULL)? NULL : &length))
8416
13.4k
    {
8417
13.4k
    *ptrptr = ptr;
8418
13.4k
    return FALSE;
8419
13.4k
    }
8420
8421
  /* Keep the highest bracket count in case (?| was used and some branch
8422
  has fewer than the rest. */
8423
8424
765k
  if (cd->bracount > max_bracount) max_bracount = cd->bracount;
8425
8426
  /* In the real compile phase, there is some post-processing to be done. */
8427
8428
765k
  if (lengthptr == NULL)
8429
148k
    {
8430
    /* If this is the first branch, the firstchar and reqchar values for the
8431
    branch become the values for the regex. */
8432
8433
148k
    if (*last_branch != OP_ALT)
8434
107k
      {
8435
107k
      firstchar = branchfirstchar;
8436
107k
      firstcharflags = branchfirstcharflags;
8437
107k
      reqchar = branchreqchar;
8438
107k
      reqcharflags = branchreqcharflags;
8439
107k
      }
8440
8441
    /* If this is not the first branch, the first char and reqchar have to
8442
    match the values from all the previous branches, except that if the
8443
    previous value for reqchar didn't have REQ_VARY set, it can still match,
8444
    and we set REQ_VARY for the regex. */
8445
8446
40.3k
    else
8447
40.3k
      {
8448
      /* If we previously had a firstchar, but it doesn't match the new branch,
8449
      we have to abandon the firstchar for the regex, but if there was
8450
      previously no reqchar, it takes on the value of the old firstchar. */
8451
8452
40.3k
      if (firstcharflags >= 0 &&
8453
3.51k
          (firstcharflags != branchfirstcharflags || firstchar != branchfirstchar))
8454
1.77k
        {
8455
1.77k
        if (reqcharflags < 0)
8456
1.09k
          {
8457
1.09k
          reqchar = firstchar;
8458
1.09k
          reqcharflags = firstcharflags;
8459
1.09k
          }
8460
1.77k
        firstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
8461
1.77k
        }
8462
8463
      /* If we (now or from before) have no firstchar, a firstchar from the
8464
      branch becomes a reqchar if there isn't a branch reqchar. */
8465
8466
40.3k
      if (firstcharflags < 0 && branchfirstcharflags >= 0 && branchreqcharflags < 0)
8467
4.60k
        {
8468
4.60k
        branchreqchar = branchfirstchar;
8469
4.60k
        branchreqcharflags = branchfirstcharflags;
8470
4.60k
        }
8471
8472
      /* Now ensure that the reqchars match */
8473
8474
40.3k
      if (((reqcharflags & ~REQ_VARY) != (branchreqcharflags & ~REQ_VARY)) ||
8475
4.86k
          reqchar != branchreqchar)
8476
36.8k
        reqcharflags = REQ_NONE;
8477
3.52k
      else
8478
3.52k
        {
8479
3.52k
        reqchar = branchreqchar;
8480
3.52k
        reqcharflags |= branchreqcharflags; /* To "or" REQ_VARY */
8481
3.52k
        }
8482
40.3k
      }
8483
8484
    /* If lookbehind, check that this branch matches a fixed-length string, and
8485
    put the length into the OP_REVERSE item. Temporarily mark the end of the
8486
    branch with OP_END. If the branch contains OP_RECURSE, the result is -3
8487
    because there may be forward references that we can't check here. Set a
8488
    flag to cause another lookbehind check at the end. Why not do it all at the
8489
    end? Because common, erroneous checks are picked up here and the offset of
8490
    the problem can be shown. */
8491
8492
148k
    if (lookbehind)
8493
2.07k
      {
8494
2.07k
      int fixed_length;
8495
2.07k
      *code = OP_END;
8496
2.07k
      fixed_length = find_fixedlength(last_branch,  (options & PCRE_UTF8) != 0,
8497
2.07k
        FALSE, cd, NULL);
8498
2.07k
      DPRINTF(("fixed length = %d\n", fixed_length));
8499
2.07k
      if (fixed_length == -3)
8500
498
        {
8501
498
        cd->check_lookbehind = TRUE;
8502
498
        }
8503
1.57k
      else if (fixed_length < 0)
8504
151
        {
8505
151
        *errorcodeptr = (fixed_length == -2)? ERR36 :
8506
151
                        (fixed_length == -4)? ERR70: ERR25;
8507
151
        *ptrptr = ptr;
8508
151
        return FALSE;
8509
151
        }
8510
1.42k
      else
8511
1.42k
        {
8512
1.42k
        if (fixed_length > cd->max_lookbehind)
8513
329
          cd->max_lookbehind = fixed_length;
8514
1.42k
        PUT(reverse_count, 0, fixed_length);
8515
1.42k
        }
8516
2.07k
      }
8517
148k
    }
8518
8519
  /* Reached end of expression, either ')' or end of pattern. In the real
8520
  compile phase, go back through the alternative branches and reverse the chain
8521
  of offsets, with the field in the BRA item now becoming an offset to the
8522
  first alternative. If there are no alternatives, it points to the end of the
8523
  group. The length in the terminating ket is always the length of the whole
8524
  bracketed item. Return leaving the pointer at the terminating char. */
8525
8526
765k
  if (*ptr != CHAR_VERTICAL_LINE)
8527
679k
    {
8528
679k
    if (lengthptr == NULL)
8529
107k
      {
8530
107k
      int branch_length = (int)(code - last_branch);
8531
107k
      do
8532
148k
        {
8533
148k
        int prev_length = GET(last_branch, 1);
8534
148k
        PUT(last_branch, 1, branch_length);
8535
148k
        branch_length = prev_length;
8536
148k
        last_branch -= branch_length;
8537
148k
        }
8538
148k
      while (branch_length > 0);
8539
107k
      }
8540
8541
    /* Fill in the ket */
8542
8543
679k
    *code = OP_KET;
8544
679k
    PUT(code, 1, (int)(code - start_bracket));
8545
679k
    code += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
8546
8547
    /* If it was a capturing subpattern, check to see if it contained any
8548
    recursive back references. If so, we must wrap it in atomic brackets.
8549
    Because we are moving code along, we must ensure that any pending recursive
8550
    references are updated. In any event, remove the block from the chain. */
8551
8552
679k
    if (capnumber > 0)
8553
616k
      {
8554
616k
      if (cd->open_caps->flag)
8555
1.20k
        {
8556
1.20k
        *code = OP_END;
8557
1.20k
        adjust_recurse(start_bracket, 1 + LINK_SIZE,
8558
1.20k
          (options & PCRE_UTF8) != 0, cd, save_hwm_offset);
8559
1.20k
        memmove(start_bracket + 1 + LINK_SIZE, start_bracket,
8560
1.20k
          IN_UCHARS(code - start_bracket));
8561
1.20k
        *start_bracket = OP_ONCE;
8562
1.20k
        code += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
8563
1.20k
        PUT(start_bracket, 1, (int)(code - start_bracket));
8564
1.20k
        *code = OP_KET;
8565
1.20k
        PUT(code, 1, (int)(code - start_bracket));
8566
1.20k
        code += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
8567
1.20k
        length += 2 + 2*LINK_SIZE;
8568
1.20k
        }
8569
616k
      cd->open_caps = cd->open_caps->next;
8570
616k
      }
8571
8572
    /* Retain the highest bracket number, in case resetting was used. */
8573
8574
679k
    cd->bracount = max_bracount;
8575
8576
    /* Set values to pass back */
8577
8578
679k
    *codeptr = code;
8579
679k
    *ptrptr = ptr;
8580
679k
    *firstcharptr = firstchar;
8581
679k
    *firstcharflagsptr = firstcharflags;
8582
679k
    *reqcharptr = reqchar;
8583
679k
    *reqcharflagsptr = reqcharflags;
8584
679k
    if (lengthptr != NULL)
8585
571k
      {
8586
571k
      if (OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < length)
8587
1
        {
8588
1
        *errorcodeptr = ERR20;
8589
1
        return FALSE;
8590
1
        }
8591
571k
      *lengthptr += length;
8592
571k
      }
8593
679k
    return TRUE;
8594
679k
    }
8595
8596
  /* Another branch follows. In the pre-compile phase, we can move the code
8597
  pointer back to where it was for the start of the first branch. (That is,
8598
  pretend that each branch is the only one.)
8599
8600
  In the real compile phase, insert an ALT node. Its length field points back
8601
  to the previous branch while the bracket remains open. At the end the chain
8602
  is reversed. It's done like this so that the start of the bracket has a
8603
  zero offset until it is closed, making it possible to detect recursion. */
8604
8605
85.5k
  if (lengthptr != NULL)
8606
45.1k
    {
8607
45.1k
    code = *codeptr + 1 + LINK_SIZE + skipbytes;
8608
45.1k
    length += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
8609
45.1k
    }
8610
40.3k
  else
8611
40.3k
    {
8612
40.3k
    *code = OP_ALT;
8613
40.3k
    PUT(code, 1, (int)(code - last_branch));
8614
40.3k
    bc.current_branch = last_branch = code;
8615
40.3k
    code += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
8616
40.3k
    }
8617
8618
85.5k
  ptr++;
8619
85.5k
  }
8620
/* Control never reaches here */
8621
693k
}
8622
8623
8624
8625
8626
/*************************************************
8627
*          Check for anchored expression         *
8628
*************************************************/
8629
8630
/* Try to find out if this is an anchored regular expression. Consider each
8631
alternative branch. If they all start with OP_SOD or OP_CIRC, or with a bracket
8632
all of whose alternatives start with OP_SOD or OP_CIRC (recurse ad lib), then
8633
it's anchored. However, if this is a multiline pattern, then only OP_SOD will
8634
be found, because ^ generates OP_CIRCM in that mode.
8635
8636
We can also consider a regex to be anchored if OP_SOM starts all its branches.
8637
This is the code for \G, which means "match at start of match position, taking
8638
into account the match offset".
8639
8640
A branch is also implicitly anchored if it starts with .* and DOTALL is set,
8641
because that will try the rest of the pattern at all possible matching points,
8642
so there is no point trying again.... er ....
8643
8644
.... except when the .* appears inside capturing parentheses, and there is a
8645
subsequent back reference to those parentheses. We haven't enough information
8646
to catch that case precisely.
8647
8648
At first, the best we could do was to detect when .* was in capturing brackets
8649
and the highest back reference was greater than or equal to that level.
8650
However, by keeping a bitmap of the first 31 back references, we can catch some
8651
of the more common cases more precisely.
8652
8653
... A second exception is when the .* appears inside an atomic group, because
8654
this prevents the number of characters it matches from being adjusted.
8655
8656
Arguments:
8657
  code           points to start of expression (the bracket)
8658
  bracket_map    a bitmap of which brackets we are inside while testing; this
8659
                  handles up to substring 31; after that we just have to take
8660
                  the less precise approach
8661
  cd             points to the compile data block
8662
  atomcount      atomic group level
8663
8664
Returns:     TRUE or FALSE
8665
*/
8666
8667
static BOOL
8668
is_anchored(register const pcre_uchar *code, unsigned int bracket_map,
8669
  compile_data *cd, int atomcount)
8670
23.4k
{
8671
24.8k
do {
8672
24.8k
   const pcre_uchar *scode = first_significant_code(
8673
24.8k
     code + PRIV(OP_lengths)[*code], FALSE);
8674
24.8k
   register int op = *scode;
8675
8676
   /* Non-capturing brackets */
8677
8678
24.8k
   if (op == OP_BRA  || op == OP_BRAPOS ||
8679
23.8k
       op == OP_SBRA || op == OP_SBRAPOS)
8680
1.47k
     {
8681
1.47k
     if (!is_anchored(scode, bracket_map, cd, atomcount)) return FALSE;
8682
1.47k
     }
8683
8684
   /* Capturing brackets */
8685
8686
23.4k
   else if (op == OP_CBRA  || op == OP_CBRAPOS ||
8687
19.6k
            op == OP_SCBRA || op == OP_SCBRAPOS)
8688
4.24k
     {
8689
4.24k
     int n = GET2(scode, 1+LINK_SIZE);
8690
4.24k
     int new_map = bracket_map | ((n < 32)? (1U << n) : 1);
8691
4.24k
     if (!is_anchored(scode, new_map, cd, atomcount)) return FALSE;
8692
4.24k
     }
8693
8694
   /* Positive forward assertion */
8695
8696
19.1k
   else if (op == OP_ASSERT)
8697
686
     {
8698
686
     if (!is_anchored(scode, bracket_map, cd, atomcount)) return FALSE;
8699
686
     }
8700
8701
   /* Condition; not anchored if no second branch */
8702
8703
18.4k
   else if (op == OP_COND)
8704
293
     {
8705
293
     if (scode[GET(scode,1)] != OP_ALT) return FALSE;
8706
89
     if (!is_anchored(scode, bracket_map, cd, atomcount)) return FALSE;
8707
89
     }
8708
8709
   /* Atomic groups */
8710
8711
18.1k
   else if (op == OP_ONCE || op == OP_ONCE_NC)
8712
1.31k
     {
8713
1.31k
     if (!is_anchored(scode, bracket_map, cd, atomcount + 1))
8714
1.01k
       return FALSE;
8715
1.31k
     }
8716
8717
   /* .* is not anchored unless DOTALL is set (which generates OP_ALLANY) and
8718
   it isn't in brackets that are or may be referenced or inside an atomic
8719
   group. */
8720
8721
16.8k
   else if ((op == OP_TYPESTAR || op == OP_TYPEMINSTAR ||
8722
16.3k
             op == OP_TYPEPOSSTAR))
8723
846
     {
8724
846
     if (scode[1] != OP_ALLANY || (bracket_map & cd->backref_map) != 0 ||
8725
655
         atomcount > 0 || cd->had_pruneorskip)
8726
193
       return FALSE;
8727
846
     }
8728
8729
   /* Check for explicit anchoring */
8730
8731
16.0k
   else if (op != OP_SOD && op != OP_SOM && op != OP_CIRC) return FALSE;
8732
8733
2.73k
   code += GET(code, 1);
8734
2.73k
   }
8735
23.4k
while (*code == OP_ALT);   /* Loop for each alternative */
8736
1.29k
return TRUE;
8737
23.4k
}
8738
8739
8740
8741
/*************************************************
8742
*         Check for starting with ^ or .*        *
8743
*************************************************/
8744
8745
/* This is called to find out if every branch starts with ^ or .* so that
8746
"first char" processing can be done to speed things up in multiline
8747
matching and for non-DOTALL patterns that start with .* (which must start at
8748
the beginning or after \n). As in the case of is_anchored() (see above), we
8749
have to take account of back references to capturing brackets that contain .*
8750
because in that case we can't make the assumption. Also, the appearance of .*
8751
inside atomic brackets or in an assertion, or in a pattern that contains *PRUNE
8752
or *SKIP does not count, because once again the assumption no longer holds.
8753
8754
Arguments:
8755
  code           points to start of expression (the bracket)
8756
  bracket_map    a bitmap of which brackets we are inside while testing; this
8757
                  handles up to substring 31; after that we just have to take
8758
                  the less precise approach
8759
  cd             points to the compile data
8760
  atomcount      atomic group level
8761
  inassert       TRUE if in an assertion
8762
8763
Returns:         TRUE or FALSE
8764
*/
8765
8766
static BOOL
8767
is_startline(const pcre_uchar *code, unsigned int bracket_map,
8768
  compile_data *cd, int atomcount, BOOL inassert)
8769
11.2k
{
8770
12.8k
do {
8771
12.8k
   const pcre_uchar *scode = first_significant_code(
8772
12.8k
     code + PRIV(OP_lengths)[*code], FALSE);
8773
12.8k
   register int op = *scode;
8774
8775
   /* If we are at the start of a conditional assertion group, *both* the
8776
   conditional assertion *and* what follows the condition must satisfy the test
8777
   for start of line. Other kinds of condition fail. Note that there may be an
8778
   auto-callout at the start of a condition. */
8779
8780
12.8k
   if (op == OP_COND)
8781
414
     {
8782
414
     scode += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
8783
414
     if (*scode == OP_CALLOUT) scode += PRIV(OP_lengths)[OP_CALLOUT];
8784
414
     switch (*scode)
8785
414
       {
8786
46
       case OP_CREF:
8787
47
       case OP_DNCREF:
8788
168
       case OP_RREF:
8789
170
       case OP_DNRREF:
8790
177
       case OP_DEF:
8791
191
       case OP_FAIL:
8792
191
       return FALSE;
8793
8794
223
       default:     /* Assertion */
8795
223
       if (!is_startline(scode, bracket_map, cd, atomcount, TRUE)) return FALSE;
8796
263
       do scode += GET(scode, 1); while (*scode == OP_ALT);
8797
45
       scode += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
8798
45
       break;
8799
414
       }
8800
45
     scode = first_significant_code(scode, FALSE);
8801
45
     op = *scode;
8802
45
     }
8803
8804
   /* Non-capturing brackets */
8805
8806
12.5k
   if (op == OP_BRA  || op == OP_BRAPOS ||
8807
11.7k
       op == OP_SBRA || op == OP_SBRAPOS)
8808
1.27k
     {
8809
1.27k
     if (!is_startline(scode, bracket_map, cd, atomcount, inassert)) return FALSE;
8810
1.27k
     }
8811
8812
   /* Capturing brackets */
8813
8814
11.2k
   else if (op == OP_CBRA  || op == OP_CBRAPOS ||
8815
8.09k
            op == OP_SCBRA || op == OP_SCBRAPOS)
8816
3.68k
     {
8817
3.68k
     int n = GET2(scode, 1+LINK_SIZE);
8818
3.68k
     int new_map = bracket_map | ((n < 32)? (1U << n) : 1);
8819
3.68k
     if (!is_startline(scode, new_map, cd, atomcount, inassert)) return FALSE;
8820
3.68k
     }
8821
8822
   /* Positive forward assertions */
8823
8824
7.57k
   else if (op == OP_ASSERT)
8825
346
     {
8826
346
     if (!is_startline(scode, bracket_map, cd, atomcount, TRUE)) return FALSE;
8827
346
     }
8828
8829
   /* Atomic brackets */
8830
8831
7.23k
   else if (op == OP_ONCE || op == OP_ONCE_NC)
8832
1.11k
     {
8833
1.11k
     if (!is_startline(scode, bracket_map, cd, atomcount + 1, inassert)) return FALSE;
8834
1.11k
     }
8835
8836
   /* .* means "start at start or after \n" if it isn't in atomic brackets or
8837
   brackets that may be referenced or an assertion, as long as the pattern does
8838
   not contain *PRUNE or *SKIP, because these break the feature. Consider, for
8839
   example, /.*?a(*PRUNE)b/ with the subject "aab", which matches "ab", i.e.
8840
   not at the start of a line. */
8841
8842
6.12k
   else if (op == OP_TYPESTAR || op == OP_TYPEMINSTAR || op == OP_TYPEPOSSTAR)
8843
1.12k
     {
8844
1.12k
     if (scode[1] != OP_ANY || (bracket_map & cd->backref_map) != 0 ||
8845
1.02k
         atomcount > 0 || cd->had_pruneorskip || inassert)
8846
119
       return FALSE;
8847
1.12k
     }
8848
8849
   /* Check for explicit circumflex; anything else gives a FALSE result. Note
8850
   in particular that this includes atomic brackets OP_ONCE and OP_ONCE_NC
8851
   because the number of characters matched by .* cannot be adjusted inside
8852
   them. */
8853
8854
4.99k
   else if (op != OP_CIRC && op != OP_CIRCM) return FALSE;
8855
8856
   /* Move on to the next alternative */
8857
8858
2.70k
   code += GET(code, 1);
8859
2.70k
   }
8860
11.2k
while (*code == OP_ALT);  /* Loop for each alternative */
8861
1.02k
return TRUE;
8862
11.2k
}
8863
8864
8865
8866
/*************************************************
8867
*       Check for asserted fixed first char      *
8868
*************************************************/
8869
8870
/* During compilation, the "first char" settings from forward assertions are
8871
discarded, because they can cause conflicts with actual literals that follow.
8872
However, if we end up without a first char setting for an unanchored pattern,
8873
it is worth scanning the regex to see if there is an initial asserted first
8874
char. If all branches start with the same asserted char, or with a
8875
non-conditional bracket all of whose alternatives start with the same asserted
8876
char (recurse ad lib), then we return that char, with the flags set to zero or
8877
REQ_CASELESS; otherwise return zero with REQ_NONE in the flags.
8878
8879
Arguments:
8880
  code       points to start of expression (the bracket)
8881
  flags      points to the first char flags, or to REQ_NONE
8882
  inassert   TRUE if in an assertion
8883
8884
Returns:     the fixed first char, or 0 with REQ_NONE in flags
8885
*/
8886
8887
static pcre_uint32
8888
find_firstassertedchar(const pcre_uchar *code, pcre_int32 *flags,
8889
  BOOL inassert)
8890
11.0k
{
8891
11.0k
register pcre_uint32 c = 0;
8892
11.0k
int cflags = REQ_NONE;
8893
8894
11.0k
*flags = REQ_NONE;
8895
13.8k
do {
8896
13.8k
   pcre_uint32 d;
8897
13.8k
   int dflags;
8898
13.8k
   int xl = (*code == OP_CBRA || *code == OP_SCBRA ||
8899
10.7k
             *code == OP_CBRAPOS || *code == OP_SCBRAPOS)? IMM2_SIZE:0;
8900
13.8k
   const pcre_uchar *scode = first_significant_code(code + 1+LINK_SIZE + xl,
8901
13.8k
     TRUE);
8902
13.8k
   register pcre_uchar op = *scode;
8903
8904
13.8k
   switch(op)
8905
13.8k
     {
8906
4.41k
     default:
8907
4.41k
     return 0;
8908
8909
665
     case OP_BRA:
8910
778
     case OP_BRAPOS:
8911
3.73k
     case OP_CBRA:
8912
3.96k
     case OP_SCBRA:
8913
4.17k
     case OP_CBRAPOS:
8914
4.46k
     case OP_SCBRAPOS:
8915
5.25k
     case OP_ASSERT:
8916
5.91k
     case OP_ONCE:
8917
6.33k
     case OP_ONCE_NC:
8918
6.33k
     d = find_firstassertedchar(scode, &dflags, op == OP_ASSERT);
8919
6.33k
     if (dflags < 0)
8920
5.88k
       return 0;
8921
455
     if (cflags < 0) { c = d; cflags = dflags; } else if (c != d || cflags != dflags) return 0;
8922
448
     break;
8923
8924
448
     case OP_EXACT:
8925
171
     scode += IMM2_SIZE;
8926
     /* Fall through */
8927
8928
928
     case OP_CHAR:
8929
1.18k
     case OP_PLUS:
8930
1.40k
     case OP_MINPLUS:
8931
1.68k
     case OP_POSPLUS:
8932
1.68k
     if (!inassert) return 0;
8933
1.56k
     if (cflags < 0) { c = scode[1]; cflags = 0; }
8934
1.38k
       else if (c != scode[1]) return 0;
8935
1.55k
     break;
8936
8937
1.55k
     case OP_EXACTI:
8938
199
     scode += IMM2_SIZE;
8939
     /* Fall through */
8940
8941
746
     case OP_CHARI:
8942
951
     case OP_PLUSI:
8943
1.05k
     case OP_MINPLUSI:
8944
1.46k
     case OP_POSPLUSI:
8945
1.46k
     if (!inassert) return 0;
8946
1.43k
     if (cflags < 0) { c = scode[1]; cflags = REQ_CASELESS; }
8947
1.21k
       else if (c != scode[1]) return 0;
8948
1.42k
     break;
8949
13.8k
     }
8950
8951
3.42k
   code += GET(code, 1);
8952
3.42k
   }
8953
11.0k
while (*code == OP_ALT);
8954
8955
537
*flags = cflags;
8956
537
return c;
8957
11.0k
}
8958
8959
8960
8961
/*************************************************
8962
*     Add an entry to the name/number table      *
8963
*************************************************/
8964
8965
/* This function is called between compiling passes to add an entry to the
8966
name/number table, maintaining alphabetical order. Checking for permitted
8967
and forbidden duplicates has already been done.
8968
8969
Arguments:
8970
  cd           the compile data block
8971
  name         the name to add
8972
  length       the length of the name
8973
  groupno      the group number
8974
8975
Returns:       nothing
8976
*/
8977
8978
static void
8979
add_name(compile_data *cd, const pcre_uchar *name, int length,
8980
  unsigned int groupno)
8981
28.8k
{
8982
28.8k
int i;
8983
28.8k
pcre_uchar *slot = cd->name_table;
8984
8985
35.6M
for (i = 0; i < cd->names_found; i++)
8986
35.6M
  {
8987
35.6M
  int crc = memcmp(name, slot+IMM2_SIZE, IN_UCHARS(length));
8988
35.6M
  if (crc == 0 && slot[IMM2_SIZE+length] != 0)
8989
19.9k
    crc = -1; /* Current name is a substring */
8990
8991
  /* Make space in the table and break the loop for an earlier name. For a
8992
  duplicate or later name, carry on. We do this for duplicates so that in the
8993
  simple case (when ?(| is not used) they are in order of their numbers. In all
8994
  cases they are in the order in which they appear in the pattern. */
8995
8996
35.6M
  if (crc < 0)
8997
22.2k
    {
8998
22.2k
    memmove(slot + cd->name_entry_size, slot,
8999
22.2k
      IN_UCHARS((cd->names_found - i) * cd->name_entry_size));
9000
22.2k
    break;
9001
22.2k
    }
9002
9003
  /* Continue the loop for a later or duplicate name */
9004
9005
35.6M
  slot += cd->name_entry_size;
9006
35.6M
  }
9007
9008
28.8k
PUT2(slot, 0, groupno);
9009
28.8k
memcpy(slot + IMM2_SIZE, name, IN_UCHARS(length));
9010
28.8k
slot[IMM2_SIZE + length] = 0;
9011
28.8k
cd->names_found++;
9012
28.8k
}
9013
9014
9015
9016
/*************************************************
9017
*        Compile a Regular Expression            *
9018
*************************************************/
9019
9020
/* This function takes a string and returns a pointer to a block of store
9021
holding a compiled version of the expression. The original API for this
9022
function had no error code return variable; it is retained for backwards
9023
compatibility. The new function is given a new name.
9024
9025
Arguments:
9026
  pattern       the regular expression
9027
  options       various option bits
9028
  errorcodeptr  pointer to error code variable (pcre_compile2() only)
9029
                  can be NULL if you don't want a code value
9030
  errorptr      pointer to pointer to error text
9031
  erroroffset   ptr offset in pattern where error was detected
9032
  tables        pointer to character tables or NULL
9033
9034
Returns:        pointer to compiled data block, or NULL on error,
9035
                with errorptr and erroroffset set
9036
*/
9037
9038
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE8
9039
PCRE_EXP_DEFN pcre * PCRE_CALL_CONVENTION
9040
pcre_compile(const char *pattern, int options, const char **errorptr,
9041
  int *erroroffset, const unsigned char *tables)
9042
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16
9043
PCRE_EXP_DEFN pcre16 * PCRE_CALL_CONVENTION
9044
pcre16_compile(PCRE_SPTR16 pattern, int options, const char **errorptr,
9045
  int *erroroffset, const unsigned char *tables)
9046
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32
9047
PCRE_EXP_DEFN pcre32 * PCRE_CALL_CONVENTION
9048
pcre32_compile(PCRE_SPTR32 pattern, int options, const char **errorptr,
9049
  int *erroroffset, const unsigned char *tables)
9050
#endif
9051
20.1k
{
9052
20.1k
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE8
9053
20.1k
return pcre_compile2(pattern, options, NULL, errorptr, erroroffset, tables);
9054
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16
9055
return pcre16_compile2(pattern, options, NULL, errorptr, erroroffset, tables);
9056
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32
9057
return pcre32_compile2(pattern, options, NULL, errorptr, erroroffset, tables);
9058
#endif
9059
20.1k
}
9060
9061
9062
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE8
9063
PCRE_EXP_DEFN pcre * PCRE_CALL_CONVENTION
9064
pcre_compile2(const char *pattern, int options, int *errorcodeptr,
9065
  const char **errorptr, int *erroroffset, const unsigned char *tables)
9066
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16
9067
PCRE_EXP_DEFN pcre16 * PCRE_CALL_CONVENTION
9068
pcre16_compile2(PCRE_SPTR16 pattern, int options, int *errorcodeptr,
9069
  const char **errorptr, int *erroroffset, const unsigned char *tables)
9070
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32
9071
PCRE_EXP_DEFN pcre32 * PCRE_CALL_CONVENTION
9072
pcre32_compile2(PCRE_SPTR32 pattern, int options, int *errorcodeptr,
9073
  const char **errorptr, int *erroroffset, const unsigned char *tables)
9074
#endif
9075
20.1k
{
9076
20.1k
REAL_PCRE *re;
9077
20.1k
int length = 1;  /* For final END opcode */
9078
20.1k
pcre_int32 firstcharflags, reqcharflags;
9079
20.1k
pcre_uint32 firstchar, reqchar;
9080
20.1k
pcre_uint32 limit_match = PCRE_UINT32_MAX;
9081
20.1k
pcre_uint32 limit_recursion = PCRE_UINT32_MAX;
9082
20.1k
int newline;
9083
20.1k
int errorcode = 0;
9084
20.1k
int skipatstart = 0;
9085
20.1k
BOOL utf;
9086
20.1k
BOOL never_utf = FALSE;
9087
20.1k
size_t size;
9088
20.1k
pcre_uchar *code;
9089
20.1k
const pcre_uchar *codestart;
9090
20.1k
const pcre_uchar *ptr;
9091
20.1k
compile_data compile_block;
9092
20.1k
compile_data *cd = &compile_block;
9093
9094
/* This space is used for "compiling" into during the first phase, when we are
9095
computing the amount of memory that is needed. Compiled items are thrown away
9096
as soon as possible, so that a fairly large buffer should be sufficient for
9097
this purpose. The same space is used in the second phase for remembering where
9098
to fill in forward references to subpatterns. That may overflow, in which case
9099
new memory is obtained from malloc(). */
9100
9101
20.1k
pcre_uchar cworkspace[COMPILE_WORK_SIZE];
9102
9103
/* This vector is used for remembering name groups during the pre-compile. In a
9104
similar way to cworkspace, it can be expanded using malloc() if necessary. */
9105
9106
20.1k
named_group named_groups[NAMED_GROUP_LIST_SIZE];
9107
20.1k
cd->named_groups = named_groups;
9108
20.1k
cd->named_group_list_size = NAMED_GROUP_LIST_SIZE;
9109
9110
/* Set this early so that early errors get offset 0. */
9111
9112
20.1k
ptr = (const pcre_uchar *)pattern;
9113
9114
/* We can't pass back an error message if errorptr is NULL; I guess the best we
9115
can do is just return NULL, but we can set a code value if there is a code
9116
pointer. */
9117
9118
20.1k
if (errorptr == NULL)
9119
0
  {
9120
0
  if (errorcodeptr != NULL) *errorcodeptr = 99;
9121
0
  return NULL;
9122
0
  }
9123
9124
20.1k
*errorptr = NULL;
9125
20.1k
if (errorcodeptr != NULL) *errorcodeptr = ERR0;
9126
9127
/* However, we can give a message for this error */
9128
9129
20.1k
if (erroroffset == NULL)
9130
0
  {
9131
0
  errorcode = ERR16;
9132
0
  goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN2;
9133
0
  }
9134
9135
20.1k
*erroroffset = 0;
9136
9137
/* Set up pointers to the individual character tables */
9138
9139
20.1k
if (tables == NULL) tables = PRIV(default_tables);
9140
20.1k
cd->lcc = tables + lcc_offset;
9141
20.1k
cd->fcc = tables + fcc_offset;
9142
20.1k
cd->cbits = tables + cbits_offset;
9143
20.1k
cd->ctypes = tables + ctypes_offset;
9144
9145
/* Check that all undefined public option bits are zero */
9146
9147
20.1k
if ((options & ~PUBLIC_COMPILE_OPTIONS) != 0)
9148
0
  {
9149
0
  errorcode = ERR17;
9150
0
  goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN;
9151
0
  }
9152
9153
/* If PCRE_NEVER_UTF is set, remember it. */
9154
9155
20.1k
if ((options & PCRE_NEVER_UTF) != 0) never_utf = TRUE;
9156
9157
/* Check for global one-time settings at the start of the pattern, and remember
9158
the offset for later. */
9159
9160
20.1k
cd->external_flags = 0;   /* Initialize here for LIMIT_MATCH/RECURSION */
9161
9162
24.3k
while (ptr[skipatstart] == CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS &&
9163
10.9k
       ptr[skipatstart+1] == CHAR_ASTERISK)
9164
5.03k
  {
9165
5.03k
  int newnl = 0;
9166
5.03k
  int newbsr = 0;
9167
9168
/* For completeness and backward compatibility, (*UTFn) is supported in the
9169
relevant libraries, but (*UTF) is generic and always supported. Note that
9170
PCRE_UTF8 == PCRE_UTF16 == PCRE_UTF32. */
9171
9172
5.03k
#ifdef COMPILE_PCRE8
9173
5.03k
  if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_UTF8_RIGHTPAR, 5) == 0)
9174
18
    { skipatstart += 7; options |= PCRE_UTF8; continue; }
9175
5.01k
#endif
9176
#ifdef COMPILE_PCRE16
9177
  if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_UTF16_RIGHTPAR, 6) == 0)
9178
    { skipatstart += 8; options |= PCRE_UTF16; continue; }
9179
#endif
9180
#ifdef COMPILE_PCRE32
9181
  if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_UTF32_RIGHTPAR, 6) == 0)
9182
    { skipatstart += 8; options |= PCRE_UTF32; continue; }
9183
#endif
9184
9185
5.01k
  else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_UTF_RIGHTPAR, 4) == 0)
9186
162
    { skipatstart += 6; options |= PCRE_UTF8; continue; }
9187
4.85k
  else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_UCP_RIGHTPAR, 4) == 0)
9188
34
    { skipatstart += 6; options |= PCRE_UCP; continue; }
9189
4.82k
  else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_NO_AUTO_POSSESS_RIGHTPAR, 16) == 0)
9190
34
    { skipatstart += 18; options |= PCRE_NO_AUTO_POSSESS; continue; }
9191
4.78k
  else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_NO_START_OPT_RIGHTPAR, 13) == 0)
9192
67
    { skipatstart += 15; options |= PCRE_NO_START_OPTIMIZE; continue; }
9193
9194
4.72k
  else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_LIMIT_MATCH_EQ, 12) == 0)
9195
293
    {
9196
293
    pcre_uint32 c = 0;
9197
293
    int p = skipatstart + 14;
9198
293
    while (isdigit(ptr[p]))
9199
351
      {
9200
351
      if (c > PCRE_UINT32_MAX / 10 - 1) break;   /* Integer overflow */
9201
349
      c = c*10 + ptr[p++] - CHAR_0;
9202
349
      }
9203
293
    if (ptr[p++] != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS) break;
9204
278
    if (c < limit_match)
9205
41
      {
9206
41
      limit_match = c;
9207
41
      cd->external_flags |= PCRE_MLSET;
9208
41
      }
9209
278
    skipatstart = p;
9210
278
    continue;
9211
293
    }
9212
9213
4.42k
  else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_LIMIT_RECURSION_EQ, 16) == 0)
9214
173
    {
9215
173
    pcre_uint32 c = 0;
9216
173
    int p = skipatstart + 18;
9217
173
    while (isdigit(ptr[p]))
9218
343
      {
9219
343
      if (c > PCRE_UINT32_MAX / 10 - 1) break;   /* Integer overflow check */
9220
342
      c = c*10 + ptr[p++] - CHAR_0;
9221
342
      }
9222
173
    if (ptr[p++] != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS) break;
9223
160
    if (c < limit_recursion)
9224
39
      {
9225
39
      limit_recursion = c;
9226
39
      cd->external_flags |= PCRE_RLSET;
9227
39
      }
9228
160
    skipatstart = p;
9229
160
    continue;
9230
173
    }
9231
9232
4.25k
  if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_CR_RIGHTPAR, 3) == 0)
9233
228
    { skipatstart += 5; newnl = PCRE_NEWLINE_CR; }
9234
4.02k
  else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_LF_RIGHTPAR, 3)  == 0)
9235
284
    { skipatstart += 5; newnl = PCRE_NEWLINE_LF; }
9236
3.74k
  else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_CRLF_RIGHTPAR, 5)  == 0)
9237
2.71k
    { skipatstart += 7; newnl = PCRE_NEWLINE_CR + PCRE_NEWLINE_LF; }
9238
1.03k
  else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_ANY_RIGHTPAR, 4) == 0)
9239
100
    { skipatstart += 6; newnl = PCRE_NEWLINE_ANY; }
9240
931
  else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_ANYCRLF_RIGHTPAR, 8) == 0)
9241
52
    { skipatstart += 10; newnl = PCRE_NEWLINE_ANYCRLF; }
9242
9243
879
  else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_BSR_ANYCRLF_RIGHTPAR, 12) == 0)
9244
63
    { skipatstart += 14; newbsr = PCRE_BSR_ANYCRLF; }
9245
816
  else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_BSR_UNICODE_RIGHTPAR, 12) == 0)
9246
39
    { skipatstart += 14; newbsr = PCRE_BSR_UNICODE; }
9247
9248
4.25k
  if (newnl != 0)
9249
3.37k
    options = (options & ~PCRE_NEWLINE_BITS) | newnl;
9250
879
  else if (newbsr != 0)
9251
102
    options = (options & ~(PCRE_BSR_ANYCRLF|PCRE_BSR_UNICODE)) | newbsr;
9252
777
  else break;
9253
4.25k
  }
9254
9255
/* PCRE_UTF(16|32) have the same value as PCRE_UTF8. */
9256
20.1k
utf = (options & PCRE_UTF8) != 0;
9257
20.1k
if (utf && never_utf)
9258
0
  {
9259
0
  errorcode = ERR78;
9260
0
  goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN2;
9261
0
  }
9262
9263
/* Can't support UTF unless PCRE has been compiled to include the code. The
9264
return of an error code from PRIV(valid_utf)() is a new feature, introduced in
9265
release 8.13. It is passed back from pcre_[dfa_]exec(), but at the moment is
9266
not used here. */
9267
9268
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
9269
if (utf && (options & PCRE_NO_UTF8_CHECK) == 0 &&
9270
     (errorcode = PRIV(valid_utf)((PCRE_PUCHAR)pattern, -1, erroroffset)) != 0)
9271
  {
9272
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE8
9273
  errorcode = ERR44;
9274
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16
9275
  errorcode = ERR74;
9276
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32
9277
  errorcode = ERR77;
9278
#endif
9279
  goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN2;
9280
  }
9281
#else
9282
20.1k
if (utf)
9283
12
  {
9284
12
  errorcode = ERR32;
9285
12
  goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN;
9286
12
  }
9287
20.0k
#endif
9288
9289
/* Can't support UCP unless PCRE has been compiled to include the code. */
9290
9291
20.0k
#ifndef SUPPORT_UCP
9292
20.0k
if ((options & PCRE_UCP) != 0)
9293
6
  {
9294
6
  errorcode = ERR67;
9295
6
  goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN;
9296
6
  }
9297
20.0k
#endif
9298
9299
/* Check validity of \R options. */
9300
9301
20.0k
if ((options & (PCRE_BSR_ANYCRLF|PCRE_BSR_UNICODE)) ==
9302
20.0k
     (PCRE_BSR_ANYCRLF|PCRE_BSR_UNICODE))
9303
0
  {
9304
0
  errorcode = ERR56;
9305
0
  goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN;
9306
0
  }
9307
9308
/* Handle different types of newline. The three bits give seven cases. The
9309
current code allows for fixed one- or two-byte sequences, plus "any" and
9310
"anycrlf". */
9311
9312
20.0k
switch (options & PCRE_NEWLINE_BITS)
9313
20.0k
  {
9314
19.8k
  case 0: newline = NEWLINE; break;   /* Build-time default */
9315
13
  case PCRE_NEWLINE_CR: newline = CHAR_CR; break;
9316
9
  case PCRE_NEWLINE_LF: newline = CHAR_NL; break;
9317
54
  case PCRE_NEWLINE_CR+
9318
54
       PCRE_NEWLINE_LF: newline = (CHAR_CR << 8) | CHAR_NL; break;
9319
72
  case PCRE_NEWLINE_ANY: newline = -1; break;
9320
39
  case PCRE_NEWLINE_ANYCRLF: newline = -2; break;
9321
0
  default: errorcode = ERR56; goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN;
9322
20.0k
  }
9323
9324
20.0k
if (newline == -2)
9325
39
  {
9326
39
  cd->nltype = NLTYPE_ANYCRLF;
9327
39
  }
9328
20.0k
else if (newline < 0)
9329
72
  {
9330
72
  cd->nltype = NLTYPE_ANY;
9331
72
  }
9332
19.9k
else
9333
19.9k
  {
9334
19.9k
  cd->nltype = NLTYPE_FIXED;
9335
19.9k
  if (newline > 255)
9336
54
    {
9337
54
    cd->nllen = 2;
9338
54
    cd->nl[0] = (newline >> 8) & 255;
9339
54
    cd->nl[1] = newline & 255;
9340
54
    }
9341
19.9k
  else
9342
19.9k
    {
9343
19.9k
    cd->nllen = 1;
9344
19.9k
    cd->nl[0] = newline;
9345
19.9k
    }
9346
19.9k
  }
9347
9348
/* Maximum back reference and backref bitmap. The bitmap records up to 31 back
9349
references to help in deciding whether (.*) can be treated as anchored or not.
9350
*/
9351
9352
20.0k
cd->top_backref = 0;
9353
20.0k
cd->backref_map = 0;
9354
9355
/* Reflect pattern for debugging output */
9356
9357
20.0k
DPRINTF(("------------------------------------------------------------------\n"));
9358
#ifdef PCRE_DEBUG
9359
print_puchar(stdout, (PCRE_PUCHAR)pattern);
9360
#endif
9361
20.0k
DPRINTF(("\n"));
9362
9363
/* Pretend to compile the pattern while actually just accumulating the length
9364
of memory required. This behaviour is triggered by passing a non-NULL final
9365
argument to compile_regex(). We pass a block of workspace (cworkspace) for it
9366
to compile parts of the pattern into; the compiled code is discarded when it is
9367
no longer needed, so hopefully this workspace will never overflow, though there
9368
is a test for its doing so. */
9369
9370
20.0k
cd->bracount = cd->final_bracount = 0;
9371
20.0k
cd->names_found = 0;
9372
20.0k
cd->name_entry_size = 0;
9373
20.0k
cd->name_table = NULL;
9374
20.0k
cd->dupnames = FALSE;
9375
20.0k
cd->dupgroups = FALSE;
9376
20.0k
cd->namedrefcount = 0;
9377
20.0k
cd->start_code = cworkspace;
9378
20.0k
cd->hwm = cworkspace;
9379
20.0k
cd->iscondassert = FALSE;
9380
20.0k
cd->start_workspace = cworkspace;
9381
20.0k
cd->workspace_size = COMPILE_WORK_SIZE;
9382
20.0k
cd->start_pattern = (const pcre_uchar *)pattern;
9383
20.0k
cd->end_pattern = (const pcre_uchar *)(pattern + STRLEN_UC((const pcre_uchar *)pattern));
9384
20.0k
cd->req_varyopt = 0;
9385
20.0k
cd->parens_depth = 0;
9386
20.0k
cd->assert_depth = 0;
9387
20.0k
cd->max_lookbehind = 0;
9388
20.0k
cd->external_options = options;
9389
20.0k
cd->open_caps = NULL;
9390
9391
/* Now do the pre-compile. On error, errorcode will be set non-zero, so we
9392
don't need to look at the result of the function here. The initial options have
9393
been put into the cd block so that they can be changed if an option setting is
9394
found within the regex right at the beginning. Bringing initial option settings
9395
outside can help speed up starting point checks. */
9396
9397
20.0k
ptr += skipatstart;
9398
20.0k
code = cworkspace;
9399
20.0k
*code = OP_BRA;
9400
9401
20.0k
(void)compile_regex(cd->external_options, &code, &ptr, &errorcode, FALSE,
9402
20.0k
  FALSE, 0, 0, &firstchar, &firstcharflags, &reqchar, &reqcharflags, NULL,
9403
20.0k
  cd, &length);
9404
20.0k
if (errorcode != 0) goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN;
9405
9406
17.4k
DPRINTF(("end pre-compile: length=%d workspace=%d\n", length,
9407
17.4k
  (int)(cd->hwm - cworkspace)));
9408
9409
17.4k
if (length > MAX_PATTERN_SIZE)
9410
118
  {
9411
118
  errorcode = ERR20;
9412
118
  goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN;
9413
118
  }
9414
9415
/* Compute the size of the data block for storing the compiled pattern. Integer
9416
overflow should no longer be possible because nowadays we limit the maximum
9417
value of cd->names_found and cd->name_entry_size. */
9418
9419
17.2k
size = sizeof(REAL_PCRE) +
9420
17.2k
  (length + cd->names_found * cd->name_entry_size) * sizeof(pcre_uchar);
9421
9422
/* Get the memory. */
9423
9424
17.2k
re = (REAL_PCRE *)(PUBL(malloc))(size);
9425
17.2k
if (re == NULL)
9426
0
  {
9427
0
  errorcode = ERR21;
9428
0
  goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN;
9429
0
  }
9430
9431
/* Put in the magic number, and save the sizes, initial options, internal
9432
flags, and character table pointer. NULL is used for the default character
9433
tables. The nullpad field is at the end; it's there to help in the case when a
9434
regex compiled on a system with 4-byte pointers is run on another with 8-byte
9435
pointers. */
9436
9437
17.2k
re->magic_number = MAGIC_NUMBER;
9438
17.2k
re->size = (int)size;
9439
17.2k
re->options = cd->external_options;
9440
17.2k
re->flags = cd->external_flags;
9441
17.2k
re->limit_match = limit_match;
9442
17.2k
re->limit_recursion = limit_recursion;
9443
17.2k
re->first_char = 0;
9444
17.2k
re->req_char = 0;
9445
17.2k
re->name_table_offset = sizeof(REAL_PCRE) / sizeof(pcre_uchar);
9446
17.2k
re->name_entry_size = cd->name_entry_size;
9447
17.2k
re->name_count = cd->names_found;
9448
17.2k
re->ref_count = 0;
9449
17.2k
re->tables = (tables == PRIV(default_tables))? NULL : tables;
9450
17.2k
re->nullpad = NULL;
9451
#ifdef COMPILE_PCRE32
9452
re->dummy = 0;
9453
#else
9454
17.2k
re->dummy1 = re->dummy2 = re->dummy3 = 0;
9455
17.2k
#endif
9456
9457
/* The starting points of the name/number translation table and of the code are
9458
passed around in the compile data block. The start/end pattern and initial
9459
options are already set from the pre-compile phase, as is the name_entry_size
9460
field. Reset the bracket count and the names_found field. Also reset the hwm
9461
field; this time it's used for remembering forward references to subpatterns.
9462
*/
9463
9464
17.2k
cd->final_bracount = cd->bracount;  /* Save for checking forward references */
9465
17.2k
cd->parens_depth = 0;
9466
17.2k
cd->assert_depth = 0;
9467
17.2k
cd->bracount = 0;
9468
17.2k
cd->max_lookbehind = 0;
9469
17.2k
cd->name_table = (pcre_uchar *)re + re->name_table_offset;
9470
17.2k
codestart = cd->name_table + re->name_entry_size * re->name_count;
9471
17.2k
cd->start_code = codestart;
9472
17.2k
cd->hwm = (pcre_uchar *)(cd->start_workspace);
9473
17.2k
cd->iscondassert = FALSE;
9474
17.2k
cd->req_varyopt = 0;
9475
17.2k
cd->had_accept = FALSE;
9476
17.2k
cd->had_pruneorskip = FALSE;
9477
17.2k
cd->check_lookbehind = FALSE;
9478
17.2k
cd->open_caps = NULL;
9479
9480
/* If any named groups were found, create the name/number table from the list
9481
created in the first pass. */
9482
9483
17.2k
if (cd->names_found > 0)
9484
734
  {
9485
734
  int i = cd->names_found;
9486
734
  named_group *ng = cd->named_groups;
9487
734
  cd->names_found = 0;
9488
29.5k
  for (; i > 0; i--, ng++)
9489
28.8k
    add_name(cd, ng->name, ng->length, ng->number);
9490
734
  if (cd->named_group_list_size > NAMED_GROUP_LIST_SIZE)
9491
42
    (PUBL(free))((void *)cd->named_groups);
9492
734
  cd->named_group_list_size = 0;   /* So we don't free it twice */
9493
734
  }
9494
9495
/* Set up a starting, non-extracting bracket, then compile the expression. On
9496
error, errorcode will be set non-zero, so we don't need to look at the result
9497
of the function here. */
9498
9499
17.2k
ptr = (const pcre_uchar *)pattern + skipatstart;
9500
17.2k
code = (pcre_uchar *)codestart;
9501
17.2k
*code = OP_BRA;
9502
17.2k
(void)compile_regex(re->options, &code, &ptr, &errorcode, FALSE, FALSE, 0, 0,
9503
17.2k
  &firstchar, &firstcharflags, &reqchar, &reqcharflags, NULL, cd, NULL);
9504
17.2k
re->top_bracket = cd->bracount;
9505
17.2k
re->top_backref = cd->top_backref;
9506
17.2k
re->max_lookbehind = cd->max_lookbehind;
9507
17.2k
re->flags = cd->external_flags | PCRE_MODE;
9508
9509
17.2k
if (cd->had_accept)
9510
43
  {
9511
43
  reqchar = 0;              /* Must disable after (*ACCEPT) */
9512
43
  reqcharflags = REQ_NONE;
9513
43
  }
9514
9515
/* If not reached end of pattern on success, there's an excess bracket. */
9516
9517
17.2k
if (errorcode == 0 && *ptr != CHAR_NULL) errorcode = ERR22;
9518
9519
/* Fill in the terminating state and check for disastrous overflow, but
9520
if debugging, leave the test till after things are printed out. */
9521
9522
17.2k
*code++ = OP_END;
9523
9524
17.2k
#ifndef PCRE_DEBUG
9525
17.2k
if (code - codestart > length) errorcode = ERR23;
9526
17.2k
#endif
9527
9528
#ifdef SUPPORT_VALGRIND
9529
/* If the estimated length exceeds the really used length, mark the extra
9530
allocated memory as unaddressable, so that any out-of-bound reads can be
9531
detected. */
9532
VALGRIND_MAKE_MEM_NOACCESS(code, (length - (code - codestart)) * sizeof(pcre_uchar));
9533
#endif
9534
9535
/* Fill in any forward references that are required. There may be repeated
9536
references; optimize for them, as searching a large regex takes time. */
9537
9538
17.2k
if (cd->hwm > cd->start_workspace)
9539
373
  {
9540
373
  int prev_recno = -1;
9541
373
  const pcre_uchar *groupptr = NULL;
9542
125k
  while (errorcode == 0 && cd->hwm > cd->start_workspace)
9543
124k
    {
9544
124k
    int offset, recno;
9545
124k
    cd->hwm -= LINK_SIZE;
9546
124k
    offset = GET(cd->hwm, 0);
9547
9548
    /* Check that the hwm handling hasn't gone wrong. This whole area is
9549
    rewritten in PCRE2 because there are some obscure cases. */
9550
9551
124k
    if (offset == 0 || codestart[offset-1] != OP_RECURSE)
9552
24
      {
9553
24
      errorcode = ERR10;
9554
24
      break;
9555
24
      }
9556
9557
124k
    recno = GET(codestart, offset);
9558
124k
    if (recno != prev_recno)
9559
788
      {
9560
788
      groupptr = PRIV(find_bracket)(codestart, utf, recno);
9561
788
      prev_recno = recno;
9562
788
      }
9563
124k
    if (groupptr == NULL) errorcode = ERR53;
9564
124k
      else PUT(((pcre_uchar *)codestart), offset, (int)(groupptr - codestart));
9565
124k
    }
9566
373
  }
9567
9568
/* If the workspace had to be expanded, free the new memory. Set the pointer to
9569
NULL to indicate that forward references have been filled in. */
9570
9571
17.2k
if (cd->workspace_size > COMPILE_WORK_SIZE)
9572
28
  (PUBL(free))((void *)cd->start_workspace);
9573
17.2k
cd->start_workspace = NULL;
9574
9575
/* Give an error if there's back reference to a non-existent capturing
9576
subpattern. */
9577
9578
17.2k
if (errorcode == 0 && re->top_backref > re->top_bracket) errorcode = ERR15;
9579
9580
/* Unless disabled, check whether any single character iterators can be
9581
auto-possessified. The function overwrites the appropriate opcode values, so
9582
the type of the pointer must be cast. NOTE: the intermediate variable "temp" is
9583
used in this code because at least one compiler gives a warning about loss of
9584
"const" attribute if the cast (pcre_uchar *)codestart is used directly in the
9585
function call. */
9586
9587
17.2k
if (errorcode == 0 && (options & PCRE_NO_AUTO_POSSESS) == 0)
9588
15.7k
  {
9589
15.7k
  pcre_uchar *temp = (pcre_uchar *)codestart;
9590
15.7k
  auto_possessify(temp, utf, cd);
9591
15.7k
  }
9592
9593
/* If there were any lookbehind assertions that contained OP_RECURSE
9594
(recursions or subroutine calls), a flag is set for them to be checked here,
9595
because they may contain forward references. Actual recursions cannot be fixed
9596
length, but subroutine calls can. It is done like this so that those without
9597
OP_RECURSE that are not fixed length get a diagnosic with a useful offset. The
9598
exceptional ones forgo this. We scan the pattern to check that they are fixed
9599
length, and set their lengths. */
9600
9601
17.2k
if (errorcode == 0 && cd->check_lookbehind)
9602
243
  {
9603
243
  pcre_uchar *cc = (pcre_uchar *)codestart;
9604
9605
  /* Loop, searching for OP_REVERSE items, and process those that do not have
9606
  their length set. (Actually, it will also re-process any that have a length
9607
  of zero, but that is a pathological case, and it does no harm.) When we find
9608
  one, we temporarily terminate the branch it is in while we scan it. */
9609
9610
243
  for (cc = (pcre_uchar *)PRIV(find_bracket)(codestart, utf, -1);
9611
2.78k
       cc != NULL;
9612
2.54k
       cc = (pcre_uchar *)PRIV(find_bracket)(cc, utf, -1))
9613
2.68k
    {
9614
2.68k
    if (GET(cc, 1) == 0)
9615
2.38k
      {
9616
2.38k
      int fixed_length;
9617
2.38k
      pcre_uchar *be = cc - 1 - LINK_SIZE + GET(cc, -LINK_SIZE);
9618
2.38k
      int end_op = *be;
9619
2.38k
      *be = OP_END;
9620
2.38k
      fixed_length = find_fixedlength(cc, (re->options & PCRE_UTF8) != 0, TRUE,
9621
2.38k
        cd, NULL);
9622
2.38k
      *be = end_op;
9623
2.38k
      DPRINTF(("fixed length = %d\n", fixed_length));
9624
2.38k
      if (fixed_length < 0)
9625
136
        {
9626
136
        errorcode = (fixed_length == -2)? ERR36 :
9627
136
                    (fixed_length == -4)? ERR70 : ERR25;
9628
136
        break;
9629
136
        }
9630
2.25k
      if (fixed_length > cd->max_lookbehind) cd->max_lookbehind = fixed_length;
9631
2.25k
      PUT(cc, 1, fixed_length);
9632
2.25k
      }
9633
2.54k
    cc += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
9634
2.54k
    }
9635
243
  }
9636
9637
/* Failed to compile, or error while post-processing */
9638
9639
17.2k
if (errorcode != 0)
9640
1.65k
  {
9641
1.65k
  (PUBL(free))(re);
9642
4.46k
  PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN:
9643
4.46k
  if (cd->named_group_list_size > NAMED_GROUP_LIST_SIZE)
9644
32
    (PUBL(free))((void *)cd->named_groups);
9645
4.46k
  *erroroffset = (int)(ptr - (const pcre_uchar *)pattern);
9646
4.46k
  PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN2:
9647
4.46k
  *errorptr = find_error_text(errorcode);
9648
4.46k
  if (errorcodeptr != NULL) *errorcodeptr = errorcode;
9649
4.46k
  return NULL;
9650
4.46k
  }
9651
9652
/* If the anchored option was not passed, set the flag if we can determine that
9653
the pattern is anchored by virtue of ^ characters or \A or anything else, such
9654
as starting with non-atomic .* when DOTALL is set and there are no occurrences
9655
of *PRUNE or *SKIP.
9656
9657
Otherwise, if we know what the first byte has to be, save it, because that
9658
speeds up unanchored matches no end. If not, see if we can set the
9659
PCRE_STARTLINE flag. This is helpful for multiline matches when all branches
9660
start with ^. and also when all branches start with non-atomic .* for
9661
non-DOTALL matches when *PRUNE and SKIP are not present. */
9662
9663
15.6k
if ((re->options & PCRE_ANCHORED) == 0)
9664
15.6k
  {
9665
15.6k
  if (is_anchored(codestart, 0, cd, 0)) re->options |= PCRE_ANCHORED;
9666
15.5k
  else
9667
15.5k
    {
9668
15.5k
    if (firstcharflags < 0)
9669
4.67k
      firstchar = find_firstassertedchar(codestart, &firstcharflags, FALSE);
9670
15.5k
    if (firstcharflags >= 0)   /* Remove caseless flag for non-caseable chars */
9671
10.9k
      {
9672
10.9k
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE8
9673
10.9k
      re->first_char = firstchar & 0xff;
9674
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16
9675
      re->first_char = firstchar & 0xffff;
9676
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32
9677
      re->first_char = firstchar;
9678
#endif
9679
10.9k
      if ((firstcharflags & REQ_CASELESS) != 0)
9680
50
        {
9681
#if defined SUPPORT_UCP && !(defined COMPILE_PCRE8)
9682
        /* We ignore non-ASCII first chars in 8 bit mode. */
9683
        if (utf)
9684
          {
9685
          if (re->first_char < 128)
9686
            {
9687
            if (cd->fcc[re->first_char] != re->first_char)
9688
              re->flags |= PCRE_FCH_CASELESS;
9689
            }
9690
          else if (UCD_OTHERCASE(re->first_char) != re->first_char)
9691
            re->flags |= PCRE_FCH_CASELESS;
9692
          }
9693
        else
9694
#endif
9695
50
        if (MAX_255(re->first_char)
9696
50
            && cd->fcc[re->first_char] != re->first_char)
9697
12
          re->flags |= PCRE_FCH_CASELESS;
9698
50
        }
9699
9700
10.9k
      re->flags |= PCRE_FIRSTSET;
9701
10.9k
      }
9702
9703
4.58k
    else if (is_startline(codestart, 0, cd, 0, FALSE)) re->flags |= PCRE_STARTLINE;
9704
15.5k
    }
9705
15.6k
  }
9706
9707
/* For an anchored pattern, we use the "required byte" only if it follows a
9708
variable length item in the regex. Remove the caseless flag for non-caseable
9709
bytes. */
9710
9711
15.6k
if (reqcharflags >= 0 &&
9712
11.3k
     ((re->options & PCRE_ANCHORED) == 0 || (reqcharflags & REQ_VARY) != 0))
9713
11.3k
  {
9714
11.3k
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE8
9715
11.3k
  re->req_char = reqchar & 0xff;
9716
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16
9717
  re->req_char = reqchar & 0xffff;
9718
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32
9719
  re->req_char = reqchar;
9720
#endif
9721
11.3k
  if ((reqcharflags & REQ_CASELESS) != 0)
9722
60
    {
9723
#if defined SUPPORT_UCP && !(defined COMPILE_PCRE8)
9724
    /* We ignore non-ASCII first chars in 8 bit mode. */
9725
    if (utf)
9726
      {
9727
      if (re->req_char < 128)
9728
        {
9729
        if (cd->fcc[re->req_char] != re->req_char)
9730
          re->flags |= PCRE_RCH_CASELESS;
9731
        }
9732
      else if (UCD_OTHERCASE(re->req_char) != re->req_char)
9733
        re->flags |= PCRE_RCH_CASELESS;
9734
      }
9735
    else
9736
#endif
9737
60
    if (MAX_255(re->req_char) && cd->fcc[re->req_char] != re->req_char)
9738
17
      re->flags |= PCRE_RCH_CASELESS;
9739
60
    }
9740
9741
11.3k
  re->flags |= PCRE_REQCHSET;
9742
11.3k
  }
9743
9744
/* Print out the compiled data if debugging is enabled. This is never the
9745
case when building a production library. */
9746
9747
#ifdef PCRE_DEBUG
9748
printf("Length = %d top_bracket = %d top_backref = %d\n",
9749
  length, re->top_bracket, re->top_backref);
9750
9751
printf("Options=%08x\n", re->options);
9752
9753
if ((re->flags & PCRE_FIRSTSET) != 0)
9754
  {
9755
  pcre_uchar ch = re->first_char;
9756
  const char *caseless =
9757
    ((re->flags & PCRE_FCH_CASELESS) == 0)? "" : " (caseless)";
9758
  if (PRINTABLE(ch)) printf("First char = %c%s\n", ch, caseless);
9759
    else printf("First char = \\x%02x%s\n", ch, caseless);
9760
  }
9761
9762
if ((re->flags & PCRE_REQCHSET) != 0)
9763
  {
9764
  pcre_uchar ch = re->req_char;
9765
  const char *caseless =
9766
    ((re->flags & PCRE_RCH_CASELESS) == 0)? "" : " (caseless)";
9767
  if (PRINTABLE(ch)) printf("Req char = %c%s\n", ch, caseless);
9768
    else printf("Req char = \\x%02x%s\n", ch, caseless);
9769
  }
9770
9771
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE8
9772
pcre_printint((pcre *)re, stdout, TRUE);
9773
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16
9774
pcre16_printint((pcre *)re, stdout, TRUE);
9775
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32
9776
pcre32_printint((pcre *)re, stdout, TRUE);
9777
#endif
9778
9779
/* This check is done here in the debugging case so that the code that
9780
was compiled can be seen. */
9781
9782
if (code - codestart > length)
9783
  {
9784
  (PUBL(free))(re);
9785
  *errorptr = find_error_text(ERR23);
9786
  *erroroffset = ptr - (pcre_uchar *)pattern;
9787
  if (errorcodeptr != NULL) *errorcodeptr = ERR23;
9788
  return NULL;
9789
  }
9790
#endif   /* PCRE_DEBUG */
9791
9792
/* Check for a pattern than can match an empty string, so that this information
9793
can be provided to applications. */
9794
9795
15.6k
do
9796
16.2k
  {
9797
16.2k
  if (could_be_empty_branch(codestart, code, utf, cd, NULL))
9798
3.05k
    {
9799
3.05k
    re->flags |= PCRE_MATCH_EMPTY;
9800
3.05k
    break;
9801
3.05k
    }
9802
13.1k
  codestart += GET(codestart, 1);
9803
13.1k
  }
9804
15.6k
while (*codestart == OP_ALT);
9805
9806
15.6k
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE8
9807
15.6k
return (pcre *)re;
9808
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16
9809
return (pcre16 *)re;
9810
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32
9811
return (pcre32 *)re;
9812
#endif
9813
17.2k
}
9814
9815
/* End of pcre_compile.c */